Coverage Report

Created: 2025-08-26 06:21

/src/libgit2/deps/pcre/pcre_compile.c
Line
Count
Source (jump to first uncovered line)
1
/*************************************************
2
*      Perl-Compatible Regular Expressions       *
3
*************************************************/
4
5
/* PCRE is a library of functions to support regular expressions whose syntax
6
and semantics are as close as possible to those of the Perl 5 language.
7
8
                       Written by Philip Hazel
9
           Copyright (c) 1997-2021 University of Cambridge
10
11
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
12
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
13
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
14
15
    * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
16
      this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
17
18
    * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
19
      notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
20
      documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
21
22
    * Neither the name of the University of Cambridge nor the names of its
23
      contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
24
      this software without specific prior written permission.
25
26
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS"
27
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
28
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
29
ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
30
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
31
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
32
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
33
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
34
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
35
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
36
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
37
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
38
*/
39
40
41
/* This module contains the external function pcre_compile(), along with
42
supporting internal functions that are not used by other modules. */
43
44
45
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
46
#include "config.h"
47
#endif
48
49
34.5k
#define NLBLOCK cd             /* Block containing newline information */
50
#define PSSTART start_pattern  /* Field containing pattern start */
51
14.4k
#define PSEND   end_pattern    /* Field containing pattern end */
52
53
#include "pcre_internal.h"
54
55
56
/* When PCRE_DEBUG is defined, we need the pcre(16|32)_printint() function, which
57
is also used by pcretest. PCRE_DEBUG is not defined when building a production
58
library. We do not need to select pcre16_printint.c specially, because the
59
COMPILE_PCREx macro will already be appropriately set. */
60
61
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
62
/* pcre_printint.c should not include any headers */
63
#define PCRE_INCLUDED
64
#include "pcre_printint.c"
65
#undef PCRE_INCLUDED
66
#endif
67
68
69
/* Macro for setting individual bits in class bitmaps. */
70
71
714k
#define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] |= (1U << ((b)&7))
72
73
/* Maximum length value to check against when making sure that the integer that
74
holds the compiled pattern length does not overflow. We make it a bit less than
75
INT_MAX to allow for adding in group terminating bytes, so that we don't have
76
to check them every time. */
77
78
4.72M
#define OFLOW_MAX (INT_MAX - 20)
79
80
/* Definitions to allow mutual recursion */
81
82
static int
83
  add_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *, pcre_uchar **, int, compile_data *,
84
    const pcre_uint32 *, unsigned int);
85
86
static BOOL
87
  compile_regex(int, pcre_uchar **, const pcre_uchar **, int *, BOOL, BOOL, int, int,
88
    pcre_uint32 *, pcre_int32 *, pcre_uint32 *, pcre_int32 *, branch_chain *,
89
    compile_data *, int *);
90
91
92
93
/*************************************************
94
*      Code parameters and static tables         *
95
*************************************************/
96
97
/* This value specifies the size of stack workspace that is used during the
98
first pre-compile phase that determines how much memory is required. The regex
99
is partly compiled into this space, but the compiled parts are discarded as
100
soon as they can be, so that hopefully there will never be an overrun. The code
101
does, however, check for an overrun. The largest amount I've seen used is 218,
102
so this number is very generous.
103
104
The same workspace is used during the second, actual compile phase for
105
remembering forward references to groups so that they can be filled in at the
106
end. Each entry in this list occupies LINK_SIZE bytes, so even when LINK_SIZE
107
is 4 there is plenty of room for most patterns. However, the memory can get
108
filled up by repetitions of forward references, for example patterns like
109
/(?1){0,1999}(b)/, and one user did hit the limit. The code has been changed so
110
that the workspace is expanded using malloc() in this situation. The value
111
below is therefore a minimum, and we put a maximum on it for safety. The
112
minimum is now also defined in terms of LINK_SIZE so that the use of malloc()
113
kicks in at the same number of forward references in all cases. */
114
115
35.9k
#define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE (2048*LINK_SIZE)
116
111
#define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX (100*COMPILE_WORK_SIZE)
117
118
/* This value determines the size of the initial vector that is used for
119
remembering named groups during the pre-compile. It is allocated on the stack,
120
but if it is too small, it is expanded using malloc(), in a similar way to the
121
workspace. The value is the number of slots in the list. */
122
123
25.3k
#define NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE  20
124
125
/* The overrun tests check for a slightly smaller size so that they detect the
126
overrun before it actually does run off the end of the data block. */
127
128
3.49M
#define WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN (100)
129
130
/* Private flags added to firstchar and reqchar. */
131
132
261k
#define REQ_CASELESS    (1U << 0)        /* Indicates caselessness */
133
303k
#define REQ_VARY        (1U << 1)        /* Reqchar followed non-literal item */
134
/* Negative values for the firstchar and reqchar flags */
135
3.53M
#define REQ_UNSET       (-2)
136
398k
#define REQ_NONE        (-1)
137
138
/* Repeated character flags. */
139
140
#define UTF_LENGTH     0x10000000l      /* The char contains its length. */
141
142
/* Table for handling escaped characters in the range '0'-'z'. Positive returns
143
are simple data values; negative values are for special things like \d and so
144
on. Zero means further processing is needed (for things like \x), or the escape
145
is invalid. */
146
147
#ifndef EBCDIC
148
149
/* This is the "normal" table for ASCII systems or for EBCDIC systems running
150
in UTF-8 mode. */
151
152
static const short int escapes[] = {
153
     0,                       0,
154
     0,                       0,
155
     0,                       0,
156
     0,                       0,
157
     0,                       0,
158
     CHAR_COLON,              CHAR_SEMICOLON,
159
     CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN,     CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN,
160
     CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN,  CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
161
     CHAR_COMMERCIAL_AT,      -ESC_A,
162
     -ESC_B,                  -ESC_C,
163
     -ESC_D,                  -ESC_E,
164
     0,                       -ESC_G,
165
     -ESC_H,                  0,
166
     0,                       -ESC_K,
167
     0,                       0,
168
     -ESC_N,                  0,
169
     -ESC_P,                  -ESC_Q,
170
     -ESC_R,                  -ESC_S,
171
     0,                       0,
172
     -ESC_V,                  -ESC_W,
173
     -ESC_X,                  0,
174
     -ESC_Z,                  CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
175
     CHAR_BACKSLASH,          CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET,
176
     CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT,  CHAR_UNDERSCORE,
177
     CHAR_GRAVE_ACCENT,       ESC_a,
178
     -ESC_b,                  0,
179
     -ESC_d,                  ESC_e,
180
     ESC_f,                   0,
181
     -ESC_h,                  0,
182
     0,                       -ESC_k,
183
     0,                       0,
184
     ESC_n,                   0,
185
     -ESC_p,                  0,
186
     ESC_r,                   -ESC_s,
187
     ESC_tee,                 0,
188
     -ESC_v,                  -ESC_w,
189
     0,                       0,
190
     -ESC_z
191
};
192
193
#else
194
195
/* This is the "abnormal" table for EBCDIC systems without UTF-8 support. */
196
197
static const short int escapes[] = {
198
/*  48 */     0,     0,      0,     '.',    '<',   '(',    '+',    '|',
199
/*  50 */   '&',     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
200
/*  58 */     0,     0,    '!',     '$',    '*',   ')',    ';',    '~',
201
/*  60 */   '-',   '/',      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
202
/*  68 */     0,     0,    '|',     ',',    '%',   '_',    '>',    '?',
203
/*  70 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
204
/*  78 */     0,   '`',    ':',     '#',    '@',  '\'',    '=',    '"',
205
/*  80 */     0, ESC_a, -ESC_b,       0, -ESC_d, ESC_e,  ESC_f,      0,
206
/*  88 */-ESC_h,     0,      0,     '{',      0,     0,      0,      0,
207
/*  90 */     0,     0, -ESC_k,       0,      0, ESC_n,      0, -ESC_p,
208
/*  98 */     0, ESC_r,      0,     '}',      0,     0,      0,      0,
209
/*  A0 */     0,   '~', -ESC_s, ESC_tee,      0,-ESC_v, -ESC_w,      0,
210
/*  A8 */     0,-ESC_z,      0,       0,      0,   '[',      0,      0,
211
/*  B0 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
212
/*  B8 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,   ']',    '=',    '-',
213
/*  C0 */   '{',-ESC_A, -ESC_B,  -ESC_C, -ESC_D,-ESC_E,      0, -ESC_G,
214
/*  C8 */-ESC_H,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
215
/*  D0 */   '}',     0, -ESC_K,       0,      0,-ESC_N,      0, -ESC_P,
216
/*  D8 */-ESC_Q,-ESC_R,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
217
/*  E0 */  '\\',     0, -ESC_S,       0,      0,-ESC_V, -ESC_W, -ESC_X,
218
/*  E8 */     0,-ESC_Z,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
219
/*  F0 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0,
220
/*  F8 */     0,     0,      0,       0,      0,     0,      0,      0
221
};
222
223
/* We also need a table of characters that may follow \c in an EBCDIC
224
environment for characters 0-31. */
225
226
static unsigned char ebcdic_escape_c[] = "@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ[\\]^_";
227
228
#endif
229
230
231
/* Table of special "verbs" like (*PRUNE). This is a short table, so it is
232
searched linearly. Put all the names into a single string, in order to reduce
233
the number of relocations when a shared library is dynamically linked. The
234
string is built from string macros so that it works in UTF-8 mode on EBCDIC
235
platforms. */
236
237
typedef struct verbitem {
238
  int   len;                 /* Length of verb name */
239
  int   op;                  /* Op when no arg, or -1 if arg mandatory */
240
  int   op_arg;              /* Op when arg present, or -1 if not allowed */
241
} verbitem;
242
243
static const char verbnames[] =
244
  "\0"                       /* Empty name is a shorthand for MARK */
245
  STRING_MARK0
246
  STRING_ACCEPT0
247
  STRING_COMMIT0
248
  STRING_F0
249
  STRING_FAIL0
250
  STRING_PRUNE0
251
  STRING_SKIP0
252
  STRING_THEN;
253
254
static const verbitem verbs[] = {
255
  { 0, -1,        OP_MARK },
256
  { 4, -1,        OP_MARK },
257
  { 6, OP_ACCEPT, -1 },
258
  { 6, OP_COMMIT, -1 },
259
  { 1, OP_FAIL,   -1 },
260
  { 4, OP_FAIL,   -1 },
261
  { 5, OP_PRUNE,  OP_PRUNE_ARG },
262
  { 4, OP_SKIP,   OP_SKIP_ARG  },
263
  { 4, OP_THEN,   OP_THEN_ARG  }
264
};
265
266
static const int verbcount = sizeof(verbs)/sizeof(verbitem);
267
268
269
/* Substitutes for [[:<:]] and [[:>:]], which mean start and end of word in
270
another regex library. */
271
272
static const pcre_uchar sub_start_of_word[] = {
273
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_b, CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
274
  CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_w, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, '\0' };
275
276
static const pcre_uchar sub_end_of_word[] = {
277
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_b, CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK,
278
  CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_w,
279
  CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, '\0' };
280
281
282
/* Tables of names of POSIX character classes and their lengths. The names are
283
now all in a single string, to reduce the number of relocations when a shared
284
library is dynamically loaded. The list of lengths is terminated by a zero
285
length entry. The first three must be alpha, lower, upper, as this is assumed
286
for handling case independence. The indices for graph, print, and punct are
287
needed, so identify them. */
288
289
static const char posix_names[] =
290
  STRING_alpha0 STRING_lower0 STRING_upper0 STRING_alnum0
291
  STRING_ascii0 STRING_blank0 STRING_cntrl0 STRING_digit0
292
  STRING_graph0 STRING_print0 STRING_punct0 STRING_space0
293
  STRING_word0  STRING_xdigit;
294
295
static const pcre_uint8 posix_name_lengths[] = {
296
  5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 4, 6, 0 };
297
298
#define PC_GRAPH  8
299
#define PC_PRINT  9
300
#define PC_PUNCT 10
301
302
303
/* Table of class bit maps for each POSIX class. Each class is formed from a
304
base map, with an optional addition or removal of another map. Then, for some
305
classes, there is some additional tweaking: for [:blank:] the vertical space
306
characters are removed, and for [:alpha:] and [:alnum:] the underscore
307
character is removed. The triples in the table consist of the base map offset,
308
second map offset or -1 if no second map, and a non-negative value for map
309
addition or a negative value for map subtraction (if there are two maps). The
310
absolute value of the third field has these meanings: 0 => no tweaking, 1 =>
311
remove vertical space characters, 2 => remove underscore. */
312
313
static const int posix_class_maps[] = {
314
  cbit_word,  cbit_digit, -2,             /* alpha */
315
  cbit_lower, -1,          0,             /* lower */
316
  cbit_upper, -1,          0,             /* upper */
317
  cbit_word,  -1,          2,             /* alnum - word without underscore */
318
  cbit_print, cbit_cntrl,  0,             /* ascii */
319
  cbit_space, -1,          1,             /* blank - a GNU extension */
320
  cbit_cntrl, -1,          0,             /* cntrl */
321
  cbit_digit, -1,          0,             /* digit */
322
  cbit_graph, -1,          0,             /* graph */
323
  cbit_print, -1,          0,             /* print */
324
  cbit_punct, -1,          0,             /* punct */
325
  cbit_space, -1,          0,             /* space */
326
  cbit_word,  -1,          0,             /* word - a Perl extension */
327
  cbit_xdigit,-1,          0              /* xdigit */
328
};
329
330
/* Table of substitutes for \d etc when PCRE_UCP is set. They are replaced by
331
Unicode property escapes. */
332
333
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
334
static const pcre_uchar string_PNd[]  = {
335
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
336
  CHAR_N, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
337
static const pcre_uchar string_pNd[]  = {
338
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
339
  CHAR_N, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
340
static const pcre_uchar string_PXsp[] = {
341
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
342
  CHAR_X, CHAR_s, CHAR_p, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
343
static const pcre_uchar string_pXsp[] = {
344
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
345
  CHAR_X, CHAR_s, CHAR_p, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
346
static const pcre_uchar string_PXwd[] = {
347
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
348
  CHAR_X, CHAR_w, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
349
static const pcre_uchar string_pXwd[] = {
350
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
351
  CHAR_X, CHAR_w, CHAR_d, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
352
353
static const pcre_uchar *substitutes[] = {
354
  string_PNd,           /* \D */
355
  string_pNd,           /* \d */
356
  string_PXsp,          /* \S */   /* Xsp is Perl space, but from 8.34, Perl */
357
  string_pXsp,          /* \s */   /* space and POSIX space are the same. */
358
  string_PXwd,          /* \W */
359
  string_pXwd           /* \w */
360
};
361
362
/* The POSIX class substitutes must be in the order of the POSIX class names,
363
defined above, and there are both positive and negative cases. NULL means no
364
general substitute of a Unicode property escape (\p or \P). However, for some
365
POSIX classes (e.g. graph, print, punct) a special property code is compiled
366
directly. */
367
368
static const pcre_uchar string_pL[] =   {
369
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
370
  CHAR_L, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
371
static const pcre_uchar string_pLl[] =  {
372
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
373
  CHAR_L, CHAR_l, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
374
static const pcre_uchar string_pLu[] =  {
375
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
376
  CHAR_L, CHAR_u, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
377
static const pcre_uchar string_pXan[] = {
378
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
379
  CHAR_X, CHAR_a, CHAR_n, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
380
static const pcre_uchar string_h[] =    {
381
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_h, '\0' };
382
static const pcre_uchar string_pXps[] = {
383
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_p, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
384
  CHAR_X, CHAR_p, CHAR_s, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
385
static const pcre_uchar string_PL[] =   {
386
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
387
  CHAR_L, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
388
static const pcre_uchar string_PLl[] =  {
389
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
390
  CHAR_L, CHAR_l, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
391
static const pcre_uchar string_PLu[] =  {
392
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
393
  CHAR_L, CHAR_u, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
394
static const pcre_uchar string_PXan[] = {
395
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
396
  CHAR_X, CHAR_a, CHAR_n, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
397
static const pcre_uchar string_H[] =    {
398
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_H, '\0' };
399
static const pcre_uchar string_PXps[] = {
400
  CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_P, CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET,
401
  CHAR_X, CHAR_p, CHAR_s, CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET, '\0' };
402
403
static const pcre_uchar *posix_substitutes[] = {
404
  string_pL,            /* alpha */
405
  string_pLl,           /* lower */
406
  string_pLu,           /* upper */
407
  string_pXan,          /* alnum */
408
  NULL,                 /* ascii */
409
  string_h,             /* blank */
410
  NULL,                 /* cntrl */
411
  string_pNd,           /* digit */
412
  NULL,                 /* graph */
413
  NULL,                 /* print */
414
  NULL,                 /* punct */
415
  string_pXps,          /* space */   /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */
416
  string_pXwd,          /* word  */   /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */
417
  NULL,                 /* xdigit */
418
  /* Negated cases */
419
  string_PL,            /* ^alpha */
420
  string_PLl,           /* ^lower */
421
  string_PLu,           /* ^upper */
422
  string_PXan,          /* ^alnum */
423
  NULL,                 /* ^ascii */
424
  string_H,             /* ^blank */
425
  NULL,                 /* ^cntrl */
426
  string_PNd,           /* ^digit */
427
  NULL,                 /* ^graph */
428
  NULL,                 /* ^print */
429
  NULL,                 /* ^punct */
430
  string_PXps,          /* ^space */  /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */
431
  string_PXwd,          /* ^word */   /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */
432
  NULL                  /* ^xdigit */
433
};
434
#define POSIX_SUBSIZE (sizeof(posix_substitutes) / sizeof(pcre_uchar *))
435
#endif
436
437
#define STRING(a)  # a
438
#define XSTRING(s) STRING(s)
439
440
/* The texts of compile-time error messages. These are "char *" because they
441
are passed to the outside world. Do not ever re-use any error number, because
442
they are documented. Always add a new error instead. Messages marked DEAD below
443
are no longer used. This used to be a table of strings, but in order to reduce
444
the number of relocations needed when a shared library is loaded dynamically,
445
it is now one long string. We cannot use a table of offsets, because the
446
lengths of inserts such as XSTRING(MAX_NAME_SIZE) are not known. Instead, we
447
simply count through to the one we want - this isn't a performance issue
448
because these strings are used only when there is a compilation error.
449
450
Each substring ends with \0 to insert a null character. This includes the final
451
substring, so that the whole string ends with \0\0, which can be detected when
452
counting through. */
453
454
static const char error_texts[] =
455
  "no error\0"
456
  "\\ at end of pattern\0"
457
  "\\c at end of pattern\0"
458
  "unrecognized character follows \\\0"
459
  "numbers out of order in {} quantifier\0"
460
  /* 5 */
461
  "number too big in {} quantifier\0"
462
  "missing terminating ] for character class\0"
463
  "invalid escape sequence in character class\0"
464
  "range out of order in character class\0"
465
  "nothing to repeat\0"
466
  /* 10 */
467
  "internal error: invalid forward reference offset\0"
468
  "internal error: unexpected repeat\0"
469
  "unrecognized character after (? or (?-\0"
470
  "POSIX named classes are supported only within a class\0"
471
  "missing )\0"
472
  /* 15 */
473
  "reference to non-existent subpattern\0"
474
  "erroffset passed as NULL\0"
475
  "unknown option bit(s) set\0"
476
  "missing ) after comment\0"
477
  "parentheses nested too deeply\0"  /** DEAD **/
478
  /* 20 */
479
  "regular expression is too large\0"
480
  "failed to get memory\0"
481
  "unmatched parentheses\0"
482
  "internal error: code overflow\0"
483
  "unrecognized character after (?<\0"
484
  /* 25 */
485
  "lookbehind assertion is not fixed length\0"
486
  "malformed number or name after (?(\0"
487
  "conditional group contains more than two branches\0"
488
  "assertion expected after (?( or (?(?C)\0"
489
  "(?R or (?[+-]digits must be followed by )\0"
490
  /* 30 */
491
  "unknown POSIX class name\0"
492
  "POSIX collating elements are not supported\0"
493
  "this version of PCRE is compiled without UTF support\0"
494
  "spare error\0"  /** DEAD **/
495
  "character value in \\x{} or \\o{} is too large\0"
496
  /* 35 */
497
  "invalid condition (?(0)\0"
498
  "\\C not allowed in lookbehind assertion\0"
499
  "PCRE does not support \\L, \\l, \\N{name}, \\U, or \\u\0"
500
  "number after (?C is > 255\0"
501
  "closing ) for (?C expected\0"
502
  /* 40 */
503
  "recursive call could loop indefinitely\0"
504
  "unrecognized character after (?P\0"
505
  "syntax error in subpattern name (missing terminator)\0"
506
  "two named subpatterns have the same name\0"
507
  "invalid UTF-8 string\0"
508
  /* 45 */
509
  "support for \\P, \\p, and \\X has not been compiled\0"
510
  "malformed \\P or \\p sequence\0"
511
  "unknown property name after \\P or \\p\0"
512
  "subpattern name is too long (maximum " XSTRING(MAX_NAME_SIZE) " characters)\0"
513
  "too many named subpatterns (maximum " XSTRING(MAX_NAME_COUNT) ")\0"
514
  /* 50 */
515
  "repeated subpattern is too long\0"    /** DEAD **/
516
  "octal value is greater than \\377 in 8-bit non-UTF-8 mode\0"
517
  "internal error: overran compiling workspace\0"
518
  "internal error: previously-checked referenced subpattern not found\0"
519
  "DEFINE group contains more than one branch\0"
520
  /* 55 */
521
  "repeating a DEFINE group is not allowed\0"  /** DEAD **/
522
  "inconsistent NEWLINE options\0"
523
  "\\g is not followed by a braced, angle-bracketed, or quoted name/number or by a plain number\0"
524
  "a numbered reference must not be zero\0"
525
  "an argument is not allowed for (*ACCEPT), (*FAIL), or (*COMMIT)\0"
526
  /* 60 */
527
  "(*VERB) not recognized or malformed\0"
528
  "number is too big\0"
529
  "subpattern name expected\0"
530
  "digit expected after (?+\0"
531
  "] is an invalid data character in JavaScript compatibility mode\0"
532
  /* 65 */
533
  "different names for subpatterns of the same number are not allowed\0"
534
  "(*MARK) must have an argument\0"
535
  "this version of PCRE is not compiled with Unicode property support\0"
536
#ifndef EBCDIC
537
  "\\c must be followed by an ASCII character\0"
538
#else
539
  "\\c must be followed by a letter or one of [\\]^_?\0"
540
#endif
541
  "\\k is not followed by a braced, angle-bracketed, or quoted name\0"
542
  /* 70 */
543
  "internal error: unknown opcode in find_fixedlength()\0"
544
  "\\N is not supported in a class\0"
545
  "too many forward references\0"
546
  "disallowed Unicode code point (>= 0xd800 && <= 0xdfff)\0"
547
  "invalid UTF-16 string\0"
548
  /* 75 */
549
  "name is too long in (*MARK), (*PRUNE), (*SKIP), or (*THEN)\0"
550
  "character value in \\u.... sequence is too large\0"
551
  "invalid UTF-32 string\0"
552
  "setting UTF is disabled by the application\0"
553
  "non-hex character in \\x{} (closing brace missing?)\0"
554
  /* 80 */
555
  "non-octal character in \\o{} (closing brace missing?)\0"
556
  "missing opening brace after \\o\0"
557
  "parentheses are too deeply nested\0"
558
  "invalid range in character class\0"
559
  "group name must start with a non-digit\0"
560
  /* 85 */
561
  "parentheses are too deeply nested (stack check)\0"
562
  "digits missing in \\x{} or \\o{}\0"
563
  "regular expression is too complicated\0"
564
  ;
565
566
/* Table to identify digits and hex digits. This is used when compiling
567
patterns. Note that the tables in chartables are dependent on the locale, and
568
may mark arbitrary characters as digits - but the PCRE compiling code expects
569
to handle only 0-9, a-z, and A-Z as digits when compiling. That is why we have
570
a private table here. It costs 256 bytes, but it is a lot faster than doing
571
character value tests (at least in some simple cases I timed), and in some
572
applications one wants PCRE to compile efficiently as well as match
573
efficiently.
574
575
For convenience, we use the same bit definitions as in chartables:
576
577
  0x04   decimal digit
578
  0x08   hexadecimal digit
579
580
Then we can use ctype_digit and ctype_xdigit in the code. */
581
582
/* Using a simple comparison for decimal numbers rather than a memory read
583
is much faster, and the resulting code is simpler (the compiler turns it
584
into a subtraction and unsigned comparison). */
585
586
398k
#define IS_DIGIT(x) ((x) >= CHAR_0 && (x) <= CHAR_9)
587
588
#ifndef EBCDIC
589
590
/* This is the "normal" case, for ASCII systems, and EBCDIC systems running in
591
UTF-8 mode. */
592
593
static const pcre_uint8 digitab[] =
594
  {
595
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   0-  7 */
596
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   8- 15 */
597
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  16- 23 */
598
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  24- 31 */
599
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*    - '  */
600
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  ( - /  */
601
  0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c, /*  0 - 7  */
602
  0x0c,0x0c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  8 - ?  */
603
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /*  @ - G  */
604
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  H - O  */
605
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  P - W  */
606
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  X - _  */
607
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /*  ` - g  */
608
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  h - o  */
609
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  p - w  */
610
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  x -127 */
611
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 128-135 */
612
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 136-143 */
613
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 144-151 */
614
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 152-159 */
615
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 160-167 */
616
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 168-175 */
617
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 176-183 */
618
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191 */
619
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 192-199 */
620
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 200-207 */
621
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 208-215 */
622
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 216-223 */
623
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 224-231 */
624
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 232-239 */
625
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 240-247 */
626
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/* 248-255 */
627
628
#else
629
630
/* This is the "abnormal" case, for EBCDIC systems not running in UTF-8 mode. */
631
632
static const pcre_uint8 digitab[] =
633
  {
634
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   0-  7  0 */
635
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*   8- 15    */
636
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  16- 23 10 */
637
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  24- 31    */
638
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  32- 39 20 */
639
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  40- 47    */
640
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  48- 55 30 */
641
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  56- 63    */
642
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*    - 71 40 */
643
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  72- |     */
644
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  & - 87 50 */
645
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  88- 95    */
646
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  - -103 60 */
647
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 104- ?     */
648
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 112-119 70 */
649
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 120- "     */
650
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /* 128- g  80 */
651
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  h -143    */
652
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 144- p  90 */
653
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  q -159    */
654
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 160- x  A0 */
655
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  y -175    */
656
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  ^ -183 B0 */
657
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191    */
658
  0x00,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x08,0x00, /*  { - G  C0 */
659
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  H -207    */
660
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  } - P  D0 */
661
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Q -223    */
662
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  \ - X  E0 */
663
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Y -239    */
664
  0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c,0x0c, /*  0 - 7  F0 */
665
  0x0c,0x0c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/*  8 -255    */
666
667
static const pcre_uint8 ebcdic_chartab[] = { /* chartable partial dup */
668
  0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*   0-  7 */
669
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*   8- 15 */
670
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*  16- 23 */
671
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  24- 31 */
672
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x01,0x00,0x00, /*  32- 39 */
673
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  40- 47 */
674
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  48- 55 */
675
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  56- 63 */
676
  0x01,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*    - 71 */
677
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x80,0x00,0x80,0x80,0x80, /*  72- |  */
678
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  & - 87 */
679
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x80,0x80,0x80,0x00,0x00, /*  88- 95 */
680
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  - -103 */
681
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x10,0x00,0x80, /* 104- ?  */
682
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 112-119 */
683
  0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 120- "  */
684
  0x00,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x12, /* 128- g  */
685
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  h -143 */
686
  0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* 144- p  */
687
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  q -159 */
688
  0x00,0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /* 160- x  */
689
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  y -175 */
690
  0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  ^ -183 */
691
  0x00,0x00,0x80,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /* 184-191 */
692
  0x80,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x1a,0x12, /*  { - G  */
693
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  H -207 */
694
  0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /*  } - P  */
695
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Q -223 */
696
  0x00,0x00,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12,0x12, /*  \ - X  */
697
  0x12,0x12,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00, /*  Y -239 */
698
  0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c,0x1c, /*  0 - 7  */
699
  0x1c,0x1c,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00,0x00};/*  8 -255 */
700
#endif
701
702
703
/* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible
704
between adjacent character-type opcodes. The left-hand (repeated) opcode is
705
used to select the row, and the right-hand opcode is use to select the column.
706
A value of 1 means that auto-possessification is OK. For example, the second
707
value in the first row means that \D+\d can be turned into \D++\d.
708
709
The Unicode property types (\P and \p) have to be present to fill out the table
710
because of what their opcode values are, but the table values should always be
711
zero because property types are handled separately in the code. The last four
712
columns apply to items that cannot be repeated, so there is no need to have
713
rows for them. Note that OP_DIGIT etc. are generated only when PCRE_UCP is
714
*not* set. When it is set, \d etc. are converted into OP_(NOT_)PROP codes. */
715
716
#define APTROWS (LAST_AUTOTAB_LEFT_OP - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP + 1)
717
#define APTCOLS (LAST_AUTOTAB_RIGHT_OP - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP + 1)
718
719
static const pcre_uint8 autoposstab[APTROWS][APTCOLS] = {
720
/* \D \d \S \s \W \w  . .+ \C \P \p \R \H \h \V \v \X \Z \z  $ $M */
721
  { 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \D */
722
  { 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* \d */
723
  { 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* \S */
724
  { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \s */
725
  { 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \W */
726
  { 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* \w */
727
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* .  */
728
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* .+ */
729
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \C */
730
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 },  /* \P */
731
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0 },  /* \p */
732
  { 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \R */
733
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \H */
734
  { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \h */
735
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \V */
736
  { 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 },  /* \v */
737
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0 }   /* \X */
738
};
739
740
741
/* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible
742
between adjacent Unicode property opcodes (OP_PROP and OP_NOTPROP). The
743
left-hand (repeated) opcode is used to select the row, and the right-hand
744
opcode is used to select the column. The values are as follows:
745
746
  0   Always return FALSE (never auto-possessify)
747
  1   Character groups are distinct (possessify if both are OP_PROP)
748
  2   Check character categories in the same group (general or particular)
749
  3   TRUE if the two opcodes are not the same (PROP vs NOTPROP)
750
751
  4   Check left general category vs right particular category
752
  5   Check right general category vs left particular category
753
754
  6   Left alphanum vs right general category
755
  7   Left space vs right general category
756
  8   Left word vs right general category
757
758
  9   Right alphanum vs left general category
759
 10   Right space vs left general category
760
 11   Right word vs left general category
761
762
 12   Left alphanum vs right particular category
763
 13   Left space vs right particular category
764
 14   Left word vs right particular category
765
766
 15   Right alphanum vs left particular category
767
 16   Right space vs left particular category
768
 17   Right word vs left particular category
769
*/
770
771
static const pcre_uint8 propposstab[PT_TABSIZE][PT_TABSIZE] = {
772
/* ANY LAMP GC  PC  SC ALNUM SPACE PXSPACE WORD CLIST UCNC */
773
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  0,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_ANY */
774
  { 0,  3,  0,  0,  0,    3,    1,      1,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_LAMP */
775
  { 0,  0,  2,  4,  0,    9,   10,     10,  11,    0,   0 },  /* PT_GC */
776
  { 0,  0,  5,  2,  0,   15,   16,     16,  17,    0,   0 },  /* PT_PC */
777
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  2,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_SC */
778
  { 0,  3,  6, 12,  0,    3,    1,      1,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_ALNUM */
779
  { 0,  1,  7, 13,  0,    1,    3,      3,   1,    0,   0 },  /* PT_SPACE */
780
  { 0,  1,  7, 13,  0,    1,    3,      3,   1,    0,   0 },  /* PT_PXSPACE */
781
  { 0,  0,  8, 14,  0,    0,    1,      1,   3,    0,   0 },  /* PT_WORD */
782
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  0,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   0 },  /* PT_CLIST */
783
  { 0,  0,  0,  0,  0,    0,    0,      0,   0,    0,   3 }   /* PT_UCNC */
784
};
785
786
/* This table is used to check whether auto-possessification is possible
787
between adjacent Unicode property opcodes (OP_PROP and OP_NOTPROP) when one
788
specifies a general category and the other specifies a particular category. The
789
row is selected by the general category and the column by the particular
790
category. The value is 1 if the particular category is not part of the general
791
category. */
792
793
static const pcre_uint8 catposstab[7][30] = {
794
/* Cc Cf Cn Co Cs Ll Lm Lo Lt Lu Mc Me Mn Nd Nl No Pc Pd Pe Pf Pi Po Ps Sc Sk Sm So Zl Zp Zs */
795
  { 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* C */
796
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* L */
797
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* M */
798
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* N */
799
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1 },  /* P */
800
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1 },  /* S */
801
  { 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0 }   /* Z */
802
};
803
804
/* This table is used when checking ALNUM, (PX)SPACE, SPACE, and WORD against
805
a general or particular category. The properties in each row are those
806
that apply to the character set in question. Duplication means that a little
807
unnecessary work is done when checking, but this keeps things much simpler
808
because they can all use the same code. For more details see the comment where
809
this table is used.
810
811
Note: SPACE and PXSPACE used to be different because Perl excluded VT from
812
"space", but from Perl 5.18 it's included, so both categories are treated the
813
same here. */
814
815
static const pcre_uint8 posspropstab[3][4] = {
816
  { ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_N, ucp_Nl },  /* ALNUM, 3rd and 4th values redundant */
817
  { ucp_Z, ucp_Z, ucp_C, ucp_Cc },  /* SPACE and PXSPACE, 2nd value redundant */
818
  { ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_P, ucp_Po }   /* WORD */
819
};
820
821
/* This table is used when converting repeating opcodes into possessified
822
versions as a result of an explicit possessive quantifier such as ++. A zero
823
value means there is no possessified version - in those cases the item in
824
question must be wrapped in ONCE brackets. The table is truncated at OP_CALLOUT
825
because all relevant opcodes are less than that. */
826
827
static const pcre_uint8 opcode_possessify[] = {
828
  0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,   /* 0 - 15  */
829
  0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0,   /* 16 - 31 */
830
831
  0,                       /* NOTI */
832
  OP_POSSTAR, 0,           /* STAR, MINSTAR */
833
  OP_POSPLUS, 0,           /* PLUS, MINPLUS */
834
  OP_POSQUERY, 0,          /* QUERY, MINQUERY */
835
  OP_POSUPTO, 0,           /* UPTO, MINUPTO */
836
  0,                       /* EXACT */
837
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* POS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
838
839
  OP_POSSTARI, 0,          /* STARI, MINSTARI */
840
  OP_POSPLUSI, 0,          /* PLUSI, MINPLUSI */
841
  OP_POSQUERYI, 0,         /* QUERYI, MINQUERYI */
842
  OP_POSUPTOI, 0,          /* UPTOI, MINUPTOI */
843
  0,                       /* EXACTI */
844
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* POS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
845
846
  OP_NOTPOSSTAR, 0,        /* NOTSTAR, NOTMINSTAR */
847
  OP_NOTPOSPLUS, 0,        /* NOTPLUS, NOTMINPLUS */
848
  OP_NOTPOSQUERY, 0,       /* NOTQUERY, NOTMINQUERY */
849
  OP_NOTPOSUPTO, 0,        /* NOTUPTO, NOTMINUPTO */
850
  0,                       /* NOTEXACT */
851
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* NOTPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
852
853
  OP_NOTPOSSTARI, 0,       /* NOTSTARI, NOTMINSTARI */
854
  OP_NOTPOSPLUSI, 0,       /* NOTPLUSI, NOTMINPLUSI */
855
  OP_NOTPOSQUERYI, 0,      /* NOTQUERYI, NOTMINQUERYI */
856
  OP_NOTPOSUPTOI, 0,       /* NOTUPTOI, NOTMINUPTOI */
857
  0,                       /* NOTEXACTI */
858
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* NOTPOS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */
859
860
  OP_TYPEPOSSTAR, 0,       /* TYPESTAR, TYPEMINSTAR */
861
  OP_TYPEPOSPLUS, 0,       /* TYPEPLUS, TYPEMINPLUS */
862
  OP_TYPEPOSQUERY, 0,      /* TYPEQUERY, TYPEMINQUERY */
863
  OP_TYPEPOSUPTO, 0,       /* TYPEUPTO, TYPEMINUPTO */
864
  0,                       /* TYPEEXACT */
865
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* TYPEPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */
866
867
  OP_CRPOSSTAR, 0,         /* CRSTAR, CRMINSTAR */
868
  OP_CRPOSPLUS, 0,         /* CRPLUS, CRMINPLUS */
869
  OP_CRPOSQUERY, 0,        /* CRQUERY, CRMINQUERY */
870
  OP_CRPOSRANGE, 0,        /* CRRANGE, CRMINRANGE */
871
  0, 0, 0, 0,              /* CRPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,RANGE} */
872
873
  0, 0, 0,                 /* CLASS, NCLASS, XCLASS */
874
  0, 0,                    /* REF, REFI */
875
  0, 0,                    /* DNREF, DNREFI */
876
  0, 0                     /* RECURSE, CALLOUT */
877
};
878
879
880
881
/*************************************************
882
*            Find an error text                  *
883
*************************************************/
884
885
/* The error texts are now all in one long string, to save on relocations. As
886
some of the text is of unknown length, we can't use a table of offsets.
887
Instead, just count through the strings. This is not a performance issue
888
because it happens only when there has been a compilation error.
889
890
Argument:   the error number
891
Returns:    pointer to the error string
892
*/
893
894
static const char *
895
find_error_text(int n)
896
4.73k
{
897
4.73k
const char *s = error_texts;
898
139k
for (; n > 0; n--)
899
135k
  {
900
4.64M
  while (*s++ != CHAR_NULL) {};
901
135k
  if (*s == CHAR_NULL) return "Error text not found (please report)";
902
135k
  }
903
4.73k
return s;
904
4.73k
}
905
906
907
908
/*************************************************
909
*           Expand the workspace                 *
910
*************************************************/
911
912
/* This function is called during the second compiling phase, if the number of
913
forward references fills the existing workspace, which is originally a block on
914
the stack. A larger block is obtained from malloc() unless the ultimate limit
915
has been reached or the increase will be rather small.
916
917
Argument: pointer to the compile data block
918
Returns:  0 if all went well, else an error number
919
*/
920
921
static int
922
expand_workspace(compile_data *cd)
923
37
{
924
37
pcre_uchar *newspace;
925
37
int newsize = cd->workspace_size * 2;
926
927
37
if (newsize > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX) newsize = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX;
928
37
if (cd->workspace_size >= COMPILE_WORK_SIZE_MAX ||
929
37
    newsize - cd->workspace_size < WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)
930
0
 return ERR72;
931
932
37
newspace = (PUBL(malloc))(IN_UCHARS(newsize));
933
37
if (newspace == NULL) return ERR21;
934
37
memcpy(newspace, cd->start_workspace, cd->workspace_size * sizeof(pcre_uchar));
935
37
cd->hwm = (pcre_uchar *)newspace + (cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace);
936
37
if (cd->workspace_size > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE)
937
16
  (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->start_workspace);
938
37
cd->start_workspace = newspace;
939
37
cd->workspace_size = newsize;
940
37
return 0;
941
37
}
942
943
944
945
/*************************************************
946
*            Check for counted repeat            *
947
*************************************************/
948
949
/* This function is called when a '{' is encountered in a place where it might
950
start a quantifier. It looks ahead to see if it really is a quantifier or not.
951
It is only a quantifier if it is one of the forms {ddd} {ddd,} or {ddd,ddd}
952
where the ddds are digits.
953
954
Arguments:
955
  p         pointer to the first char after '{'
956
957
Returns:    TRUE or FALSE
958
*/
959
960
static BOOL
961
is_counted_repeat(const pcre_uchar *p)
962
36.3k
{
963
36.3k
if (!IS_DIGIT(*p)) return FALSE;
964
26.8k
p++;
965
52.2k
while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++;
966
26.8k
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) return TRUE;
967
968
13.4k
if (*p++ != CHAR_COMMA) return FALSE;
969
9.49k
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) return TRUE;
970
971
7.60k
if (!IS_DIGIT(*p)) return FALSE;
972
5.72k
p++;
973
8.43k
while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++;
974
975
5.72k
return (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET);
976
7.60k
}
977
978
979
980
/*************************************************
981
*            Handle escapes                      *
982
*************************************************/
983
984
/* This function is called when a \ has been encountered. It either returns a
985
positive value for a simple escape such as \n, or 0 for a data character which
986
will be placed in chptr. A backreference to group n is returned as negative n.
987
When UTF-8 is enabled, a positive value greater than 255 may be returned in
988
chptr. On entry, ptr is pointing at the \. On exit, it is on the final
989
character of the escape sequence.
990
991
Arguments:
992
  ptrptr         points to the pattern position pointer
993
  chptr          points to a returned data character
994
  errorcodeptr   points to the errorcode variable
995
  bracount       number of previous extracting brackets
996
  options        the options bits
997
  isclass        TRUE if inside a character class
998
999
Returns:         zero => a data character
1000
                 positive => a special escape sequence
1001
                 negative => a back reference
1002
                 on error, errorcodeptr is set
1003
*/
1004
1005
static int
1006
check_escape(const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, pcre_uint32 *chptr, int *errorcodeptr,
1007
  int bracount, int options, BOOL isclass)
1008
365k
{
1009
/* PCRE_UTF16 has the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */
1010
365k
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
1011
365k
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr + 1;
1012
365k
pcre_uint32 c;
1013
365k
int escape = 0;
1014
365k
int i;
1015
1016
365k
GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr);           /* Get character value, increment pointer */
1017
365k
ptr--;                            /* Set pointer back to the last byte */
1018
1019
/* If backslash is at the end of the pattern, it's an error. */
1020
1021
365k
if (c == CHAR_NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR1;
1022
1023
/* Non-alphanumerics are literals. For digits or letters, do an initial lookup
1024
in a table. A non-zero result is something that can be returned immediately.
1025
Otherwise further processing may be required. */
1026
1027
365k
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1028
/* Not alphanumeric */
1029
365k
else if (c < CHAR_0 || c > CHAR_z) {}
1030
302k
else if ((i = escapes[c - CHAR_0]) != 0)
1031
285k
  { if (i > 0) c = (pcre_uint32)i; else escape = -i; }
1032
1033
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1034
/* Not alphanumeric */
1035
else if (c < CHAR_a || (!MAX_255(c) || (ebcdic_chartab[c] & 0x0E) == 0)) {}
1036
else if ((i = escapes[c - 0x48]) != 0)  { if (i > 0) c = (pcre_uint32)i; else escape = -i; }
1037
#endif
1038
1039
/* Escapes that need further processing, or are illegal. */
1040
1041
16.7k
else
1042
16.7k
  {
1043
16.7k
  const pcre_uchar *oldptr;
1044
16.7k
  BOOL braced, negated, overflow;
1045
16.7k
  int s;
1046
1047
16.7k
  switch (c)
1048
16.7k
    {
1049
    /* A number of Perl escapes are not handled by PCRE. We give an explicit
1050
    error. */
1051
1052
1
    case CHAR_l:
1053
2
    case CHAR_L:
1054
2
    *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1055
2
    break;
1056
1057
1
    case CHAR_u:
1058
1
    if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
1059
0
      {
1060
      /* In JavaScript, \u must be followed by four hexadecimal numbers.
1061
      Otherwise it is a lowercase u letter. */
1062
0
      if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1063
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[2]) && (digitab[ptr[2]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1064
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[3]) && (digitab[ptr[3]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1065
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[4]) && (digitab[ptr[4]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1066
0
        {
1067
0
        c = 0;
1068
0
        for (i = 0; i < 4; ++i)
1069
0
          {
1070
0
          register pcre_uint32 cc = *(++ptr);
1071
0
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1072
0
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;               /* Convert to upper case */
1073
0
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1074
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1075
          if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;  /* Convert to upper case */
1076
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1077
#endif
1078
0
          }
1079
1080
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
1081
0
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU))
1082
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
1083
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU))
1084
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1085
        if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU)
1086
#endif
1087
0
          {
1088
0
          *errorcodeptr = ERR76;
1089
0
          }
1090
0
        else if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
1091
0
        }
1092
0
      }
1093
1
    else
1094
1
      *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1095
1
    break;
1096
1097
1
    case CHAR_U:
1098
    /* In JavaScript, \U is an uppercase U letter. */
1099
1
    if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) == 0) *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1100
1
    break;
1101
1102
    /* In a character class, \g is just a literal "g". Outside a character
1103
    class, \g must be followed by one of a number of specific things:
1104
1105
    (1) A number, either plain or braced. If positive, it is an absolute
1106
    backreference. If negative, it is a relative backreference. This is a Perl
1107
    5.10 feature.
1108
1109
    (2) Perl 5.10 also supports \g{name} as a reference to a named group. This
1110
    is part of Perl's movement towards a unified syntax for back references. As
1111
    this is synonymous with \k{name}, we fudge it up by pretending it really
1112
    was \k.
1113
1114
    (3) For Oniguruma compatibility we also support \g followed by a name or a
1115
    number either in angle brackets or in single quotes. However, these are
1116
    (possibly recursive) subroutine calls, _not_ backreferences. Just return
1117
    the ESC_g code (cf \k). */
1118
1119
5.65k
    case CHAR_g:
1120
5.65k
    if (isclass) break;
1121
5.42k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN || ptr[1] == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
1122
1.56k
      {
1123
1.56k
      escape = ESC_g;
1124
1.56k
      break;
1125
1.56k
      }
1126
1127
    /* Handle the Perl-compatible cases */
1128
1129
3.85k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1130
1.06k
      {
1131
1.06k
      const pcre_uchar *p;
1132
1.66k
      for (p = ptr+2; *p != CHAR_NULL && *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET; p++)
1133
1.44k
        if (*p != CHAR_MINUS && !IS_DIGIT(*p)) break;
1134
1.06k
      if (*p != CHAR_NULL && *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1135
844
        {
1136
844
        escape = ESC_k;
1137
844
        break;
1138
844
        }
1139
223
      braced = TRUE;
1140
223
      ptr++;
1141
223
      }
1142
2.79k
    else braced = FALSE;
1143
1144
3.01k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_MINUS)
1145
1.87k
      {
1146
1.87k
      negated = TRUE;
1147
1.87k
      ptr++;
1148
1.87k
      }
1149
1.13k
    else negated = FALSE;
1150
1151
    /* The integer range is limited by the machine's int representation. */
1152
3.01k
    s = 0;
1153
3.01k
    overflow = FALSE;
1154
9.18k
    while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1155
6.18k
      {
1156
6.18k
      if (s > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */
1157
19
        {
1158
19
        overflow = TRUE;
1159
19
        break;
1160
19
        }
1161
6.16k
      s = s * 10 + (int)(*(++ptr) - CHAR_0);
1162
6.16k
      }
1163
3.01k
    if (overflow) /* Integer overflow */
1164
19
      {
1165
346
      while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1166
327
        ptr++;
1167
19
      *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
1168
19
      break;
1169
19
      }
1170
1171
2.99k
    if (braced && *(++ptr) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1172
14
      {
1173
14
      *errorcodeptr = ERR57;
1174
14
      break;
1175
14
      }
1176
1177
2.98k
    if (s == 0)
1178
33
      {
1179
33
      *errorcodeptr = ERR58;
1180
33
      break;
1181
33
      }
1182
1183
2.94k
    if (negated)
1184
1.86k
      {
1185
1.86k
      if (s > bracount)
1186
43
        {
1187
43
        *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
1188
43
        break;
1189
43
        }
1190
1.82k
      s = bracount - (s - 1);
1191
1.82k
      }
1192
1193
2.90k
    escape = -s;
1194
2.90k
    break;
1195
1196
    /* The handling of escape sequences consisting of a string of digits
1197
    starting with one that is not zero is not straightforward. Perl has changed
1198
    over the years. Nowadays \g{} for backreferences and \o{} for octal are
1199
    recommended to avoid the ambiguities in the old syntax.
1200
1201
    Outside a character class, the digits are read as a decimal number. If the
1202
    number is less than 8 (used to be 10), or if there are that many previous
1203
    extracting left brackets, then it is a back reference. Otherwise, up to
1204
    three octal digits are read to form an escaped byte. Thus \123 is likely to
1205
    be octal 123 (cf \0123, which is octal 012 followed by the literal 3). If
1206
    the octal value is greater than 377, the least significant 8 bits are
1207
    taken. \8 and \9 are treated as the literal characters 8 and 9.
1208
1209
    Inside a character class, \ followed by a digit is always either a literal
1210
    8 or 9 or an octal number. */
1211
1212
5.40k
    case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4: case CHAR_5:
1213
7.58k
    case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
1214
1215
7.58k
    if (!isclass)
1216
6.92k
      {
1217
6.92k
      oldptr = ptr;
1218
      /* The integer range is limited by the machine's int representation. */
1219
6.92k
      s = (int)(c -CHAR_0);
1220
6.92k
      overflow = FALSE;
1221
9.57k
      while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1222
2.66k
        {
1223
2.66k
        if (s > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */
1224
10
          {
1225
10
          overflow = TRUE;
1226
10
          break;
1227
10
          }
1228
2.65k
        s = s * 10 + (int)(*(++ptr) - CHAR_0);
1229
2.65k
        }
1230
6.92k
      if (overflow) /* Integer overflow */
1231
10
        {
1232
220
        while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
1233
210
          ptr++;
1234
10
        *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
1235
10
        break;
1236
10
        }
1237
6.91k
      if (s < 8 || s <= bracount)  /* Check for back reference */
1238
5.70k
        {
1239
5.70k
        escape = -s;
1240
5.70k
        break;
1241
5.70k
        }
1242
1.21k
      ptr = oldptr;      /* Put the pointer back and fall through */
1243
1.21k
      }
1244
1245
    /* Handle a digit following \ when the number is not a back reference. If
1246
    the first digit is 8 or 9, Perl used to generate a binary zero byte and
1247
    then treat the digit as a following literal. At least by Perl 5.18 this
1248
    changed so as not to insert the binary zero. */
1249
1250
1.87k
    if ((c = *ptr) >= CHAR_8) break;
1251
1252
    /* Fall through with a digit less than 8 */
1253
1254
    /* \0 always starts an octal number, but we may drop through to here with a
1255
    larger first octal digit. The original code used just to take the least
1256
    significant 8 bits of octal numbers (I think this is what early Perls used
1257
    to do). Nowadays we allow for larger numbers in UTF-8 mode and 16-bit mode,
1258
    but no more than 3 octal digits. */
1259
1260
1.78k
    case CHAR_0:
1261
1.78k
    c -= CHAR_0;
1262
3.04k
    while(i++ < 2 && ptr[1] >= CHAR_0 && ptr[1] <= CHAR_7)
1263
1.25k
        c = c * 8 + *(++ptr) - CHAR_0;
1264
1.78k
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
1265
1.78k
    if (!utf && c > 0xff) *errorcodeptr = ERR51;
1266
1.78k
#endif
1267
1.78k
    break;
1268
1269
    /* \o is a relatively new Perl feature, supporting a more general way of
1270
    specifying character codes in octal. The only supported form is \o{ddd}. */
1271
1272
481
    case CHAR_o:
1273
481
    if (ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) *errorcodeptr = ERR81; else
1274
469
    if (ptr[2] == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) *errorcodeptr = ERR86; else
1275
468
      {
1276
468
      ptr += 2;
1277
468
      c = 0;
1278
468
      overflow = FALSE;
1279
1.71k
      while (*ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7)
1280
1.26k
        {
1281
1.26k
        register pcre_uint32 cc = *ptr++;
1282
1.26k
        if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue;     /* Leading zeroes */
1283
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
1284
        if (c >= 0x20000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1285
#endif
1286
1.02k
        c = (c << 3) + cc - CHAR_0 ;
1287
1.02k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
1288
1.02k
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1289
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
1290
        if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1291
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1292
        if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1293
#endif
1294
1.02k
        }
1295
468
      if (overflow)
1296
25
        {
1297
227
        while (*ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) ptr++;
1298
25
        *errorcodeptr = ERR34;
1299
25
        }
1300
443
      else if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1301
421
        {
1302
421
        if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
1303
421
        }
1304
22
      else *errorcodeptr = ERR80;
1305
468
      }
1306
481
    break;
1307
1308
    /* \x is complicated. In JavaScript, \x must be followed by two hexadecimal
1309
    numbers. Otherwise it is a lowercase x letter. */
1310
1311
1.44k
    case CHAR_x:
1312
1.44k
    if ((options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
1313
0
      {
1314
0
      if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0
1315
0
        && MAX_255(ptr[2]) && (digitab[ptr[2]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1316
0
        {
1317
0
        c = 0;
1318
0
        for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
1319
0
          {
1320
0
          register pcre_uint32 cc = *(++ptr);
1321
0
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1322
0
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;               /* Convert to upper case */
1323
0
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1324
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1325
          if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;  /* Convert to upper case */
1326
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1327
#endif
1328
0
          }
1329
0
        }
1330
0
      }    /* End JavaScript handling */
1331
1332
    /* Handle \x in Perl's style. \x{ddd} is a character number which can be
1333
    greater than 0xff in utf or non-8bit mode, but only if the ddd are hex
1334
    digits. If not, { used to be treated as a data character. However, Perl
1335
    seems to read hex digits up to the first non-such, and ignore the rest, so
1336
    that, for example \x{zz} matches a binary zero. This seems crazy, so PCRE
1337
    now gives an error. */
1338
1339
1.44k
    else
1340
1.44k
      {
1341
1.44k
      if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1342
577
        {
1343
577
        ptr += 2;
1344
577
        if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1345
1
          {
1346
1
          *errorcodeptr = ERR86;
1347
1
          break;
1348
1
          }
1349
576
        c = 0;
1350
576
        overflow = FALSE;
1351
1.87k
        while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (digitab[*ptr] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1352
1.31k
          {
1353
1.31k
          register pcre_uint32 cc = *ptr++;
1354
1.31k
          if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue;     /* Leading zeroes */
1355
1356
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
1357
          if (c >= 0x10000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1358
#endif
1359
1360
1.11k
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1361
1.11k
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;               /* Convert to upper case */
1362
1.11k
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1363
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1364
          if (cc >= CHAR_a && cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;  /* Convert to upper case */
1365
          c = (c << 4) + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1366
#endif
1367
1368
1.11k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
1369
1.11k
          if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1370
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
1371
          if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1372
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1373
          if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; }
1374
#endif
1375
1.11k
          }
1376
1377
576
        if (overflow)
1378
19
          {
1379
223
          while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (digitab[*ptr] & ctype_xdigit) != 0) ptr++;
1380
19
          *errorcodeptr = ERR34;
1381
19
          }
1382
1383
557
        else if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1384
547
          {
1385
547
          if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff) *errorcodeptr = ERR73;
1386
547
          }
1387
1388
        /* If the sequence of hex digits does not end with '}', give an error.
1389
        We used just to recognize this construct and fall through to the normal
1390
        \x handling, but nowadays Perl gives an error, which seems much more
1391
        sensible, so we do too. */
1392
1393
10
        else *errorcodeptr = ERR79;
1394
576
        }   /* End of \x{} processing */
1395
1396
      /* Read a single-byte hex-defined char (up to two hex digits after \x) */
1397
1398
864
      else
1399
864
        {
1400
864
        c = 0;
1401
1.81k
        while (i++ < 2 && MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (digitab[ptr[1]] & ctype_xdigit) != 0)
1402
955
          {
1403
955
          pcre_uint32 cc;                          /* Some compilers don't like */
1404
955
          cc = *(++ptr);                           /* ++ in initializers */
1405
955
#ifndef EBCDIC  /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1406
955
          if (cc >= CHAR_a) cc -= 32;              /* Convert to upper case */
1407
955
          c = c * 16 + cc - ((cc < CHAR_A)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1408
#else           /* EBCDIC coding */
1409
          if (cc <= CHAR_z) cc += 64;              /* Convert to upper case */
1410
          c = c * 16 + cc - ((cc >= CHAR_0)? CHAR_0 : (CHAR_A - 10));
1411
#endif
1412
955
          }
1413
864
        }     /* End of \xdd handling */
1414
1.44k
      }       /* End of Perl-style \x handling */
1415
1.44k
    break;
1416
1417
    /* For \c, a following letter is upper-cased; then the 0x40 bit is flipped.
1418
    An error is given if the byte following \c is not an ASCII character. This
1419
    coding is ASCII-specific, but then the whole concept of \cx is
1420
    ASCII-specific. (However, an EBCDIC equivalent has now been added.) */
1421
1422
1.44k
    case CHAR_c:
1423
766
    c = *(++ptr);
1424
766
    if (c == CHAR_NULL)
1425
1
      {
1426
1
      *errorcodeptr = ERR2;
1427
1
      break;
1428
1
      }
1429
765
#ifndef EBCDIC    /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */
1430
765
    if (c > 127)  /* Excludes all non-ASCII in either mode */
1431
6
      {
1432
6
      *errorcodeptr = ERR68;
1433
6
      break;
1434
6
      }
1435
759
    if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c -= 32;
1436
759
    c ^= 0x40;
1437
#else             /* EBCDIC coding */
1438
    if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c += 64;
1439
    if (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
1440
      c = ('\\' == 188 && '`' == 74)? 0x5f : 0xff;
1441
    else
1442
      {
1443
      for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
1444
        {
1445
        if (c == ebcdic_escape_c[i]) break;
1446
        }
1447
      if (i < 32) c = i; else *errorcodeptr = ERR68;
1448
      }
1449
#endif
1450
759
    break;
1451
1452
    /* PCRE_EXTRA enables extensions to Perl in the matter of escapes. Any
1453
    other alphanumeric following \ is an error if PCRE_EXTRA was set;
1454
    otherwise, for Perl compatibility, it is a literal. This code looks a bit
1455
    odd, but there used to be some cases other than the default, and there may
1456
    be again in future, so I haven't "optimized" it. */
1457
1458
333
    default:
1459
333
    if ((options & PCRE_EXTRA) != 0) switch(c)
1460
1
      {
1461
1
      default:
1462
1
      *errorcodeptr = ERR3;
1463
1
      break;
1464
1
      }
1465
333
    break;
1466
16.7k
    }
1467
16.7k
  }
1468
1469
/* Perl supports \N{name} for character names, as well as plain \N for "not
1470
newline". PCRE does not support \N{name}. However, it does support
1471
quantification such as \N{2,3}. */
1472
1473
365k
if (escape == ESC_N && ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET &&
1474
365k
     !is_counted_repeat(ptr+2))
1475
1
  *errorcodeptr = ERR37;
1476
1477
/* If PCRE_UCP is set, we change the values for \d etc. */
1478
1479
365k
if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0 && escape >= ESC_D && escape <= ESC_w)
1480
0
  escape += (ESC_DU - ESC_D);
1481
1482
/* Set the pointer to the final character before returning. */
1483
1484
365k
*ptrptr = ptr;
1485
365k
*chptr = c;
1486
365k
return escape;
1487
365k
}
1488
1489
1490
1491
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
1492
/*************************************************
1493
*               Handle \P and \p                 *
1494
*************************************************/
1495
1496
/* This function is called after \P or \p has been encountered, provided that
1497
PCRE is compiled with support for Unicode properties. On entry, ptrptr is
1498
pointing at the P or p. On exit, it is pointing at the final character of the
1499
escape sequence.
1500
1501
Argument:
1502
  ptrptr         points to the pattern position pointer
1503
  negptr         points to a boolean that is set TRUE for negation else FALSE
1504
  ptypeptr       points to an unsigned int that is set to the type value
1505
  pdataptr       points to an unsigned int that is set to the detailed property value
1506
  errorcodeptr   points to the error code variable
1507
1508
Returns:         TRUE if the type value was found, or FALSE for an invalid type
1509
*/
1510
1511
static BOOL
1512
get_ucp(const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, BOOL *negptr, unsigned int *ptypeptr,
1513
  unsigned int *pdataptr, int *errorcodeptr)
1514
{
1515
pcre_uchar c;
1516
int i, bot, top;
1517
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr;
1518
pcre_uchar name[32];
1519
1520
c = *(++ptr);
1521
if (c == CHAR_NULL) goto ERROR_RETURN;
1522
1523
*negptr = FALSE;
1524
1525
/* \P or \p can be followed by a name in {}, optionally preceded by ^ for
1526
negation. */
1527
1528
if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1529
  {
1530
  if (ptr[1] == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
1531
    {
1532
    *negptr = TRUE;
1533
    ptr++;
1534
    }
1535
  for (i = 0; i < (int)(sizeof(name) / sizeof(pcre_uchar)) - 1; i++)
1536
    {
1537
    c = *(++ptr);
1538
    if (c == CHAR_NULL) goto ERROR_RETURN;
1539
    if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break;
1540
    name[i] = c;
1541
    }
1542
  if (c != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) goto ERROR_RETURN;
1543
  name[i] = 0;
1544
  }
1545
1546
/* Otherwise there is just one following character */
1547
1548
else
1549
  {
1550
  name[0] = c;
1551
  name[1] = 0;
1552
  }
1553
1554
*ptrptr = ptr;
1555
1556
/* Search for a recognized property name using binary chop */
1557
1558
bot = 0;
1559
top = PRIV(utt_size);
1560
1561
while (bot < top)
1562
  {
1563
  int r;
1564
  i = (bot + top) >> 1;
1565
  r = STRCMP_UC_C8(name, PRIV(utt_names) + PRIV(utt)[i].name_offset);
1566
  if (r == 0)
1567
    {
1568
    *ptypeptr = PRIV(utt)[i].type;
1569
    *pdataptr = PRIV(utt)[i].value;
1570
    return TRUE;
1571
    }
1572
  if (r > 0) bot = i + 1; else top = i;
1573
  }
1574
1575
*errorcodeptr = ERR47;
1576
*ptrptr = ptr;
1577
return FALSE;
1578
1579
ERROR_RETURN:
1580
*errorcodeptr = ERR46;
1581
*ptrptr = ptr;
1582
return FALSE;
1583
}
1584
#endif
1585
1586
1587
1588
/*************************************************
1589
*         Read repeat counts                     *
1590
*************************************************/
1591
1592
/* Read an item of the form {n,m} and return the values. This is called only
1593
after is_counted_repeat() has confirmed that a repeat-count quantifier exists,
1594
so the syntax is guaranteed to be correct, but we need to check the values.
1595
1596
Arguments:
1597
  p              pointer to first char after '{'
1598
  minp           pointer to int for min
1599
  maxp           pointer to int for max
1600
                 returned as -1 if no max
1601
  errorcodeptr   points to error code variable
1602
1603
Returns:         pointer to '}' on success;
1604
                 current ptr on error, with errorcodeptr set non-zero
1605
*/
1606
1607
static const pcre_uchar *
1608
read_repeat_counts(const pcre_uchar *p, int *minp, int *maxp, int *errorcodeptr)
1609
19.5k
{
1610
19.5k
int min = 0;
1611
19.5k
int max = -1;
1612
1613
47.9k
while (IS_DIGIT(*p))
1614
28.3k
  {
1615
28.3k
  min = min * 10 + (int)(*p++ - CHAR_0);
1616
28.3k
  if (min > 65535)
1617
3
    {
1618
3
    *errorcodeptr = ERR5;
1619
3
    return p;
1620
3
    }
1621
28.3k
  }
1622
1623
19.5k
if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) max = min; else
1624
6.54k
  {
1625
6.54k
  if (*(++p) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)
1626
4.65k
    {
1627
4.65k
    max = 0;
1628
11.3k
    while(IS_DIGIT(*p))
1629
6.67k
      {
1630
6.67k
      max = max * 10 + (int)(*p++ - CHAR_0);
1631
6.67k
      if (max > 65535)
1632
2
        {
1633
2
        *errorcodeptr = ERR5;
1634
2
        return p;
1635
2
        }
1636
6.67k
      }
1637
4.65k
    if (max < min)
1638
3
      {
1639
3
      *errorcodeptr = ERR4;
1640
3
      return p;
1641
3
      }
1642
4.65k
    }
1643
6.54k
  }
1644
1645
19.5k
*minp = min;
1646
19.5k
*maxp = max;
1647
19.5k
return p;
1648
19.5k
}
1649
1650
1651
1652
/*************************************************
1653
*      Find first significant op code            *
1654
*************************************************/
1655
1656
/* This is called by several functions that scan a compiled expression looking
1657
for a fixed first character, or an anchoring op code etc. It skips over things
1658
that do not influence this. For some calls, it makes sense to skip negative
1659
forward and all backward assertions, and also the \b assertion; for others it
1660
does not.
1661
1662
Arguments:
1663
  code         pointer to the start of the group
1664
  skipassert   TRUE if certain assertions are to be skipped
1665
1666
Returns:       pointer to the first significant opcode
1667
*/
1668
1669
static const pcre_uchar*
1670
first_significant_code(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL skipassert)
1671
853k
{
1672
853k
for (;;)
1673
864k
  {
1674
864k
  switch ((int)*code)
1675
864k
    {
1676
760
    case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
1677
2.36k
    case OP_ASSERTBACK:
1678
6.00k
    case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
1679
6.00k
    if (!skipassert) return code;
1680
6.57k
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
1681
4.83k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
1682
4.83k
    break;
1683
1684
1.33k
    case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1685
2.09k
    case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1686
2.09k
    if (!skipassert) return code;
1687
    /* Fall through */
1688
1689
2.62k
    case OP_CALLOUT:
1690
3.19k
    case OP_CREF:
1691
3.47k
    case OP_DNCREF:
1692
5.10k
    case OP_RREF:
1693
5.36k
    case OP_DNRREF:
1694
5.46k
    case OP_DEF:
1695
5.46k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code];
1696
5.46k
    break;
1697
1698
852k
    default:
1699
852k
    return code;
1700
864k
    }
1701
864k
  }
1702
/* Control never reaches here */
1703
853k
}
1704
1705
1706
1707
/*************************************************
1708
*        Find the fixed length of a branch       *
1709
*************************************************/
1710
1711
/* Scan a branch and compute the fixed length of subject that will match it,
1712
if the length is fixed. This is needed for dealing with backward assertions.
1713
In UTF8 mode, the result is in characters rather than bytes. The branch is
1714
temporarily terminated with OP_END when this function is called.
1715
1716
This function is called when a backward assertion is encountered, so that if it
1717
fails, the error message can point to the correct place in the pattern.
1718
However, we cannot do this when the assertion contains subroutine calls,
1719
because they can be forward references. We solve this by remembering this case
1720
and doing the check at the end; a flag specifies which mode we are running in.
1721
1722
Arguments:
1723
  code     points to the start of the pattern (the bracket)
1724
  utf      TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
1725
  atend    TRUE if called when the pattern is complete
1726
  cd       the "compile data" structure
1727
  recurses    chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
1728
1729
Returns:   the fixed length,
1730
             or -1 if there is no fixed length,
1731
             or -2 if \C was encountered (in UTF-8 mode only)
1732
             or -3 if an OP_RECURSE item was encountered and atend is FALSE
1733
             or -4 if an unknown opcode was encountered (internal error)
1734
*/
1735
1736
static int
1737
find_fixedlength(pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, BOOL atend, compile_data *cd,
1738
  recurse_check *recurses)
1739
124M
{
1740
124M
int length = -1;
1741
124M
recurse_check this_recurse;
1742
124M
register int branchlength = 0;
1743
124M
register pcre_uchar *cc = code + 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1744
1745
/* Scan along the opcodes for this branch. If we get to the end of the
1746
branch, check the length against that of the other branches. */
1747
1748
124M
for (;;)
1749
542M
  {
1750
542M
  int d;
1751
542M
  pcre_uchar *ce, *cs;
1752
542M
  register pcre_uchar op = *cc;
1753
1754
542M
  switch (op)
1755
542M
    {
1756
    /* We only need to continue for OP_CBRA (normal capturing bracket) and
1757
    OP_BRA (normal non-capturing bracket) because the other variants of these
1758
    opcodes are all concerned with unlimited repeated groups, which of course
1759
    are not of fixed length. */
1760
1761
123M
    case OP_CBRA:
1762
123M
    case OP_BRA:
1763
123M
    case OP_ONCE:
1764
123M
    case OP_ONCE_NC:
1765
123M
    case OP_COND:
1766
123M
    d = find_fixedlength(cc + ((op == OP_CBRA)? IMM2_SIZE : 0), utf, atend, cd,
1767
123M
      recurses);
1768
123M
    if (d < 0) return d;
1769
123M
    branchlength += d;
1770
123M
    do cc += GET(cc, 1); while (*cc == OP_ALT);
1771
123M
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1772
123M
    break;
1773
1774
    /* Reached end of a branch; if it's a ket it is the end of a nested call.
1775
    If it's ALT it is an alternation in a nested call. An ACCEPT is effectively
1776
    an ALT. If it is END it's the end of the outer call. All can be handled by
1777
    the same code. Note that we must not include the OP_KETRxxx opcodes here,
1778
    because they all imply an unlimited repeat. */
1779
1780
28.4k
    case OP_ALT:
1781
124M
    case OP_KET:
1782
124M
    case OP_END:
1783
124M
    case OP_ACCEPT:
1784
124M
    case OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT:
1785
124M
    if (length < 0) length = branchlength;
1786
28.3k
      else if (length != branchlength) return -1;
1787
124M
    if (*cc != OP_ALT) return length;
1788
28.4k
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1789
28.4k
    branchlength = 0;
1790
28.4k
    break;
1791
1792
    /* A true recursion implies not fixed length, but a subroutine call may
1793
    be OK. If the subroutine is a forward reference, we can't deal with
1794
    it until the end of the pattern, so return -3. */
1795
1796
335k
    case OP_RECURSE:
1797
335k
    if (!atend) return -3;
1798
335k
    cs = ce = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_code + GET(cc, 1);  /* Start subpattern */
1799
363k
    do ce += GET(ce, 1); while (*ce == OP_ALT);           /* End subpattern */
1800
335k
    if (cc > cs && cc < ce) return -1;                    /* Recursion */
1801
335k
    else   /* Check for mutual recursion */
1802
335k
      {
1803
335k
      recurse_check *r = recurses;
1804
410k
      for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev) if (r->group == cs) break;
1805
335k
      if (r != NULL) return -1;   /* Mutual recursion */
1806
335k
      }
1807
335k
    this_recurse.prev = recurses;
1808
335k
    this_recurse.group = cs;
1809
335k
    d = find_fixedlength(cs + IMM2_SIZE, utf, atend, cd, &this_recurse);
1810
335k
    if (d < 0) return d;
1811
335k
    branchlength += d;
1812
335k
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1813
335k
    break;
1814
1815
    /* Skip over assertive subpatterns */
1816
1817
1.02k
    case OP_ASSERT:
1818
1.34k
    case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
1819
2.47k
    case OP_ASSERTBACK:
1820
3.37k
    case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
1821
4.71k
    do cc += GET(cc, 1); while (*cc == OP_ALT);
1822
3.37k
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
1823
3.37k
    break;
1824
1825
    /* Skip over things that don't match chars */
1826
1827
234
    case OP_MARK:
1828
895
    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
1829
1.16k
    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
1830
2.25k
    case OP_THEN_ARG:
1831
2.25k
    cc += cc[1] + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*cc];
1832
2.25k
    break;
1833
1834
520
    case OP_CALLOUT:
1835
2.12k
    case OP_CIRC:
1836
2.46k
    case OP_CIRCM:
1837
4.24k
    case OP_CLOSE:
1838
4.26k
    case OP_COMMIT:
1839
4.56k
    case OP_CREF:
1840
4.91k
    case OP_DEF:
1841
5.20k
    case OP_DNCREF:
1842
5.67k
    case OP_DNRREF:
1843
1.84M
    case OP_DOLL:
1844
1.84M
    case OP_DOLLM:
1845
1.84M
    case OP_EOD:
1846
1.84M
    case OP_EODN:
1847
1.84M
    case OP_FAIL:
1848
1.84M
    case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1849
1.84M
    case OP_PRUNE:
1850
1.84M
    case OP_REVERSE:
1851
1.84M
    case OP_RREF:
1852
1.84M
    case OP_SET_SOM:
1853
1.84M
    case OP_SKIP:
1854
1.84M
    case OP_SOD:
1855
1.84M
    case OP_SOM:
1856
1.84M
    case OP_THEN:
1857
1.84M
    case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY:
1858
1.84M
    cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*cc];
1859
1.84M
    break;
1860
1861
    /* Handle literal characters */
1862
1863
227M
    case OP_CHAR:
1864
227M
    case OP_CHARI:
1865
227M
    case OP_NOT:
1866
227M
    case OP_NOTI:
1867
227M
    branchlength++;
1868
227M
    cc += 2;
1869
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
1870
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(cc[-1])) cc += GET_EXTRALEN(cc[-1]);
1871
#endif
1872
227M
    break;
1873
1874
    /* Handle exact repetitions. The count is already in characters, but we
1875
    need to skip over a multibyte character in UTF8 mode.  */
1876
1877
61.0M
    case OP_EXACT:
1878
61.0M
    case OP_EXACTI:
1879
61.0M
    case OP_NOTEXACT:
1880
61.0M
    case OP_NOTEXACTI:
1881
61.0M
    branchlength += (int)GET2(cc,1);
1882
61.0M
    cc += 2 + IMM2_SIZE;
1883
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
1884
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(cc[-1])) cc += GET_EXTRALEN(cc[-1]);
1885
#endif
1886
61.0M
    break;
1887
1888
900
    case OP_TYPEEXACT:
1889
900
    branchlength += GET2(cc,1);
1890
900
    if (cc[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || cc[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
1891
282
      cc += 2;
1892
900
    cc += 1 + IMM2_SIZE + 1;
1893
900
    break;
1894
1895
    /* Handle single-char matchers */
1896
1897
292
    case OP_PROP:
1898
537
    case OP_NOTPROP:
1899
537
    cc += 2;
1900
    /* Fall through */
1901
1902
1.40k
    case OP_HSPACE:
1903
2.24k
    case OP_VSPACE:
1904
3.06k
    case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
1905
3.37k
    case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
1906
5.45k
    case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
1907
5.72k
    case OP_DIGIT:
1908
6.00k
    case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
1909
6.25k
    case OP_WHITESPACE:
1910
6.82k
    case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
1911
7.25k
    case OP_WORDCHAR:
1912
4.19M
    case OP_ANY:
1913
4.19M
    case OP_ALLANY:
1914
4.19M
    branchlength++;
1915
4.19M
    cc++;
1916
4.19M
    break;
1917
1918
    /* The single-byte matcher isn't allowed. This only happens in UTF-8 mode;
1919
    otherwise \C is coded as OP_ALLANY. */
1920
1921
1
    case OP_ANYBYTE:
1922
1
    return -2;
1923
1924
    /* Check a class for variable quantification */
1925
1926
23.6k
    case OP_CLASS:
1927
23.9k
    case OP_NCLASS:
1928
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || defined COMPILE_PCRE16 || defined COMPILE_PCRE32
1929
    case OP_XCLASS:
1930
    /* The original code caused an unsigned overflow in 64 bit systems,
1931
    so now we use a conditional statement. */
1932
    if (op == OP_XCLASS)
1933
      cc += GET(cc, 1);
1934
    else
1935
      cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS];
1936
#else
1937
23.9k
    cc += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS];
1938
23.9k
#endif
1939
1940
23.9k
    switch (*cc)
1941
23.9k
      {
1942
1
      case OP_CRSTAR:
1943
2
      case OP_CRMINSTAR:
1944
5
      case OP_CRPLUS:
1945
6
      case OP_CRMINPLUS:
1946
7
      case OP_CRQUERY:
1947
8
      case OP_CRMINQUERY:
1948
9
      case OP_CRPOSSTAR:
1949
11
      case OP_CRPOSPLUS:
1950
12
      case OP_CRPOSQUERY:
1951
12
      return -1;
1952
1953
5.13k
      case OP_CRRANGE:
1954
7.27k
      case OP_CRMINRANGE:
1955
21.3k
      case OP_CRPOSRANGE:
1956
21.3k
      if (GET2(cc,1) != GET2(cc,1+IMM2_SIZE)) return -1;
1957
21.3k
      branchlength += (int)GET2(cc,1);
1958
21.3k
      cc += 1 + 2 * IMM2_SIZE;
1959
21.3k
      break;
1960
1961
2.58k
      default:
1962
2.58k
      branchlength++;
1963
23.9k
      }
1964
23.9k
    break;
1965
1966
    /* Anything else is variable length */
1967
1968
23.9k
    case OP_ANYNL:
1969
3
    case OP_BRAMINZERO:
1970
4
    case OP_BRAPOS:
1971
5
    case OP_BRAPOSZERO:
1972
17
    case OP_BRAZERO:
1973
19
    case OP_CBRAPOS:
1974
20
    case OP_EXTUNI:
1975
37
    case OP_KETRMAX:
1976
38
    case OP_KETRMIN:
1977
39
    case OP_KETRPOS:
1978
40
    case OP_MINPLUS:
1979
41
    case OP_MINPLUSI:
1980
42
    case OP_MINQUERY:
1981
43
    case OP_MINQUERYI:
1982
44
    case OP_MINSTAR:
1983
45
    case OP_MINSTARI:
1984
46
    case OP_MINUPTO:
1985
47
    case OP_MINUPTOI:
1986
48
    case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
1987
49
    case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
1988
50
    case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
1989
52
    case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
1990
53
    case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
1991
54
    case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
1992
55
    case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
1993
56
    case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
1994
57
    case OP_NOTPLUS:
1995
58
    case OP_NOTPLUSI:
1996
59
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
1997
60
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
1998
61
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
1999
62
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2000
63
    case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2001
64
    case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2002
65
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2003
67
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2004
68
    case OP_NOTQUERY:
2005
70
    case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2006
71
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
2007
72
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
2008
73
    case OP_NOTUPTO:
2009
74
    case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2010
80
    case OP_PLUS:
2011
81
    case OP_PLUSI:
2012
83
    case OP_POSPLUS:
2013
84
    case OP_POSPLUSI:
2014
90
    case OP_POSQUERY:
2015
91
    case OP_POSQUERYI:
2016
93
    case OP_POSSTAR:
2017
94
    case OP_POSSTARI:
2018
95
    case OP_POSUPTO:
2019
96
    case OP_POSUPTOI:
2020
108
    case OP_QUERY:
2021
110
    case OP_QUERYI:
2022
117
    case OP_REF:
2023
118
    case OP_REFI:
2024
125
    case OP_DNREF:
2025
126
    case OP_DNREFI:
2026
127
    case OP_SBRA:
2027
128
    case OP_SBRAPOS:
2028
132
    case OP_SCBRA:
2029
133
    case OP_SCBRAPOS:
2030
137
    case OP_SCOND:
2031
140
    case OP_SKIPZERO:
2032
142
    case OP_STAR:
2033
143
    case OP_STARI:
2034
144
    case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2035
145
    case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2036
146
    case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2037
147
    case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2038
149
    case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2039
151
    case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2040
152
    case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2041
153
    case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2042
155
    case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2043
156
    case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2044
157
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
2045
158
    case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2046
160
    case OP_UPTO:
2047
161
    case OP_UPTOI:
2048
161
    return -1;
2049
2050
    /* Catch unrecognized opcodes so that when new ones are added they
2051
    are not forgotten, as has happened in the past. */
2052
2053
1
    default:
2054
1
    return -4;
2055
542M
    }
2056
542M
  }
2057
/* Control never gets here */
2058
124M
}
2059
2060
2061
2062
/*************************************************
2063
*    Scan compiled regex for specific bracket    *
2064
*************************************************/
2065
2066
/* This little function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds a
2067
capturing bracket with the given number, or, if the number is negative, an
2068
instance of OP_REVERSE for a lookbehind. The function is global in the C sense
2069
so that it can be called from pcre_study() when finding the minimum matching
2070
length.
2071
2072
Arguments:
2073
  code        points to start of expression
2074
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2075
  number      the required bracket number or negative to find a lookbehind
2076
2077
Returns:      pointer to the opcode for the bracket, or NULL if not found
2078
*/
2079
2080
const pcre_uchar *
2081
PRIV(find_bracket)(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, int number)
2082
8.19k
{
2083
8.19k
for (;;)
2084
4.00M
  {
2085
4.00M
  register pcre_uchar c = *code;
2086
2087
4.00M
  if (c == OP_END) return NULL;
2088
2089
  /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit
2090
  map. This includes negated single high-valued characters. The length in
2091
  the table is zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */
2092
2093
3.99M
  if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1);
2094
2095
  /* Handle recursion */
2096
2097
3.99M
  else if (c == OP_REVERSE)
2098
7.67k
    {
2099
7.67k
    if (number < 0) return (pcre_uchar *)code;
2100
5.07k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2101
5.07k
    }
2102
2103
  /* Handle capturing bracket */
2104
2105
3.99M
  else if (c == OP_CBRA || c == OP_SCBRA ||
2106
3.99M
           c == OP_CBRAPOS || c == OP_SCBRAPOS)
2107
160k
    {
2108
160k
    int n = (int)GET2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE);
2109
160k
    if (n == number) return (pcre_uchar *)code;
2110
156k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2111
156k
    }
2112
2113
  /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for
2114
  repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra
2115
  two bytes of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument, we
2116
  must add in its length. */
2117
2118
3.83M
  else
2119
3.83M
    {
2120
3.83M
    switch(c)
2121
3.83M
      {
2122
3.78k
      case OP_TYPESTAR:
2123
4.05k
      case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2124
6.02k
      case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2125
7.34k
      case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2126
8.52k
      case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2127
9.38k
      case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2128
10.2k
      case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2129
10.5k
      case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2130
11.0k
      case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2131
11.0k
      if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
2132
11.0k
      break;
2133
2134
1.11k
      case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2135
1.41k
      case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2136
2.68k
      case OP_TYPEEXACT:
2137
3.85k
      case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2138
3.85k
      if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
2139
0
        code += 2;
2140
3.85k
      break;
2141
2142
3.39k
      case OP_MARK:
2143
3.82k
      case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
2144
4.16k
      case OP_SKIP_ARG:
2145
4.44k
      case OP_THEN_ARG:
2146
4.44k
      code += code[1];
2147
4.44k
      break;
2148
3.83M
      }
2149
2150
    /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
2151
2152
3.83M
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2153
2154
  /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed by
2155
  a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have to
2156
  arrange to skip the extra bytes. */
2157
2158
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
2159
    if (utf) switch(c)
2160
      {
2161
      case OP_CHAR:
2162
      case OP_CHARI:
2163
      case OP_NOT:
2164
      case OP_NOTI:
2165
      case OP_EXACT:
2166
      case OP_EXACTI:
2167
      case OP_NOTEXACT:
2168
      case OP_NOTEXACTI:
2169
      case OP_UPTO:
2170
      case OP_UPTOI:
2171
      case OP_NOTUPTO:
2172
      case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2173
      case OP_MINUPTO:
2174
      case OP_MINUPTOI:
2175
      case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
2176
      case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
2177
      case OP_POSUPTO:
2178
      case OP_POSUPTOI:
2179
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2180
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2181
      case OP_STAR:
2182
      case OP_STARI:
2183
      case OP_NOTSTAR:
2184
      case OP_NOTSTARI:
2185
      case OP_MINSTAR:
2186
      case OP_MINSTARI:
2187
      case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
2188
      case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
2189
      case OP_POSSTAR:
2190
      case OP_POSSTARI:
2191
      case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2192
      case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2193
      case OP_PLUS:
2194
      case OP_PLUSI:
2195
      case OP_NOTPLUS:
2196
      case OP_NOTPLUSI:
2197
      case OP_MINPLUS:
2198
      case OP_MINPLUSI:
2199
      case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
2200
      case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
2201
      case OP_POSPLUS:
2202
      case OP_POSPLUSI:
2203
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
2204
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
2205
      case OP_QUERY:
2206
      case OP_QUERYI:
2207
      case OP_NOTQUERY:
2208
      case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2209
      case OP_MINQUERY:
2210
      case OP_MINQUERYI:
2211
      case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
2212
      case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
2213
      case OP_POSQUERY:
2214
      case OP_POSQUERYI:
2215
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
2216
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2217
      if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
2218
      break;
2219
      }
2220
#else
2221
3.83M
    (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
2222
3.83M
#endif
2223
3.83M
    }
2224
3.99M
  }
2225
8.19k
}
2226
2227
2228
2229
/*************************************************
2230
*   Scan compiled regex for recursion reference  *
2231
*************************************************/
2232
2233
/* This little function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds an
2234
instance of OP_RECURSE.
2235
2236
Arguments:
2237
  code        points to start of expression
2238
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2239
2240
Returns:      pointer to the opcode for OP_RECURSE, or NULL if not found
2241
*/
2242
2243
static const pcre_uchar *
2244
find_recurse(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf)
2245
69.1k
{
2246
69.1k
for (;;)
2247
1.27M
  {
2248
1.27M
  register pcre_uchar c = *code;
2249
1.27M
  if (c == OP_END) return NULL;
2250
1.25M
  if (c == OP_RECURSE) return code;
2251
2252
  /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit
2253
  map. This includes negated single high-valued characters. The length in
2254
  the table is zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */
2255
2256
1.20M
  if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1);
2257
2258
  /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for
2259
  repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra
2260
  two bytes of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument, we
2261
  must add in its length. */
2262
2263
1.20M
  else
2264
1.20M
    {
2265
1.20M
    switch(c)
2266
1.20M
      {
2267
3.55k
      case OP_TYPESTAR:
2268
3.89k
      case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2269
6.29k
      case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2270
6.60k
      case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2271
12.1k
      case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2272
12.6k
      case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2273
13.2k
      case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2274
14.0k
      case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2275
14.3k
      case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2276
14.3k
      if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
2277
14.3k
      break;
2278
2279
339
      case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2280
619
      case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2281
1.10k
      case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2282
2.44k
      case OP_TYPEEXACT:
2283
2.44k
      if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
2284
0
        code += 2;
2285
2.44k
      break;
2286
2287
338
      case OP_MARK:
2288
1.17k
      case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
2289
1.45k
      case OP_SKIP_ARG:
2290
2.07k
      case OP_THEN_ARG:
2291
2.07k
      code += code[1];
2292
2.07k
      break;
2293
1.20M
      }
2294
2295
    /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
2296
2297
1.20M
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2298
2299
    /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed
2300
    by a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have
2301
    to arrange to skip the extra bytes. */
2302
2303
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
2304
    if (utf) switch(c)
2305
      {
2306
      case OP_CHAR:
2307
      case OP_CHARI:
2308
      case OP_NOT:
2309
      case OP_NOTI:
2310
      case OP_EXACT:
2311
      case OP_EXACTI:
2312
      case OP_NOTEXACT:
2313
      case OP_NOTEXACTI:
2314
      case OP_UPTO:
2315
      case OP_UPTOI:
2316
      case OP_NOTUPTO:
2317
      case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2318
      case OP_MINUPTO:
2319
      case OP_MINUPTOI:
2320
      case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
2321
      case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
2322
      case OP_POSUPTO:
2323
      case OP_POSUPTOI:
2324
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2325
      case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2326
      case OP_STAR:
2327
      case OP_STARI:
2328
      case OP_NOTSTAR:
2329
      case OP_NOTSTARI:
2330
      case OP_MINSTAR:
2331
      case OP_MINSTARI:
2332
      case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
2333
      case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
2334
      case OP_POSSTAR:
2335
      case OP_POSSTARI:
2336
      case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2337
      case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2338
      case OP_PLUS:
2339
      case OP_PLUSI:
2340
      case OP_NOTPLUS:
2341
      case OP_NOTPLUSI:
2342
      case OP_MINPLUS:
2343
      case OP_MINPLUSI:
2344
      case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
2345
      case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
2346
      case OP_POSPLUS:
2347
      case OP_POSPLUSI:
2348
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
2349
      case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
2350
      case OP_QUERY:
2351
      case OP_QUERYI:
2352
      case OP_NOTQUERY:
2353
      case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2354
      case OP_MINQUERY:
2355
      case OP_MINQUERYI:
2356
      case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
2357
      case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
2358
      case OP_POSQUERY:
2359
      case OP_POSQUERYI:
2360
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
2361
      case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2362
      if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
2363
      break;
2364
      }
2365
#else
2366
1.20M
    (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
2367
1.20M
#endif
2368
1.20M
    }
2369
1.20M
  }
2370
69.1k
}
2371
2372
2373
2374
/*************************************************
2375
*    Scan compiled branch for non-emptiness      *
2376
*************************************************/
2377
2378
/* This function scans through a branch of a compiled pattern to see whether it
2379
can match the empty string or not. It is called from could_be_empty()
2380
below and from compile_branch() when checking for an unlimited repeat of a
2381
group that can match nothing. Note that first_significant_code() skips over
2382
backward and negative forward assertions when its final argument is TRUE. If we
2383
hit an unclosed bracket, we return "empty" - this means we've struck an inner
2384
bracket whose current branch will already have been scanned.
2385
2386
Arguments:
2387
  code        points to start of search
2388
  endcode     points to where to stop
2389
  utf         TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2390
  cd          contains pointers to tables etc.
2391
  recurses    chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion
2392
2393
Returns:      TRUE if what is matched could be empty
2394
*/
2395
2396
static BOOL
2397
could_be_empty_branch(const pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *endcode,
2398
  BOOL utf, compile_data *cd, recurse_check *recurses)
2399
403k
{
2400
403k
register pcre_uchar c;
2401
403k
recurse_check this_recurse;
2402
2403
403k
for (code = first_significant_code(code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], TRUE);
2404
801k
     code < endcode;
2405
403k
     code = first_significant_code(code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[c], TRUE))
2406
797k
  {
2407
797k
  const pcre_uchar *ccode;
2408
2409
797k
  c = *code;
2410
2411
  /* Skip over forward assertions; the other assertions are skipped by
2412
  first_significant_code() with a TRUE final argument. */
2413
2414
797k
  if (c == OP_ASSERT)
2415
4.94k
    {
2416
8.33k
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
2417
4.94k
    c = *code;
2418
4.94k
    continue;
2419
4.94k
    }
2420
2421
  /* For a recursion/subroutine call, if its end has been reached, which
2422
  implies a backward reference subroutine call, we can scan it. If it's a
2423
  forward reference subroutine call, we can't. To detect forward reference
2424
  we have to scan up the list that is kept in the workspace. This function is
2425
  called only when doing the real compile, not during the pre-compile that
2426
  measures the size of the compiled pattern. */
2427
2428
792k
  if (c == OP_RECURSE)
2429
113k
    {
2430
113k
    const pcre_uchar *scode = cd->start_code + GET(code, 1);
2431
113k
    const pcre_uchar *endgroup = scode;
2432
113k
    BOOL empty_branch;
2433
2434
    /* Test for forward reference or uncompleted reference. This is disabled
2435
    when called to scan a completed pattern by setting cd->start_workspace to
2436
    NULL. */
2437
2438
113k
    if (cd->start_workspace != NULL)
2439
43.6k
      {
2440
43.6k
      const pcre_uchar *tcode;
2441
43.3M
      for (tcode = cd->start_workspace; tcode < cd->hwm; tcode += LINK_SIZE)
2442
43.3M
        if ((int)GET(tcode, 0) == (int)(code + 1 - cd->start_code)) return TRUE;
2443
3.24k
      if (GET(scode, 1) == 0) return TRUE;    /* Unclosed */
2444
3.24k
      }
2445
2446
    /* If the reference is to a completed group, we need to detect whether this
2447
    is a recursive call, as otherwise there will be an infinite loop. If it is
2448
    a recursion, just skip over it. Simple recursions are easily detected. For
2449
    mutual recursions we keep a chain on the stack. */
2450
2451
72.5k
    do endgroup += GET(endgroup, 1); while (*endgroup == OP_ALT);
2452
72.0k
    if (code >= scode && code <= endgroup) continue;  /* Simple recursion */
2453
71.7k
    else
2454
71.7k
      {
2455
71.7k
      recurse_check *r = recurses;
2456
129k
      for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev)
2457
112k
        if (r->group == scode) break;
2458
71.7k
      if (r != NULL) continue;   /* Mutual recursion */
2459
71.7k
      }
2460
2461
    /* Completed reference; scan the referenced group, remembering it on the
2462
    stack chain to detect mutual recursions. */
2463
2464
17.1k
    empty_branch = FALSE;
2465
17.1k
    this_recurse.prev = recurses;
2466
17.1k
    this_recurse.group = scode;
2467
2468
17.1k
    do
2469
17.5k
      {
2470
17.5k
      if (could_be_empty_branch(scode, endcode, utf, cd, &this_recurse))
2471
15.1k
        {
2472
15.1k
        empty_branch = TRUE;
2473
15.1k
        break;
2474
15.1k
        }
2475
2.40k
      scode += GET(scode, 1);
2476
2.40k
      }
2477
17.1k
    while (*scode == OP_ALT);
2478
2479
17.1k
    if (!empty_branch) return FALSE;  /* All branches are non-empty */
2480
15.1k
    continue;
2481
17.1k
    }
2482
2483
  /* Groups with zero repeats can of course be empty; skip them. */
2484
2485
679k
  if (c == OP_BRAZERO || c == OP_BRAMINZERO || c == OP_SKIPZERO ||
2486
679k
      c == OP_BRAPOSZERO)
2487
7.02k
    {
2488
7.02k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
2489
7.85k
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
2490
7.02k
    c = *code;
2491
7.02k
    continue;
2492
7.02k
    }
2493
2494
  /* A nested group that is already marked as "could be empty" can just be
2495
  skipped. */
2496
2497
672k
  if (c == OP_SBRA  || c == OP_SBRAPOS ||
2498
672k
      c == OP_SCBRA || c == OP_SCBRAPOS)
2499
4.98k
    {
2500
6.53k
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
2501
4.98k
    c = *code;
2502
4.98k
    continue;
2503
4.98k
    }
2504
2505
  /* For other groups, scan the branches. */
2506
2507
667k
  if (c == OP_BRA  || c == OP_BRAPOS ||
2508
667k
      c == OP_CBRA || c == OP_CBRAPOS ||
2509
667k
      c == OP_ONCE || c == OP_ONCE_NC ||
2510
667k
      c == OP_COND || c == OP_SCOND)
2511
322k
    {
2512
322k
    BOOL empty_branch;
2513
322k
    if (GET(code, 1) == 0) return TRUE;    /* Hit unclosed bracket */
2514
2515
    /* If a conditional group has only one branch, there is a second, implied,
2516
    empty branch, so just skip over the conditional, because it could be empty.
2517
    Otherwise, scan the individual branches of the group. */
2518
2519
321k
    if (c == OP_COND && code[GET(code, 1)] != OP_ALT)
2520
1.00k
      code += GET(code, 1);
2521
320k
    else
2522
320k
      {
2523
320k
      empty_branch = FALSE;
2524
320k
      do
2525
375k
        {
2526
375k
        if (!empty_branch && could_be_empty_branch(code, endcode, utf, cd,
2527
359k
          recurses)) empty_branch = TRUE;
2528
375k
        code += GET(code, 1);
2529
375k
        }
2530
375k
      while (*code == OP_ALT);
2531
320k
      if (!empty_branch) return FALSE;   /* All branches are non-empty */
2532
320k
      }
2533
2534
269k
    c = *code;
2535
269k
    continue;
2536
321k
    }
2537
2538
  /* Handle the other opcodes */
2539
2540
344k
  switch (c)
2541
344k
    {
2542
    /* Check for quantifiers after a class. XCLASS is used for classes that
2543
    cannot be represented just by a bit map. This includes negated single
2544
    high-valued characters. The length in PRIV(OP_lengths)[] is zero; the
2545
    actual length is stored in the compiled code, so we must update "code"
2546
    here. */
2547
2548
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
2549
    case OP_XCLASS:
2550
    ccode = code += GET(code, 1);
2551
    goto CHECK_CLASS_REPEAT;
2552
#endif
2553
2554
7.21k
    case OP_CLASS:
2555
8.62k
    case OP_NCLASS:
2556
8.62k
    ccode = code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CLASS];
2557
2558
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
2559
    CHECK_CLASS_REPEAT:
2560
#endif
2561
2562
8.62k
    switch (*ccode)
2563
8.62k
      {
2564
1.33k
      case OP_CRSTAR:            /* These could be empty; continue */
2565
1.63k
      case OP_CRMINSTAR:
2566
3.16k
      case OP_CRQUERY:
2567
3.45k
      case OP_CRMINQUERY:
2568
3.88k
      case OP_CRPOSSTAR:
2569
4.31k
      case OP_CRPOSQUERY:
2570
4.31k
      break;
2571
2572
1.19k
      default:                   /* Non-repeat => class must match */
2573
2.31k
      case OP_CRPLUS:            /* These repeats aren't empty */
2574
2.70k
      case OP_CRMINPLUS:
2575
3.02k
      case OP_CRPOSPLUS:
2576
3.02k
      return FALSE;
2577
2578
643
      case OP_CRRANGE:
2579
901
      case OP_CRMINRANGE:
2580
1.27k
      case OP_CRPOSRANGE:
2581
1.27k
      if (GET2(ccode, 1) > 0) return FALSE;  /* Minimum > 0 */
2582
306
      break;
2583
8.62k
      }
2584
4.62k
    break;
2585
2586
    /* Opcodes that must match a character */
2587
2588
4.62k
    case OP_ANY:
2589
1.82k
    case OP_ALLANY:
2590
1.89k
    case OP_ANYBYTE:
2591
2592
1.90k
    case OP_PROP:
2593
2.17k
    case OP_NOTPROP:
2594
2.49k
    case OP_ANYNL:
2595
2596
2.81k
    case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
2597
3.12k
    case OP_HSPACE:
2598
3.50k
    case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
2599
3.88k
    case OP_VSPACE:
2600
3.92k
    case OP_EXTUNI:
2601
2602
4.28k
    case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
2603
5.07k
    case OP_DIGIT:
2604
5.47k
    case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
2605
5.71k
    case OP_WHITESPACE:
2606
6.06k
    case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
2607
6.41k
    case OP_WORDCHAR:
2608
2609
32.9k
    case OP_CHAR:
2610
33.9k
    case OP_CHARI:
2611
34.9k
    case OP_NOT:
2612
35.7k
    case OP_NOTI:
2613
2614
36.2k
    case OP_PLUS:
2615
37.3k
    case OP_PLUSI:
2616
38.0k
    case OP_MINPLUS:
2617
39.7k
    case OP_MINPLUSI:
2618
2619
40.7k
    case OP_NOTPLUS:
2620
44.8k
    case OP_NOTPLUSI:
2621
45.4k
    case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
2622
45.9k
    case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
2623
2624
46.6k
    case OP_POSPLUS:
2625
47.4k
    case OP_POSPLUSI:
2626
48.5k
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
2627
49.6k
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
2628
2629
50.4k
    case OP_EXACT:
2630
50.8k
    case OP_EXACTI:
2631
51.1k
    case OP_NOTEXACT:
2632
51.9k
    case OP_NOTEXACTI:
2633
2634
52.4k
    case OP_TYPEPLUS:
2635
52.8k
    case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
2636
53.1k
    case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
2637
53.8k
    case OP_TYPEEXACT:
2638
2639
53.8k
    return FALSE;
2640
2641
    /* These are going to continue, as they may be empty, but we have to
2642
    fudge the length for the \p and \P cases. */
2643
2644
1.27k
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
2645
1.76k
    case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
2646
2.55k
    case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
2647
9.92k
    case OP_TYPEQUERY:
2648
10.6k
    case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
2649
11.5k
    case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
2650
11.5k
    if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
2651
11.5k
    break;
2652
2653
    /* Same for these */
2654
2655
361
    case OP_TYPEUPTO:
2656
668
    case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
2657
1.72k
    case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
2658
1.72k
    if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
2659
0
      code += 2;
2660
1.72k
    break;
2661
2662
    /* End of branch */
2663
2664
228k
    case OP_KET:
2665
229k
    case OP_KETRMAX:
2666
230k
    case OP_KETRMIN:
2667
230k
    case OP_KETRPOS:
2668
246k
    case OP_ALT:
2669
246k
    return TRUE;
2670
2671
    /* In UTF-8 mode, STAR, MINSTAR, POSSTAR, QUERY, MINQUERY, POSQUERY, UPTO,
2672
    MINUPTO, and POSUPTO and their caseless and negative versions may be
2673
    followed by a multibyte character. */
2674
2675
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
2676
    case OP_STAR:
2677
    case OP_STARI:
2678
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
2679
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
2680
2681
    case OP_MINSTAR:
2682
    case OP_MINSTARI:
2683
    case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
2684
    case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
2685
2686
    case OP_POSSTAR:
2687
    case OP_POSSTARI:
2688
    case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
2689
    case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
2690
2691
    case OP_QUERY:
2692
    case OP_QUERYI:
2693
    case OP_NOTQUERY:
2694
    case OP_NOTQUERYI:
2695
2696
    case OP_MINQUERY:
2697
    case OP_MINQUERYI:
2698
    case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
2699
    case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
2700
2701
    case OP_POSQUERY:
2702
    case OP_POSQUERYI:
2703
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
2704
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
2705
2706
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(code[1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[1]);
2707
    break;
2708
2709
    case OP_UPTO:
2710
    case OP_UPTOI:
2711
    case OP_NOTUPTO:
2712
    case OP_NOTUPTOI:
2713
2714
    case OP_MINUPTO:
2715
    case OP_MINUPTOI:
2716
    case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
2717
    case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
2718
2719
    case OP_POSUPTO:
2720
    case OP_POSUPTOI:
2721
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
2722
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
2723
2724
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(code[1 + IMM2_SIZE])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[1 + IMM2_SIZE]);
2725
    break;
2726
#endif
2727
2728
    /* MARK, and PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument must skip over the argument
2729
    string. */
2730
2731
274
    case OP_MARK:
2732
1.45k
    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
2733
1.75k
    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
2734
2.64k
    case OP_THEN_ARG:
2735
2.64k
    code += code[1];
2736
2.64k
    break;
2737
2738
    /* None of the remaining opcodes are required to match a character. */
2739
2740
20.4k
    default:
2741
20.4k
    break;
2742
344k
    }
2743
344k
  }
2744
2745
3.32k
return TRUE;
2746
403k
}
2747
2748
2749
2750
/*************************************************
2751
*    Scan compiled regex for non-emptiness       *
2752
*************************************************/
2753
2754
/* This function is called to check for left recursive calls. We want to check
2755
the current branch of the current pattern to see if it could match the empty
2756
string. If it could, we must look outwards for branches at other levels,
2757
stopping when we pass beyond the bracket which is the subject of the recursion.
2758
This function is called only during the real compile, not during the
2759
pre-compile.
2760
2761
Arguments:
2762
  code        points to start of the recursion
2763
  endcode     points to where to stop (current RECURSE item)
2764
  bcptr       points to the chain of current (unclosed) branch starts
2765
  utf         TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2766
  cd          pointers to tables etc
2767
2768
Returns:      TRUE if what is matched could be empty
2769
*/
2770
2771
static BOOL
2772
could_be_empty(const pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *endcode,
2773
  branch_chain *bcptr, BOOL utf, compile_data *cd)
2774
1.70k
{
2775
3.24k
while (bcptr != NULL && bcptr->current_branch >= code)
2776
3.21k
  {
2777
3.21k
  if (!could_be_empty_branch(bcptr->current_branch, endcode, utf, cd, NULL))
2778
1.67k
    return FALSE;
2779
1.53k
  bcptr = bcptr->outer;
2780
1.53k
  }
2781
31
return TRUE;
2782
1.70k
}
2783
2784
2785
2786
/*************************************************
2787
*        Base opcode of repeated opcodes         *
2788
*************************************************/
2789
2790
/* Returns the base opcode for repeated single character type opcodes. If the
2791
opcode is not a repeated character type, it returns with the original value.
2792
2793
Arguments:  c opcode
2794
Returns:    base opcode for the type
2795
*/
2796
2797
static pcre_uchar
2798
get_repeat_base(pcre_uchar c)
2799
461k
{
2800
461k
return (c > OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)? c :
2801
461k
       (c >= OP_TYPESTAR)?   OP_TYPESTAR :
2802
461k
       (c >= OP_NOTSTARI)?   OP_NOTSTARI :
2803
361k
       (c >= OP_NOTSTAR)?    OP_NOTSTAR :
2804
347k
       (c >= OP_STARI)?      OP_STARI :
2805
335k
                             OP_STAR;
2806
461k
}
2807
2808
2809
2810
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
2811
/*************************************************
2812
*        Check a character and a property        *
2813
*************************************************/
2814
2815
/* This function is called by check_auto_possessive() when a property item
2816
is adjacent to a fixed character.
2817
2818
Arguments:
2819
  c            the character
2820
  ptype        the property type
2821
  pdata        the data for the type
2822
  negated      TRUE if it's a negated property (\P or \p{^)
2823
2824
Returns:       TRUE if auto-possessifying is OK
2825
*/
2826
2827
static BOOL
2828
check_char_prop(pcre_uint32 c, unsigned int ptype, unsigned int pdata,
2829
  BOOL negated)
2830
{
2831
const pcre_uint32 *p;
2832
const ucd_record *prop = GET_UCD(c);
2833
2834
switch(ptype)
2835
  {
2836
  case PT_LAMP:
2837
  return (prop->chartype == ucp_Lu ||
2838
          prop->chartype == ucp_Ll ||
2839
          prop->chartype == ucp_Lt) == negated;
2840
2841
  case PT_GC:
2842
  return (pdata == PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype]) == negated;
2843
2844
  case PT_PC:
2845
  return (pdata == prop->chartype) == negated;
2846
2847
  case PT_SC:
2848
  return (pdata == prop->script) == negated;
2849
2850
  /* These are specials */
2851
2852
  case PT_ALNUM:
2853
  return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_L ||
2854
          PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_N) == negated;
2855
2856
  /* Perl space used to exclude VT, but from Perl 5.18 it is included, which
2857
  means that Perl space and POSIX space are now identical. PCRE was changed
2858
  at release 8.34. */
2859
2860
  case PT_SPACE:    /* Perl space */
2861
  case PT_PXSPACE:  /* POSIX space */
2862
  switch(c)
2863
    {
2864
    HSPACE_CASES:
2865
    VSPACE_CASES:
2866
    return negated;
2867
2868
    default:
2869
    return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_Z) == negated;
2870
    }
2871
  break;  /* Control never reaches here */
2872
2873
  case PT_WORD:
2874
  return (PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_L ||
2875
          PRIV(ucp_gentype)[prop->chartype] == ucp_N ||
2876
          c == CHAR_UNDERSCORE) == negated;
2877
2878
  case PT_CLIST:
2879
  p = PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + prop->caseset;
2880
  for (;;)
2881
    {
2882
    if (c < *p) return !negated;
2883
    if (c == *p++) return negated;
2884
    }
2885
  break;  /* Control never reaches here */
2886
  }
2887
2888
return FALSE;
2889
}
2890
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
2891
2892
2893
2894
/*************************************************
2895
*        Fill the character property list        *
2896
*************************************************/
2897
2898
/* Checks whether the code points to an opcode that can take part in auto-
2899
possessification, and if so, fills a list with its properties.
2900
2901
Arguments:
2902
  code        points to start of expression
2903
  utf         TRUE if in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
2904
  fcc         points to case-flipping table
2905
  list        points to output list
2906
              list[0] will be filled with the opcode
2907
              list[1] will be non-zero if this opcode
2908
                can match an empty character string
2909
              list[2..7] depends on the opcode
2910
2911
Returns:      points to the start of the next opcode if *code is accepted
2912
              NULL if *code is not accepted
2913
*/
2914
2915
static const pcre_uchar *
2916
get_chr_property_list(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf,
2917
  const pcre_uint8 *fcc, pcre_uint32 *list)
2918
1.08M
{
2919
1.08M
pcre_uchar c = *code;
2920
1.08M
pcre_uchar base;
2921
1.08M
const pcre_uchar *end;
2922
1.08M
pcre_uint32 chr;
2923
2924
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
2925
pcre_uint32 *clist_dest;
2926
const pcre_uint32 *clist_src;
2927
#else
2928
1.08M
((void)utf); /* Suppress "unused parameter" compiler warning */
2929
1.08M
#endif
2930
2931
1.08M
list[0] = c;
2932
1.08M
list[1] = FALSE;
2933
1.08M
code++;
2934
2935
1.08M
if (c >= OP_STAR && c <= OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)
2936
168k
  {
2937
168k
  base = get_repeat_base(c);
2938
168k
  c -= (base - OP_STAR);
2939
2940
168k
  if (c == OP_UPTO || c == OP_MINUPTO || c == OP_EXACT || c == OP_POSUPTO)
2941
32.9k
    code += IMM2_SIZE;
2942
2943
168k
  list[1] = (c != OP_PLUS && c != OP_MINPLUS && c != OP_EXACT && c != OP_POSPLUS);
2944
2945
168k
  switch(base)
2946
168k
    {
2947
93.6k
    case OP_STAR:
2948
93.6k
    list[0] = OP_CHAR;
2949
93.6k
    break;
2950
2951
9.40k
    case OP_STARI:
2952
9.40k
    list[0] = OP_CHARI;
2953
9.40k
    break;
2954
2955
5.53k
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
2956
5.53k
    list[0] = OP_NOT;
2957
5.53k
    break;
2958
2959
7.39k
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
2960
7.39k
    list[0] = OP_NOTI;
2961
7.39k
    break;
2962
2963
52.7k
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
2964
52.7k
    list[0] = *code;
2965
52.7k
    code++;
2966
52.7k
    break;
2967
168k
    }
2968
168k
  c = list[0];
2969
168k
  }
2970
2971
1.08M
switch(c)
2972
1.08M
  {
2973
2.63k
  case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
2974
4.05k
  case OP_DIGIT:
2975
5.37k
  case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
2976
8.09k
  case OP_WHITESPACE:
2977
13.2k
  case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
2978
16.6k
  case OP_WORDCHAR:
2979
52.6k
  case OP_ANY:
2980
54.0k
  case OP_ALLANY:
2981
56.9k
  case OP_ANYNL:
2982
58.3k
  case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
2983
60.4k
  case OP_HSPACE:
2984
64.2k
  case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
2985
65.5k
  case OP_VSPACE:
2986
65.5k
  case OP_EXTUNI:
2987
91.7k
  case OP_EODN:
2988
92.1k
  case OP_EOD:
2989
94.7k
  case OP_DOLL:
2990
95.0k
  case OP_DOLLM:
2991
95.0k
  return code;
2992
2993
927k
  case OP_CHAR:
2994
933k
  case OP_NOT:
2995
933k
  GETCHARINCTEST(chr, code);
2996
933k
  list[2] = chr;
2997
933k
  list[3] = NOTACHAR;
2998
933k
  return code;
2999
3000
18.8k
  case OP_CHARI:
3001
26.3k
  case OP_NOTI:
3002
26.3k
  list[0] = (c == OP_CHARI) ? OP_CHAR : OP_NOT;
3003
26.3k
  GETCHARINCTEST(chr, code);
3004
26.3k
  list[2] = chr;
3005
3006
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3007
  if (chr < 128 || (chr < 256 && !utf))
3008
    list[3] = fcc[chr];
3009
  else
3010
    list[3] = UCD_OTHERCASE(chr);
3011
#elif defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3012
  list[3] = (chr < 256) ? fcc[chr] : chr;
3013
#else
3014
26.3k
  list[3] = fcc[chr];
3015
26.3k
#endif
3016
3017
  /* The othercase might be the same value. */
3018
3019
26.3k
  if (chr == list[3])
3020
18.3k
    list[3] = NOTACHAR;
3021
7.94k
  else
3022
7.94k
    list[4] = NOTACHAR;
3023
26.3k
  return code;
3024
3025
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3026
  case OP_PROP:
3027
  case OP_NOTPROP:
3028
  if (code[0] != PT_CLIST)
3029
    {
3030
    list[2] = code[0];
3031
    list[3] = code[1];
3032
    return code + 2;
3033
    }
3034
3035
  /* Convert only if we have enough space. */
3036
3037
  clist_src = PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + code[1];
3038
  clist_dest = list + 2;
3039
  code += 2;
3040
3041
  do {
3042
     if (clist_dest >= list + 8)
3043
       {
3044
       /* Early return if there is not enough space. This should never
3045
       happen, since all clists are shorter than 5 character now. */
3046
       list[2] = code[0];
3047
       list[3] = code[1];
3048
       return code;
3049
       }
3050
     *clist_dest++ = *clist_src;
3051
     }
3052
  while(*clist_src++ != NOTACHAR);
3053
3054
  /* All characters are stored. The terminating NOTACHAR
3055
  is copied form the clist itself. */
3056
3057
  list[0] = (c == OP_PROP) ? OP_CHAR : OP_NOT;
3058
  return code;
3059
#endif
3060
3061
2.41k
  case OP_NCLASS:
3062
24.1k
  case OP_CLASS:
3063
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3064
  case OP_XCLASS:
3065
  if (c == OP_XCLASS)
3066
    end = code + GET(code, 0) - 1;
3067
  else
3068
#endif
3069
24.1k
    end = code + 32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar);
3070
3071
24.1k
  switch(*end)
3072
24.1k
    {
3073
3.69k
    case OP_CRSTAR:
3074
4.57k
    case OP_CRMINSTAR:
3075
8.24k
    case OP_CRQUERY:
3076
11.0k
    case OP_CRMINQUERY:
3077
11.6k
    case OP_CRPOSSTAR:
3078
11.8k
    case OP_CRPOSQUERY:
3079
11.8k
    list[1] = TRUE;
3080
11.8k
    end++;
3081
11.8k
    break;
3082
3083
3.67k
    case OP_CRPLUS:
3084
5.12k
    case OP_CRMINPLUS:
3085
5.44k
    case OP_CRPOSPLUS:
3086
5.44k
    end++;
3087
5.44k
    break;
3088
3089
2.45k
    case OP_CRRANGE:
3090
4.85k
    case OP_CRMINRANGE:
3091
5.37k
    case OP_CRPOSRANGE:
3092
5.37k
    list[1] = (GET2(end, 1) == 0);
3093
5.37k
    end += 1 + 2 * IMM2_SIZE;
3094
5.37k
    break;
3095
24.1k
    }
3096
24.1k
  list[2] = (pcre_uint32)(end - code);
3097
24.1k
  return end;
3098
1.08M
  }
3099
3.57k
return NULL;    /* Opcode not accepted */
3100
1.08M
}
3101
3102
3103
3104
/*************************************************
3105
*    Scan further character sets for match       *
3106
*************************************************/
3107
3108
/* Checks whether the base and the current opcode have a common character, in
3109
which case the base cannot be possessified.
3110
3111
Arguments:
3112
  code        points to the byte code
3113
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
3114
  cd          static compile data
3115
  base_list   the data list of the base opcode
3116
3117
Returns:      TRUE if the auto-possessification is possible
3118
*/
3119
3120
static BOOL
3121
compare_opcodes(const pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, const compile_data *cd,
3122
  const pcre_uint32 *base_list, const pcre_uchar *base_end, int *rec_limit)
3123
4.14M
{
3124
4.14M
pcre_uchar c;
3125
4.14M
pcre_uint32 list[8];
3126
4.14M
const pcre_uint32 *chr_ptr;
3127
4.14M
const pcre_uint32 *ochr_ptr;
3128
4.14M
const pcre_uint32 *list_ptr;
3129
4.14M
const pcre_uchar *next_code;
3130
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3131
const pcre_uchar *xclass_flags;
3132
#endif
3133
4.14M
const pcre_uint8 *class_bitset;
3134
4.14M
const pcre_uint8 *set1, *set2, *set_end;
3135
4.14M
pcre_uint32 chr;
3136
4.14M
BOOL accepted, invert_bits;
3137
4.14M
BOOL entered_a_group = FALSE;
3138
3139
4.14M
if (*rec_limit == 0) return FALSE;
3140
4.14M
--(*rec_limit);
3141
3142
/* Note: the base_list[1] contains whether the current opcode has greedy
3143
(represented by a non-zero value) quantifier. This is a different from
3144
other character type lists, which stores here that the character iterator
3145
matches to an empty string (also represented by a non-zero value). */
3146
3147
4.14M
for(;;)
3148
8.70M
  {
3149
  /* All operations move the code pointer forward.
3150
  Therefore infinite recursions are not possible. */
3151
3152
8.70M
  c = *code;
3153
3154
  /* Skip over callouts */
3155
3156
8.70M
  if (c == OP_CALLOUT)
3157
281
    {
3158
281
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3159
281
    continue;
3160
281
    }
3161
3162
8.70M
  if (c == OP_ALT)
3163
3.31M
    {
3164
3.46M
    do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT);
3165
3.31M
    c = *code;
3166
3.31M
    }
3167
3168
8.70M
  switch(c)
3169
8.70M
    {
3170
245k
    case OP_END:
3171
246k
    case OP_KETRPOS:
3172
    /* TRUE only in greedy case. The non-greedy case could be replaced by
3173
    an OP_EXACT, but it is probably not worth it. (And note that OP_EXACT
3174
    uses more memory, which we cannot get at this stage.) */
3175
3176
246k
    return base_list[1] != 0;
3177
3178
4.02M
    case OP_KET:
3179
    /* If the bracket is capturing, and referenced by an OP_RECURSE, or
3180
    it is an atomic sub-pattern (assert, once, etc.) the non-greedy case
3181
    cannot be converted to a possessive form. */
3182
3183
4.02M
    if (base_list[1] == 0) return FALSE;
3184
3185
4.01M
    switch(*(code - GET(code, 1)))
3186
4.01M
      {
3187
708
      case OP_ASSERT:
3188
1.02k
      case OP_ASSERT_NOT:
3189
1.63k
      case OP_ASSERTBACK:
3190
2.14k
      case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT:
3191
4.98k
      case OP_ONCE:
3192
5.80k
      case OP_ONCE_NC:
3193
      /* Atomic sub-patterns and assertions can always auto-possessify their
3194
      last iterator. However, if the group was entered as a result of checking
3195
      a previous iterator, this is not possible. */
3196
3197
5.80k
      return !entered_a_group;
3198
4.01M
      }
3199
3200
4.00M
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3201
4.00M
    continue;
3202
3203
1.10k
    case OP_ONCE:
3204
1.44k
    case OP_ONCE_NC:
3205
140k
    case OP_BRA:
3206
3.47M
    case OP_CBRA:
3207
3.47M
    next_code = code + GET(code, 1);
3208
3.47M
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3209
3210
4.53M
    while (*next_code == OP_ALT)
3211
4.01M
      {
3212
4.01M
      if (!compare_opcodes(code, utf, cd, base_list, base_end, rec_limit))
3213
2.95M
        return FALSE;
3214
1.06M
      code = next_code + 1 + LINK_SIZE;
3215
1.06M
      next_code += GET(next_code, 1);
3216
1.06M
      }
3217
3218
516k
    entered_a_group = TRUE;
3219
516k
    continue;
3220
3221
4.27k
    case OP_BRAZERO:
3222
5.41k
    case OP_BRAMINZERO:
3223
3224
5.41k
    next_code = code + 1;
3225
5.41k
    if (*next_code != OP_BRA && *next_code != OP_CBRA
3226
5.41k
        && *next_code != OP_ONCE && *next_code != OP_ONCE_NC) return FALSE;
3227
3228
4.41k
    do next_code += GET(next_code, 1); while (*next_code == OP_ALT);
3229
3230
    /* The bracket content will be checked by the
3231
    OP_BRA/OP_CBRA case above. */
3232
3.68k
    next_code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
3233
3.68k
    if (!compare_opcodes(next_code, utf, cd, base_list, base_end, rec_limit))
3234
1.02k
      return FALSE;
3235
3236
2.65k
    code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3237
2.65k
    continue;
3238
3239
961k
    default:
3240
961k
    break;
3241
8.70M
    }
3242
3243
  /* Check for a supported opcode, and load its properties. */
3244
3245
961k
  code = get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list);
3246
961k
  if (code == NULL) return FALSE;    /* Unsupported */
3247
3248
  /* If either opcode is a small character list, set pointers for comparing
3249
  characters from that list with another list, or with a property. */
3250
3251
957k
  if (base_list[0] == OP_CHAR)
3252
897k
    {
3253
897k
    chr_ptr = base_list + 2;
3254
897k
    list_ptr = list;
3255
897k
    }
3256
60.1k
  else if (list[0] == OP_CHAR)
3257
39.4k
    {
3258
39.4k
    chr_ptr = list + 2;
3259
39.4k
    list_ptr = base_list;
3260
39.4k
    }
3261
3262
  /* Character bitsets can also be compared to certain opcodes. */
3263
3264
20.6k
  else if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS || list[0] == OP_CLASS
3265
20.6k
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
3266
      /* In 8 bit, non-UTF mode, OP_CLASS and OP_NCLASS are the same. */
3267
20.6k
      || (!utf && (base_list[0] == OP_NCLASS || list[0] == OP_NCLASS))
3268
20.6k
#endif
3269
20.6k
      )
3270
7.97k
    {
3271
7.97k
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
3272
7.97k
    if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS || (!utf && base_list[0] == OP_NCLASS))
3273
#else
3274
    if (base_list[0] == OP_CLASS)
3275
#endif
3276
5.79k
      {
3277
5.79k
      set1 = (pcre_uint8 *)(base_end - base_list[2]);
3278
5.79k
      list_ptr = list;
3279
5.79k
      }
3280
2.17k
    else
3281
2.17k
      {
3282
2.17k
      set1 = (pcre_uint8 *)(code - list[2]);
3283
2.17k
      list_ptr = base_list;
3284
2.17k
      }
3285
3286
7.97k
    invert_bits = FALSE;
3287
7.97k
    switch(list_ptr[0])
3288
7.97k
      {
3289
2.75k
      case OP_CLASS:
3290
3.40k
      case OP_NCLASS:
3291
3.40k
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)
3292
3.40k
        ((list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2]);
3293
3.40k
      break;
3294
3295
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3296
      case OP_XCLASS:
3297
      xclass_flags = (list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2] + LINK_SIZE;
3298
      if ((*xclass_flags & XCL_HASPROP) != 0) return FALSE;
3299
      if ((*xclass_flags & XCL_MAP) == 0)
3300
        {
3301
        /* No bits are set for characters < 256. */
3302
        if (list[1] == 0) return (*xclass_flags & XCL_NOT) == 0;
3303
        /* Might be an empty repeat. */
3304
        continue;
3305
        }
3306
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(xclass_flags + 1);
3307
      break;
3308
#endif
3309
3310
814
      case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
3311
814
      invert_bits = TRUE;
3312
      /* Fall through */
3313
1.01k
      case OP_DIGIT:
3314
1.01k
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_digit);
3315
1.01k
      break;
3316
3317
487
      case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
3318
487
      invert_bits = TRUE;
3319
      /* Fall through */
3320
1.27k
      case OP_WHITESPACE:
3321
1.27k
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_space);
3322
1.27k
      break;
3323
3324
829
      case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
3325
829
      invert_bits = TRUE;
3326
      /* Fall through */
3327
1.09k
      case OP_WORDCHAR:
3328
1.09k
      set2 = (pcre_uint8 *)(cd->cbits + cbit_word);
3329
1.09k
      break;
3330
3331
1.18k
      default:
3332
1.18k
      return FALSE;
3333
7.97k
      }
3334
3335
    /* Because the sets are unaligned, we need
3336
    to perform byte comparison here. */
3337
6.79k
    set_end = set1 + 32;
3338
6.79k
    if (invert_bits)
3339
2.13k
      {
3340
2.13k
      do
3341
35.6k
        {
3342
35.6k
        if ((*set1++ & ~(*set2++)) != 0) return FALSE;
3343
35.6k
        }
3344
33.8k
      while (set1 < set_end);
3345
2.13k
      }
3346
4.66k
    else
3347
4.66k
      {
3348
4.66k
      do
3349
64.3k
        {
3350
64.3k
        if ((*set1++ & *set2++) != 0) return FALSE;
3351
64.3k
        }
3352
60.9k
      while (set1 < set_end);
3353
4.66k
      }
3354
3355
1.55k
    if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE;
3356
    /* Might be an empty repeat. */
3357
956
    continue;
3358
1.55k
    }
3359
3360
  /* Some property combinations also acceptable. Unicode property opcodes are
3361
  processed specially; the rest can be handled with a lookup table. */
3362
3363
12.7k
  else
3364
12.7k
    {
3365
12.7k
    pcre_uint32 leftop, rightop;
3366
3367
12.7k
    leftop = base_list[0];
3368
12.7k
    rightop = list[0];
3369
3370
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3371
    accepted = FALSE; /* Always set in non-unicode case. */
3372
    if (leftop == OP_PROP || leftop == OP_NOTPROP)
3373
      {
3374
      if (rightop == OP_EOD)
3375
        accepted = TRUE;
3376
      else if (rightop == OP_PROP || rightop == OP_NOTPROP)
3377
        {
3378
        int n;
3379
        const pcre_uint8 *p;
3380
        BOOL same = leftop == rightop;
3381
        BOOL lisprop = leftop == OP_PROP;
3382
        BOOL risprop = rightop == OP_PROP;
3383
        BOOL bothprop = lisprop && risprop;
3384
3385
        /* There's a table that specifies how each combination is to be
3386
        processed:
3387
          0   Always return FALSE (never auto-possessify)
3388
          1   Character groups are distinct (possessify if both are OP_PROP)
3389
          2   Check character categories in the same group (general or particular)
3390
          3   Return TRUE if the two opcodes are not the same
3391
          ... see comments below
3392
        */
3393
3394
        n = propposstab[base_list[2]][list[2]];
3395
        switch(n)
3396
          {
3397
          case 0: break;
3398
          case 1: accepted = bothprop; break;
3399
          case 2: accepted = (base_list[3] == list[3]) != same; break;
3400
          case 3: accepted = !same; break;
3401
3402
          case 4:  /* Left general category, right particular category */
3403
          accepted = risprop && catposstab[base_list[3]][list[3]] == same;
3404
          break;
3405
3406
          case 5:  /* Right general category, left particular category */
3407
          accepted = lisprop && catposstab[list[3]][base_list[3]] == same;
3408
          break;
3409
3410
          /* This code is logically tricky. Think hard before fiddling with it.
3411
          The posspropstab table has four entries per row. Each row relates to
3412
          one of PCRE's special properties such as ALNUM or SPACE or WORD.
3413
          Only WORD actually needs all four entries, but using repeats for the
3414
          others means they can all use the same code below.
3415
3416
          The first two entries in each row are Unicode general categories, and
3417
          apply always, because all the characters they include are part of the
3418
          PCRE character set. The third and fourth entries are a general and a
3419
          particular category, respectively, that include one or more relevant
3420
          characters. One or the other is used, depending on whether the check
3421
          is for a general or a particular category. However, in both cases the
3422
          category contains more characters than the specials that are defined
3423
          for the property being tested against. Therefore, it cannot be used
3424
          in a NOTPROP case.
3425
3426
          Example: the row for WORD contains ucp_L, ucp_N, ucp_P, ucp_Po.
3427
          Underscore is covered by ucp_P or ucp_Po. */
3428
3429
          case 6:  /* Left alphanum vs right general category */
3430
          case 7:  /* Left space vs right general category */
3431
          case 8:  /* Left word vs right general category */
3432
          p = posspropstab[n-6];
3433
          accepted = risprop && lisprop ==
3434
            (list[3] != p[0] &&
3435
             list[3] != p[1] &&
3436
            (list[3] != p[2] || !lisprop));
3437
          break;
3438
3439
          case 9:   /* Right alphanum vs left general category */
3440
          case 10:  /* Right space vs left general category */
3441
          case 11:  /* Right word vs left general category */
3442
          p = posspropstab[n-9];
3443
          accepted = lisprop && risprop ==
3444
            (base_list[3] != p[0] &&
3445
             base_list[3] != p[1] &&
3446
            (base_list[3] != p[2] || !risprop));
3447
          break;
3448
3449
          case 12:  /* Left alphanum vs right particular category */
3450
          case 13:  /* Left space vs right particular category */
3451
          case 14:  /* Left word vs right particular category */
3452
          p = posspropstab[n-12];
3453
          accepted = risprop && lisprop ==
3454
            (catposstab[p[0]][list[3]] &&
3455
             catposstab[p[1]][list[3]] &&
3456
            (list[3] != p[3] || !lisprop));
3457
          break;
3458
3459
          case 15:  /* Right alphanum vs left particular category */
3460
          case 16:  /* Right space vs left particular category */
3461
          case 17:  /* Right word vs left particular category */
3462
          p = posspropstab[n-15];
3463
          accepted = lisprop && risprop ==
3464
            (catposstab[p[0]][base_list[3]] &&
3465
             catposstab[p[1]][base_list[3]] &&
3466
            (base_list[3] != p[3] || !risprop));
3467
          break;
3468
          }
3469
        }
3470
      }
3471
3472
    else
3473
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
3474
3475
12.7k
    accepted = leftop >= FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP && leftop <= LAST_AUTOTAB_LEFT_OP &&
3476
12.7k
           rightop >= FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP && rightop <= LAST_AUTOTAB_RIGHT_OP &&
3477
12.7k
           autoposstab[leftop - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP][rightop - FIRST_AUTOTAB_OP];
3478
3479
12.7k
    if (!accepted) return FALSE;
3480
3481
1.17k
    if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE;
3482
    /* Might be an empty repeat. */
3483
895
    continue;
3484
1.17k
    }
3485
3486
  /* Control reaches here only if one of the items is a small character list.
3487
  All characters are checked against the other side. */
3488
3489
936k
  do
3490
938k
    {
3491
938k
    chr = *chr_ptr;
3492
3493
938k
    switch(list_ptr[0])
3494
938k
      {
3495
853k
      case OP_CHAR:
3496
853k
      ochr_ptr = list_ptr + 2;
3497
853k
      do
3498
853k
        {
3499
853k
        if (chr == *ochr_ptr) return FALSE;
3500
840k
        ochr_ptr++;
3501
840k
        }
3502
853k
      while(*ochr_ptr != NOTACHAR);
3503
839k
      break;
3504
3505
839k
      case OP_NOT:
3506
10.4k
      ochr_ptr = list_ptr + 2;
3507
10.4k
      do
3508
14.0k
        {
3509
14.0k
        if (chr == *ochr_ptr)
3510
3.67k
          break;
3511
10.3k
        ochr_ptr++;
3512
10.3k
        }
3513
10.4k
      while(*ochr_ptr != NOTACHAR);
3514
10.4k
      if (*ochr_ptr == NOTACHAR) return FALSE;   /* Not found */
3515
3.67k
      break;
3516
3517
      /* Note that OP_DIGIT etc. are generated only when PCRE_UCP is *not*
3518
      set. When it is set, \d etc. are converted into OP_(NOT_)PROP codes. */
3519
3520
3.67k
      case OP_DIGIT:
3521
915
      if (chr < 256 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_digit) != 0) return FALSE;
3522
338
      break;
3523
3524
1.57k
      case OP_NOT_DIGIT:
3525
1.57k
      if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_digit) == 0) return FALSE;
3526
547
      break;
3527
3528
2.24k
      case OP_WHITESPACE:
3529
2.24k
      if (chr < 256 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_space) != 0) return FALSE;
3530
1.72k
      break;
3531
3532
1.72k
      case OP_NOT_WHITESPACE:
3533
808
      if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_space) == 0) return FALSE;
3534
264
      break;
3535
3536
2.10k
      case OP_WORDCHAR:
3537
2.10k
      if (chr < 255 && (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_word) != 0) return FALSE;
3538
1.71k
      break;
3539
3540
4.07k
      case OP_NOT_WORDCHAR:
3541
4.07k
      if (chr > 255 || (cd->ctypes[chr] & ctype_word) == 0) return FALSE;
3542
236
      break;
3543
3544
1.91k
      case OP_HSPACE:
3545
1.91k
      switch(chr)
3546
1.91k
        {
3547
1.50k
        HSPACE_CASES: return FALSE;
3548
417
        default: break;
3549
1.91k
        }
3550
417
      break;
3551
3552
1.34k
      case OP_NOT_HSPACE:
3553
1.34k
      switch(chr)
3554
1.34k
        {
3555
931
        HSPACE_CASES: break;
3556
414
        default: return FALSE;
3557
1.34k
        }
3558
931
      break;
3559
3560
1.36k
      case OP_ANYNL:
3561
2.35k
      case OP_VSPACE:
3562
2.35k
      switch(chr)
3563
2.35k
        {
3564
1.84k
        VSPACE_CASES: return FALSE;
3565
515
        default: break;
3566
2.35k
        }
3567
515
      break;
3568
3569
3.69k
      case OP_NOT_VSPACE:
3570
3.69k
      switch(chr)
3571
3.69k
        {
3572
3.48k
        VSPACE_CASES: break;
3573
214
        default: return FALSE;
3574
3.69k
        }
3575
3.48k
      break;
3576
3577
3.48k
      case OP_DOLL:
3578
28.7k
      case OP_EODN:
3579
28.7k
      switch (chr)
3580
28.7k
        {
3581
253
        case CHAR_CR:
3582
781
        case CHAR_LF:
3583
1.57k
        case CHAR_VT:
3584
1.80k
        case CHAR_FF:
3585
2.08k
        case CHAR_NEL:
3586
2.08k
#ifndef EBCDIC
3587
2.08k
        case 0x2028:
3588
2.08k
        case 0x2029:
3589
2.08k
#endif  /* Not EBCDIC */
3590
2.08k
        return FALSE;
3591
28.7k
        }
3592
26.7k
      break;
3593
3594
26.7k
      case OP_EOD:    /* Can always possessify before \z */
3595
320
      break;
3596
3597
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
3598
      case OP_PROP:
3599
      case OP_NOTPROP:
3600
      if (!check_char_prop(chr, list_ptr[2], list_ptr[3],
3601
            list_ptr[0] == OP_NOTPROP))
3602
        return FALSE;
3603
      break;
3604
#endif
3605
3606
650
      case OP_NCLASS:
3607
650
      if (chr > 255) return FALSE;
3608
      /* Fall through */
3609
3610
9.93k
      case OP_CLASS:
3611
9.93k
      if (chr > 255) break;
3612
9.93k
      class_bitset = (pcre_uint8 *)
3613
9.93k
        ((list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) - list_ptr[2]);
3614
9.93k
      if ((class_bitset[chr >> 3] & (1U << (chr & 7))) != 0) return FALSE;
3615
8.91k
      break;
3616
3617
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3618
      case OP_XCLASS:
3619
      if (PRIV(xclass)(chr, (list_ptr == list ? code : base_end) -
3620
          list_ptr[2] + LINK_SIZE, utf)) return FALSE;
3621
      break;
3622
#endif
3623
3624
15.0k
      default:
3625
15.0k
      return FALSE;
3626
938k
      }
3627
3628
889k
    chr_ptr++;
3629
889k
    }
3630
936k
  while(*chr_ptr != NOTACHAR);
3631
3632
  /* At least one character must be matched from this opcode. */
3633
3634
888k
  if (list[1] == 0) return TRUE;
3635
888k
  }
3636
3637
/* Control never reaches here. There used to be a fail-save return FALSE; here,
3638
but some compilers complain about an unreachable statement. */
3639
3640
4.14M
}
3641
3642
3643
3644
/*************************************************
3645
*    Scan compiled regex for auto-possession     *
3646
*************************************************/
3647
3648
/* Replaces single character iterations with their possessive alternatives
3649
if appropriate. This function modifies the compiled opcode!
3650
3651
Arguments:
3652
  code        points to start of the byte code
3653
  utf         TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
3654
  cd          static compile data
3655
3656
Returns:      nothing
3657
*/
3658
3659
static void
3660
auto_possessify(pcre_uchar *code, BOOL utf, const compile_data *cd)
3661
14.7k
{
3662
14.7k
register pcre_uchar c;
3663
14.7k
const pcre_uchar *end;
3664
14.7k
pcre_uchar *repeat_opcode;
3665
14.7k
pcre_uint32 list[8];
3666
14.7k
int rec_limit;
3667
3668
14.7k
for (;;)
3669
3.51M
  {
3670
3.51M
  c = *code;
3671
3672
  /* When a pattern with bad UTF-8 encoding is compiled with NO_UTF_CHECK,
3673
  it may compile without complaining, but may get into a loop here if the code
3674
  pointer points to a bad value. This is, of course a documentated possibility,
3675
  when NO_UTF_CHECK is set, so it isn't a bug, but we can detect this case and
3676
  just give up on this optimization. */
3677
3678
3.51M
  if (c >= OP_TABLE_LENGTH) return;
3679
3680
3.51M
  if (c >= OP_STAR && c <= OP_TYPEPOSUPTO)
3681
293k
    {
3682
293k
    c -= get_repeat_base(c) - OP_STAR;
3683
293k
    end = (c <= OP_MINUPTO) ?
3684
106k
      get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list) : NULL;
3685
293k
    list[1] = c == OP_STAR || c == OP_PLUS || c == OP_QUERY || c == OP_UPTO;
3686
3687
293k
    rec_limit = 1000;
3688
293k
    if (end != NULL && compare_opcodes(end, utf, cd, list, end, &rec_limit))
3689
31.9k
      {
3690
31.9k
      switch(c)
3691
31.9k
        {
3692
6.08k
        case OP_STAR:
3693
6.08k
        *code += OP_POSSTAR - OP_STAR;
3694
6.08k
        break;
3695
3696
571
        case OP_MINSTAR:
3697
571
        *code += OP_POSSTAR - OP_MINSTAR;
3698
571
        break;
3699
3700
9.90k
        case OP_PLUS:
3701
9.90k
        *code += OP_POSPLUS - OP_PLUS;
3702
9.90k
        break;
3703
3704
417
        case OP_MINPLUS:
3705
417
        *code += OP_POSPLUS - OP_MINPLUS;
3706
417
        break;
3707
3708
13.4k
        case OP_QUERY:
3709
13.4k
        *code += OP_POSQUERY - OP_QUERY;
3710
13.4k
        break;
3711
3712
698
        case OP_MINQUERY:
3713
698
        *code += OP_POSQUERY - OP_MINQUERY;
3714
698
        break;
3715
3716
596
        case OP_UPTO:
3717
596
        *code += OP_POSUPTO - OP_UPTO;
3718
596
        break;
3719
3720
248
        case OP_MINUPTO:
3721
248
        *code += OP_POSUPTO - OP_MINUPTO;
3722
248
        break;
3723
31.9k
        }
3724
31.9k
      }
3725
293k
    c = *code;
3726
293k
    }
3727
3.21M
  else if (c == OP_CLASS || c == OP_NCLASS || c == OP_XCLASS)
3728
23.3k
    {
3729
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3730
    if (c == OP_XCLASS)
3731
      repeat_opcode = code + GET(code, 1);
3732
    else
3733
#endif
3734
23.3k
      repeat_opcode = code + 1 + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar));
3735
3736
23.3k
    c = *repeat_opcode;
3737
23.3k
    if (c >= OP_CRSTAR && c <= OP_CRMINRANGE)
3738
15.3k
      {
3739
      /* end must not be NULL. */
3740
15.3k
      end = get_chr_property_list(code, utf, cd->fcc, list);
3741
3742
15.3k
      list[1] = (c & 1) == 0;
3743
3744
15.3k
      rec_limit = 1000;
3745
15.3k
      if (compare_opcodes(end, utf, cd, list, end, &rec_limit))
3746
7.05k
        {
3747
7.05k
        switch (c)
3748
7.05k
          {
3749
384
          case OP_CRSTAR:
3750
966
          case OP_CRMINSTAR:
3751
966
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSSTAR;
3752
966
          break;
3753
3754
1.40k
          case OP_CRPLUS:
3755
2.39k
          case OP_CRMINPLUS:
3756
2.39k
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSPLUS;
3757
2.39k
          break;
3758
3759
451
          case OP_CRQUERY:
3760
1.66k
          case OP_CRMINQUERY:
3761
1.66k
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSQUERY;
3762
1.66k
          break;
3763
3764
953
          case OP_CRRANGE:
3765
2.02k
          case OP_CRMINRANGE:
3766
2.02k
          *repeat_opcode = OP_CRPOSRANGE;
3767
2.02k
          break;
3768
7.05k
          }
3769
7.05k
        }
3770
15.3k
      }
3771
23.3k
    c = *code;
3772
23.3k
    }
3773
3774
3.51M
  switch(c)
3775
3.51M
    {
3776
14.7k
    case OP_END:
3777
14.7k
    return;
3778
3779
15.6k
    case OP_TYPESTAR:
3780
16.8k
    case OP_TYPEMINSTAR:
3781
20.7k
    case OP_TYPEPLUS:
3782
21.7k
    case OP_TYPEMINPLUS:
3783
30.6k
    case OP_TYPEQUERY:
3784
31.4k
    case OP_TYPEMINQUERY:
3785
34.1k
    case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR:
3786
36.1k
    case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS:
3787
41.7k
    case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY:
3788
41.7k
    if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2;
3789
41.7k
    break;
3790
3791
506
    case OP_TYPEUPTO:
3792
1.26k
    case OP_TYPEMINUPTO:
3793
4.20k
    case OP_TYPEEXACT:
3794
5.57k
    case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO:
3795
5.57k
    if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)
3796
0
      code += 2;
3797
5.57k
    break;
3798
3799
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
3800
    case OP_XCLASS:
3801
    code += GET(code, 1);
3802
    break;
3803
#endif
3804
3805
837
    case OP_MARK:
3806
2.60k
    case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
3807
3.31k
    case OP_SKIP_ARG:
3808
5.36k
    case OP_THEN_ARG:
3809
5.36k
    code += code[1];
3810
5.36k
    break;
3811
3.51M
    }
3812
3813
  /* Add in the fixed length from the table */
3814
3815
3.49M
  code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c];
3816
3817
  /* In UTF-8 mode, opcodes that are followed by a character may be followed by
3818
  a multi-byte character. The length in the table is a minimum, so we have to
3819
  arrange to skip the extra bytes. */
3820
3821
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
3822
  if (utf) switch(c)
3823
    {
3824
    case OP_CHAR:
3825
    case OP_CHARI:
3826
    case OP_NOT:
3827
    case OP_NOTI:
3828
    case OP_STAR:
3829
    case OP_MINSTAR:
3830
    case OP_PLUS:
3831
    case OP_MINPLUS:
3832
    case OP_QUERY:
3833
    case OP_MINQUERY:
3834
    case OP_UPTO:
3835
    case OP_MINUPTO:
3836
    case OP_EXACT:
3837
    case OP_POSSTAR:
3838
    case OP_POSPLUS:
3839
    case OP_POSQUERY:
3840
    case OP_POSUPTO:
3841
    case OP_STARI:
3842
    case OP_MINSTARI:
3843
    case OP_PLUSI:
3844
    case OP_MINPLUSI:
3845
    case OP_QUERYI:
3846
    case OP_MINQUERYI:
3847
    case OP_UPTOI:
3848
    case OP_MINUPTOI:
3849
    case OP_EXACTI:
3850
    case OP_POSSTARI:
3851
    case OP_POSPLUSI:
3852
    case OP_POSQUERYI:
3853
    case OP_POSUPTOI:
3854
    case OP_NOTSTAR:
3855
    case OP_NOTMINSTAR:
3856
    case OP_NOTPLUS:
3857
    case OP_NOTMINPLUS:
3858
    case OP_NOTQUERY:
3859
    case OP_NOTMINQUERY:
3860
    case OP_NOTUPTO:
3861
    case OP_NOTMINUPTO:
3862
    case OP_NOTEXACT:
3863
    case OP_NOTPOSSTAR:
3864
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUS:
3865
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERY:
3866
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTO:
3867
    case OP_NOTSTARI:
3868
    case OP_NOTMINSTARI:
3869
    case OP_NOTPLUSI:
3870
    case OP_NOTMINPLUSI:
3871
    case OP_NOTQUERYI:
3872
    case OP_NOTMINQUERYI:
3873
    case OP_NOTUPTOI:
3874
    case OP_NOTMINUPTOI:
3875
    case OP_NOTEXACTI:
3876
    case OP_NOTPOSSTARI:
3877
    case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI:
3878
    case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI:
3879
    case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI:
3880
    if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]);
3881
    break;
3882
    }
3883
#else
3884
3.49M
  (void)(utf);  /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */
3885
3.49M
#endif
3886
3.49M
  }
3887
14.7k
}
3888
3889
3890
3891
/*************************************************
3892
*           Check for POSIX class syntax         *
3893
*************************************************/
3894
3895
/* This function is called when the sequence "[:" or "[." or "[=" is
3896
encountered in a character class. It checks whether this is followed by a
3897
sequence of characters terminated by a matching ":]" or ".]" or "=]". If we
3898
reach an unescaped ']' without the special preceding character, return FALSE.
3899
3900
Originally, this function only recognized a sequence of letters between the
3901
terminators, but it seems that Perl recognizes any sequence of characters,
3902
though of course unknown POSIX names are subsequently rejected. Perl gives an
3903
"Unknown POSIX class" error for [:f\oo:] for example, where previously PCRE
3904
didn't consider this to be a POSIX class. Likewise for [:1234:].
3905
3906
The problem in trying to be exactly like Perl is in the handling of escapes. We
3907
have to be sure that [abc[:x\]pqr] is *not* treated as containing a POSIX
3908
class, but [abc[:x\]pqr:]] is (so that an error can be generated). The code
3909
below handles the special cases \\ and \], but does not try to do any other
3910
escape processing. This makes it different from Perl for cases such as
3911
[:l\ower:] where Perl recognizes it as the POSIX class "lower" but PCRE does
3912
not recognize "l\ower". This is a lesser evil than not diagnosing bad classes
3913
when Perl does, I think.
3914
3915
A user pointed out that PCRE was rejecting [:a[:digit:]] whereas Perl was not.
3916
It seems that the appearance of a nested POSIX class supersedes an apparent
3917
external class. For example, [:a[:digit:]b:] matches "a", "b", ":", or
3918
a digit.
3919
3920
In Perl, unescaped square brackets may also appear as part of class names. For
3921
example, [:a[:abc]b:] gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b:]". However, for
3922
[:a[:abc]b][b:] it gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b][b:]", which does not
3923
seem right at all. PCRE does not allow closing square brackets in POSIX class
3924
names.
3925
3926
Arguments:
3927
  ptr      pointer to the initial [
3928
  endptr   where to return the end pointer
3929
3930
Returns:   TRUE or FALSE
3931
*/
3932
3933
static BOOL
3934
check_posix_syntax(const pcre_uchar *ptr, const pcre_uchar **endptr)
3935
5.58k
{
3936
5.58k
pcre_uchar terminator;          /* Don't combine these lines; the Solaris cc */
3937
5.58k
terminator = *(++ptr);   /* compiler warns about "non-constant" initializer. */
3938
1.21M
for (++ptr; *ptr != CHAR_NULL; ptr++)
3939
1.21M
  {
3940
1.21M
  if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH &&
3941
1.21M
      (ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET ||
3942
4.05k
       ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH))
3943
843
    ptr++;
3944
1.21M
  else if ((*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && ptr[1] == terminator) ||
3945
1.21M
            *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) return FALSE;
3946
1.21M
  else if (*ptr == terminator && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
3947
1.15k
    {
3948
1.15k
    *endptr = ptr;
3949
1.15k
    return TRUE;
3950
1.15k
    }
3951
1.21M
  }
3952
105
return FALSE;
3953
5.58k
}
3954
3955
3956
3957
3958
/*************************************************
3959
*          Check POSIX class name                *
3960
*************************************************/
3961
3962
/* This function is called to check the name given in a POSIX-style class entry
3963
such as [:alnum:].
3964
3965
Arguments:
3966
  ptr        points to the first letter
3967
  len        the length of the name
3968
3969
Returns:     a value representing the name, or -1 if unknown
3970
*/
3971
3972
static int
3973
check_posix_name(const pcre_uchar *ptr, int len)
3974
1.14k
{
3975
1.14k
const char *pn = posix_names;
3976
1.14k
register int yield = 0;
3977
5.81k
while (posix_name_lengths[yield] != 0)
3978
5.75k
  {
3979
5.75k
  if (len == posix_name_lengths[yield] &&
3980
5.75k
    STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr, pn, (unsigned int)len) == 0) return yield;
3981
4.67k
  pn += posix_name_lengths[yield] + 1;
3982
4.67k
  yield++;
3983
4.67k
  }
3984
67
return -1;
3985
1.14k
}
3986
3987
3988
/*************************************************
3989
*    Adjust OP_RECURSE items in repeated group   *
3990
*************************************************/
3991
3992
/* OP_RECURSE items contain an offset from the start of the regex to the group
3993
that is referenced. This means that groups can be replicated for fixed
3994
repetition simply by copying (because the recursion is allowed to refer to
3995
earlier groups that are outside the current group). However, when a group is
3996
optional (i.e. the minimum quantifier is zero), OP_BRAZERO or OP_SKIPZERO is
3997
inserted before it, after it has been compiled. This means that any OP_RECURSE
3998
items within it that refer to the group itself or any contained groups have to
3999
have their offsets adjusted. That one of the jobs of this function. Before it
4000
is called, the partially compiled regex must be temporarily terminated with
4001
OP_END.
4002
4003
This function has been extended to cope with forward references for recursions
4004
and subroutine calls. It must check the list of such references for the
4005
group we are dealing with. If it finds that one of the recursions in the
4006
current group is on this list, it does not adjust the value in the reference
4007
(which is a group number). After the group has been scanned, all the offsets in
4008
the forward reference list for the group are adjusted.
4009
4010
Arguments:
4011
  group      points to the start of the group
4012
  adjust     the amount by which the group is to be moved
4013
  utf        TRUE in UTF-8 / UTF-16 / UTF-32 mode
4014
  cd         contains pointers to tables etc.
4015
  save_hwm_offset   the hwm forward reference offset at the start of the group
4016
4017
Returns:     nothing
4018
*/
4019
4020
static void
4021
adjust_recurse(pcre_uchar *group, int adjust, BOOL utf, compile_data *cd,
4022
  size_t save_hwm_offset)
4023
16.2k
{
4024
16.2k
int offset;
4025
16.2k
pcre_uchar *hc;
4026
16.2k
pcre_uchar *ptr = group;
4027
4028
69.1k
while ((ptr = (pcre_uchar *)find_recurse(ptr, utf)) != NULL)
4029
52.8k
  {
4030
66.5M
  for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + save_hwm_offset; hc < cd->hwm;
4031
66.5M
       hc += LINK_SIZE)
4032
66.5M
    {
4033
66.5M
    offset = (int)GET(hc, 0);
4034
66.5M
    if (cd->start_code + offset == ptr + 1) break;
4035
66.5M
    }
4036
4037
  /* If we have not found this recursion on the forward reference list, adjust
4038
  the recursion's offset if it's after the start of this group. */
4039
4040
52.8k
  if (hc >= cd->hwm)
4041
20.6k
    {
4042
20.6k
    offset = (int)GET(ptr, 1);
4043
20.6k
    if (cd->start_code + offset >= group) PUT(ptr, 1, offset + adjust);
4044
20.6k
    }
4045
4046
52.8k
  ptr += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
4047
52.8k
  }
4048
4049
/* Now adjust all forward reference offsets for the group. */
4050
4051
50.2k
for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + save_hwm_offset; hc < cd->hwm;
4052
34.0k
     hc += LINK_SIZE)
4053
34.0k
  {
4054
34.0k
  offset = (int)GET(hc, 0);
4055
34.0k
  PUT(hc, 0, offset + adjust);
4056
34.0k
  }
4057
16.2k
}
4058
4059
4060
4061
/*************************************************
4062
*        Insert an automatic callout point       *
4063
*************************************************/
4064
4065
/* This function is called when the PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT option is set, to insert
4066
callout points before each pattern item.
4067
4068
Arguments:
4069
  code           current code pointer
4070
  ptr            current pattern pointer
4071
  cd             pointers to tables etc
4072
4073
Returns:         new code pointer
4074
*/
4075
4076
static pcre_uchar *
4077
auto_callout(pcre_uchar *code, const pcre_uchar *ptr, compile_data *cd)
4078
0
{
4079
0
*code++ = OP_CALLOUT;
4080
0
*code++ = 255;
4081
0
PUT(code, 0, (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern));  /* Pattern offset */
4082
0
PUT(code, LINK_SIZE, 0);                       /* Default length */
4083
0
return code + 2 * LINK_SIZE;
4084
0
}
4085
4086
4087
4088
/*************************************************
4089
*         Complete a callout item                *
4090
*************************************************/
4091
4092
/* A callout item contains the length of the next item in the pattern, which
4093
we can't fill in till after we have reached the relevant point. This is used
4094
for both automatic and manual callouts.
4095
4096
Arguments:
4097
  previous_callout   points to previous callout item
4098
  ptr                current pattern pointer
4099
  cd                 pointers to tables etc
4100
4101
Returns:             nothing
4102
*/
4103
4104
static void
4105
complete_callout(pcre_uchar *previous_callout, const pcre_uchar *ptr, compile_data *cd)
4106
1.11k
{
4107
1.11k
int length = (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern - GET(previous_callout, 2));
4108
1.11k
PUT(previous_callout, 2 + LINK_SIZE, length);
4109
1.11k
}
4110
4111
4112
4113
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
4114
/*************************************************
4115
*           Get othercase range                  *
4116
*************************************************/
4117
4118
/* This function is passed the start and end of a class range, in UTF-8 mode
4119
with UCP support. It searches up the characters, looking for ranges of
4120
characters in the "other" case. Each call returns the next one, updating the
4121
start address. A character with multiple other cases is returned on its own
4122
with a special return value.
4123
4124
Arguments:
4125
  cptr        points to starting character value; updated
4126
  d           end value
4127
  ocptr       where to put start of othercase range
4128
  odptr       where to put end of othercase range
4129
4130
Yield:        -1 when no more
4131
               0 when a range is returned
4132
              >0 the CASESET offset for char with multiple other cases
4133
                in this case, ocptr contains the original
4134
*/
4135
4136
static int
4137
get_othercase_range(pcre_uint32 *cptr, pcre_uint32 d, pcre_uint32 *ocptr,
4138
  pcre_uint32 *odptr)
4139
{
4140
pcre_uint32 c, othercase, next;
4141
unsigned int co;
4142
4143
/* Find the first character that has an other case. If it has multiple other
4144
cases, return its case offset value. */
4145
4146
for (c = *cptr; c <= d; c++)
4147
  {
4148
  if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
4149
    {
4150
    *ocptr = c++;   /* Character that has the set */
4151
    *cptr = c;      /* Rest of input range */
4152
    return (int)co;
4153
    }
4154
  if ((othercase = UCD_OTHERCASE(c)) != c) break;
4155
  }
4156
4157
if (c > d) return -1;  /* Reached end of range */
4158
4159
/* Found a character that has a single other case. Search for the end of the
4160
range, which is either the end of the input range, or a character that has zero
4161
or more than one other cases. */
4162
4163
*ocptr = othercase;
4164
next = othercase + 1;
4165
4166
for (++c; c <= d; c++)
4167
  {
4168
  if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0 || UCD_OTHERCASE(c) != next) break;
4169
  next++;
4170
  }
4171
4172
*odptr = next - 1;     /* End of othercase range */
4173
*cptr = c;             /* Rest of input range */
4174
return 0;
4175
}
4176
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
4177
4178
4179
4180
/*************************************************
4181
*        Add a character or range to a class     *
4182
*************************************************/
4183
4184
/* This function packages up the logic of adding a character or range of
4185
characters to a class. The character values in the arguments will be within the
4186
valid values for the current mode (8-bit, 16-bit, UTF, etc). This function is
4187
mutually recursive with the function immediately below.
4188
4189
Arguments:
4190
  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
4191
  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
4192
  options       the options word
4193
  cd            contains pointers to tables etc.
4194
  start         start of range character
4195
  end           end of range character
4196
4197
Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
4198
                the pointer to extra data is updated
4199
*/
4200
4201
static int
4202
add_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr, int options,
4203
  compile_data *cd, pcre_uint32 start, pcre_uint32 end)
4204
353k
{
4205
353k
pcre_uint32 c;
4206
353k
pcre_uint32 classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
4207
353k
int n8 = 0;
4208
4209
353k
((void)uchardptr);
4210
353k
((void)propposstab);
4211
353k
((void)catposstab);
4212
353k
((void)posspropstab);
4213
4214
/* If caseless matching is required, scan the range and process alternate
4215
cases. In Unicode, there are 8-bit characters that have alternate cases that
4216
are greater than 255 and vice-versa. Sometimes we can just extend the original
4217
range. */
4218
4219
353k
if ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)
4220
63.5k
  {
4221
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
4222
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0)
4223
    {
4224
    int rc;
4225
    pcre_uint32 oc, od;
4226
4227
    options &= ~PCRE_CASELESS;   /* Remove for recursive calls */
4228
    c = start;
4229
4230
    while ((rc = get_othercase_range(&c, end, &oc, &od)) >= 0)
4231
      {
4232
      /* Handle a single character that has more than one other case. */
4233
4234
      if (rc > 0) n8 += add_list_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd,
4235
        PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + rc, oc);
4236
4237
      /* Do nothing if the other case range is within the original range. */
4238
4239
      else if (oc >= start && od <= end) continue;
4240
4241
      /* Extend the original range if there is overlap, noting that if oc < c, we
4242
      can't have od > end because a subrange is always shorter than the basic
4243
      range. Otherwise, use a recursive call to add the additional range. */
4244
4245
      else if (oc < start && od >= start - 1) start = oc; /* Extend downwards */
4246
      else if (od > end && oc <= end + 1)
4247
        {
4248
        end = od;       /* Extend upwards */
4249
        if (end > classbits_end) classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff);
4250
        }
4251
      else n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, oc, od);
4252
      }
4253
    }
4254
  else
4255
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UCP */
4256
4257
  /* Not UTF-mode, or no UCP */
4258
4259
150k
  for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
4260
87.3k
    {
4261
87.3k
    SETBIT(classbits, cd->fcc[c]);
4262
87.3k
    n8++;
4263
87.3k
    }
4264
63.5k
  }
4265
4266
/* Now handle the original range. Adjust the final value according to the bit
4267
length - this means that the same lists of (e.g.) horizontal spaces can be used
4268
in all cases. */
4269
4270
353k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4271
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4272
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) == 0)
4273
#endif
4274
353k
  if (end > 0xff) end = 0xff;
4275
4276
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
4277
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4278
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF16) == 0)
4279
#endif
4280
  if (end > 0xffff) end = 0xffff;
4281
4282
#endif /* COMPILE_PCRE[8|16] */
4283
4284
/* Use the bitmap for characters < 256. Otherwise use extra data.*/
4285
4286
980k
for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++)
4287
627k
  {
4288
  /* Regardless of start, c will always be <= 255. */
4289
627k
  SETBIT(classbits, c);
4290
627k
  n8++;
4291
627k
  }
4292
4293
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4294
if (start <= 0xff) start = 0xff + 1;
4295
4296
if (end >= start)
4297
  {
4298
  pcre_uchar *uchardata = *uchardptr;
4299
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4300
  if ((options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0)  /* All UTFs use the same flag bit */
4301
    {
4302
    if (start < end)
4303
      {
4304
      *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
4305
      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
4306
      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(end, uchardata);
4307
      }
4308
    else if (start == end)
4309
      {
4310
      *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
4311
      uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata);
4312
      }
4313
    }
4314
  else
4315
#endif  /* SUPPORT_UTF */
4316
4317
  /* Without UTF support, character values are constrained by the bit length,
4318
  and can only be > 256 for 16-bit and 32-bit libraries. */
4319
4320
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
4321
    {}
4322
#else
4323
  if (start < end)
4324
    {
4325
    *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
4326
    *uchardata++ = start;
4327
    *uchardata++ = end;
4328
    }
4329
  else if (start == end)
4330
    {
4331
    *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE;
4332
    *uchardata++ = start;
4333
    }
4334
#endif
4335
4336
  *uchardptr = uchardata;   /* Updata extra data pointer */
4337
  }
4338
#endif /* SUPPORT_UTF || !COMPILE_PCRE8 */
4339
4340
353k
return n8;    /* Number of 8-bit characters */
4341
353k
}
4342
4343
4344
4345
4346
/*************************************************
4347
*        Add a list of characters to a class     *
4348
*************************************************/
4349
4350
/* This function is used for adding a list of case-equivalent characters to a
4351
class, and also for adding a list of horizontal or vertical whitespace. If the
4352
list is in order (which it should be), ranges of characters are detected and
4353
handled appropriately. This function is mutually recursive with the function
4354
above.
4355
4356
Arguments:
4357
  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
4358
  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
4359
  options       the options word
4360
  cd            contains pointers to tables etc.
4361
  p             points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
4362
  except        character to omit; this is used when adding lists of
4363
                  case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we
4364
                  already know about
4365
4366
Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
4367
                the pointer to extra data is updated
4368
*/
4369
4370
static int
4371
add_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr, int options,
4372
  compile_data *cd, const pcre_uint32 *p, unsigned int except)
4373
806
{
4374
806
int n8 = 0;
4375
6.12k
while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
4376
5.32k
  {
4377
5.32k
  int n = 0;
4378
5.32k
  if (p[0] != except)
4379
5.32k
    {
4380
11.4k
    while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++;
4381
5.32k
    n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, p[0], p[n]);
4382
5.32k
    }
4383
5.32k
  p += n + 1;
4384
5.32k
  }
4385
806
return n8;
4386
806
}
4387
4388
4389
4390
/*************************************************
4391
*    Add characters not in a list to a class     *
4392
*************************************************/
4393
4394
/* This function is used for adding the complement of a list of horizontal or
4395
vertical whitespace to a class. The list must be in order.
4396
4397
Arguments:
4398
  classbits     the bit map for characters < 256
4399
  uchardptr     points to the pointer for extra data
4400
  options       the options word
4401
  cd            contains pointers to tables etc.
4402
  p             points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR
4403
4404
Returns:        the number of < 256 characters added
4405
                the pointer to extra data is updated
4406
*/
4407
4408
static int
4409
add_not_list_to_class(pcre_uint8 *classbits, pcre_uchar **uchardptr,
4410
  int options, compile_data *cd, const pcre_uint32 *p)
4411
690
{
4412
690
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
4413
690
int n8 = 0;
4414
690
if (p[0] > 0)
4415
690
  n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, 0, p[0] - 1);
4416
5.53k
while (p[0] < NOTACHAR)
4417
4.84k
  {
4418
10.3k
  while (p[1] == p[0] + 1) p++;
4419
4.84k
  n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cd, p[0] + 1,
4420
4.84k
    (p[1] == NOTACHAR) ? (utf ? 0x10ffffu : 0xffffffffu) : p[1] - 1);
4421
4.84k
  p++;
4422
4.84k
  }
4423
690
return n8;
4424
690
}
4425
4426
4427
4428
/*************************************************
4429
*           Compile one branch                   *
4430
*************************************************/
4431
4432
/* Scan the pattern, compiling it into the a vector. If the options are
4433
changed during the branch, the pointer is used to change the external options
4434
bits. This function is used during the pre-compile phase when we are trying
4435
to find out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the real compile
4436
phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases.
4437
4438
Arguments:
4439
  optionsptr        pointer to the option bits
4440
  codeptr           points to the pointer to the current code point
4441
  ptrptr            points to the current pattern pointer
4442
  errorcodeptr      points to error code variable
4443
  firstcharptr      place to put the first required character
4444
  firstcharflagsptr place to put the first character flags, or a negative number
4445
  reqcharptr        place to put the last required character
4446
  reqcharflagsptr   place to put the last required character flags, or a negative number
4447
  bcptr             points to current branch chain
4448
  cond_depth        conditional nesting depth
4449
  cd                contains pointers to tables etc.
4450
  lengthptr         NULL during the real compile phase
4451
                    points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
4452
4453
Returns:            TRUE on success
4454
                    FALSE, with *errorcodeptr set non-zero on error
4455
*/
4456
4457
static BOOL
4458
compile_branch(int *optionsptr, pcre_uchar **codeptr,
4459
  const pcre_uchar **ptrptr, int *errorcodeptr,
4460
  pcre_uint32 *firstcharptr, pcre_int32 *firstcharflagsptr,
4461
  pcre_uint32 *reqcharptr, pcre_int32 *reqcharflagsptr,
4462
  branch_chain *bcptr, int cond_depth,
4463
  compile_data *cd, int *lengthptr)
4464
965k
{
4465
965k
int repeat_type, op_type;
4466
965k
int repeat_min = 0, repeat_max = 0;      /* To please picky compilers */
4467
965k
int bravalue = 0;
4468
965k
int greedy_default, greedy_non_default;
4469
965k
pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar;
4470
965k
pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags;
4471
965k
pcre_uint32 zeroreqchar, zerofirstchar;
4472
965k
pcre_int32 zeroreqcharflags, zerofirstcharflags;
4473
965k
pcre_int32 req_caseopt, reqvary, tempreqvary;
4474
965k
int options = *optionsptr;               /* May change dynamically */
4475
965k
int after_manual_callout = 0;
4476
965k
int length_prevgroup = 0;
4477
965k
register pcre_uint32 c;
4478
965k
int escape;
4479
965k
register pcre_uchar *code = *codeptr;
4480
965k
pcre_uchar *last_code = code;
4481
965k
pcre_uchar *orig_code = code;
4482
965k
pcre_uchar *tempcode;
4483
965k
BOOL inescq = FALSE;
4484
965k
BOOL groupsetfirstchar = FALSE;
4485
965k
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr;
4486
965k
const pcre_uchar *tempptr;
4487
965k
const pcre_uchar *nestptr = NULL;
4488
965k
pcre_uchar *previous = NULL;
4489
965k
pcre_uchar *previous_callout = NULL;
4490
965k
size_t item_hwm_offset = 0;
4491
965k
pcre_uint8 classbits[32];
4492
4493
/* We can fish out the UTF-8 setting once and for all into a BOOL, but we
4494
must not do this for other options (e.g. PCRE_EXTENDED) because they may change
4495
dynamically as we process the pattern. */
4496
4497
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4498
/* PCRE_UTF[16|32] have the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */
4499
BOOL utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
4500
#ifndef COMPILE_PCRE32
4501
pcre_uchar utf_chars[6];
4502
#endif
4503
#else
4504
965k
BOOL utf = FALSE;
4505
965k
#endif
4506
4507
/* Helper variables for OP_XCLASS opcode (for characters > 255). We define
4508
class_uchardata always so that it can be passed to add_to_class() always,
4509
though it will not be used in non-UTF 8-bit cases. This avoids having to supply
4510
alternative calls for the different cases. */
4511
4512
965k
pcre_uchar *class_uchardata;
4513
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4514
BOOL xclass;
4515
pcre_uchar *class_uchardata_base;
4516
#endif
4517
4518
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
4519
if (lengthptr != NULL) DPRINTF((">> start branch\n"));
4520
#endif
4521
4522
/* Set up the default and non-default settings for greediness */
4523
4524
965k
greedy_default = ((options & PCRE_UNGREEDY) != 0);
4525
965k
greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
4526
4527
/* Initialize no first byte, no required byte. REQ_UNSET means "no char
4528
matching encountered yet". It gets changed to REQ_NONE if we hit something that
4529
matches a non-fixed char first char; reqchar just remains unset if we never
4530
find one.
4531
4532
When we hit a repeat whose minimum is zero, we may have to adjust these values
4533
to take the zero repeat into account. This is implemented by setting them to
4534
zerofirstbyte and zeroreqchar when such a repeat is encountered. The individual
4535
item types that can be repeated set these backoff variables appropriately. */
4536
4537
965k
firstchar = reqchar = zerofirstchar = zeroreqchar = 0;
4538
965k
firstcharflags = reqcharflags = zerofirstcharflags = zeroreqcharflags = REQ_UNSET;
4539
4540
/* The variable req_caseopt contains either the REQ_CASELESS value
4541
or zero, according to the current setting of the caseless flag. The
4542
REQ_CASELESS leaves the lower 28 bit empty. It is added into the
4543
firstchar or reqchar variables to record the case status of the
4544
value. This is used only for ASCII characters. */
4545
4546
965k
req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS:0;
4547
4548
/* Switch on next character until the end of the branch */
4549
4550
2.53M
for (;; ptr++)
4551
3.50M
  {
4552
3.50M
  BOOL negate_class;
4553
3.50M
  BOOL should_flip_negation;
4554
3.50M
  BOOL possessive_quantifier;
4555
3.50M
  BOOL is_quantifier;
4556
3.50M
  BOOL is_recurse;
4557
3.50M
  BOOL reset_bracount;
4558
3.50M
  int class_has_8bitchar;
4559
3.50M
  int class_one_char;
4560
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4561
  BOOL xclass_has_prop;
4562
#endif
4563
3.50M
  int newoptions;
4564
3.50M
  int recno;
4565
3.50M
  int refsign;
4566
3.50M
  int skipbytes;
4567
3.50M
  pcre_uint32 subreqchar, subfirstchar;
4568
3.50M
  pcre_int32 subreqcharflags, subfirstcharflags;
4569
3.50M
  int terminator;
4570
3.50M
  unsigned int mclength;
4571
3.50M
  unsigned int tempbracount;
4572
3.50M
  pcre_uint32 ec;
4573
3.50M
  pcre_uchar mcbuffer[8];
4574
4575
  /* Come here to restart the loop without advancing the pointer. */
4576
4577
3.50M
  REDO_LOOP:
4578
4579
  /* Get next character in the pattern */
4580
4581
3.50M
  c = *ptr;
4582
4583
  /* If we are at the end of a nested substitution, revert to the outer level
4584
  string. Nesting only happens one level deep. */
4585
4586
3.50M
  if (c == CHAR_NULL && nestptr != NULL)
4587
543
    {
4588
543
    ptr = nestptr;
4589
543
    nestptr = NULL;
4590
543
    c = *ptr;
4591
543
    }
4592
4593
  /* If we are in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length used for the
4594
  previous cycle of this loop. */
4595
4596
3.50M
  if (lengthptr != NULL)
4597
2.55M
    {
4598
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
4599
    if (code > cd->hwm) cd->hwm = code;                 /* High water info */
4600
#endif
4601
2.55M
    if (code > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
4602
2.55M
        WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)                       /* Check for overrun */
4603
1
      {
4604
1
      *errorcodeptr = (code >= cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size)?
4605
1
        ERR52 : ERR87;
4606
1
      goto FAILED;
4607
1
      }
4608
4609
    /* There is at least one situation where code goes backwards: this is the
4610
    case of a zero quantifier after a class (e.g. [ab]{0}). At compile time,
4611
    the class is simply eliminated. However, it is created first, so we have to
4612
    allow memory for it. Therefore, don't ever reduce the length at this point.
4613
    */
4614
4615
2.55M
    if (code < last_code) code = last_code;
4616
4617
    /* Paranoid check for integer overflow */
4618
4619
2.55M
    if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < code - last_code)
4620
10
      {
4621
10
      *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
4622
10
      goto FAILED;
4623
10
      }
4624
4625
2.55M
    *lengthptr += (int)(code - last_code);
4626
2.55M
    DPRINTF(("length=%d added %d c=%c (0x%x)\n", *lengthptr,
4627
2.55M
      (int)(code - last_code), c, c));
4628
4629
    /* If "previous" is set and it is not at the start of the work space, move
4630
    it back to there, in order to avoid filling up the work space. Otherwise,
4631
    if "previous" is NULL, reset the current code pointer to the start. */
4632
4633
2.55M
    if (previous != NULL)
4634
1.64M
      {
4635
1.64M
      if (previous > orig_code)
4636
1.17M
        {
4637
1.17M
        memmove(orig_code, previous, IN_UCHARS(code - previous));
4638
1.17M
        code -= previous - orig_code;
4639
1.17M
        previous = orig_code;
4640
1.17M
        }
4641
1.64M
      }
4642
908k
    else code = orig_code;
4643
4644
    /* Remember where this code item starts so we can pick up the length
4645
    next time round. */
4646
4647
2.55M
    last_code = code;
4648
2.55M
    }
4649
4650
  /* In the real compile phase, just check the workspace used by the forward
4651
  reference list. */
4652
4653
948k
  else if (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size)
4654
0
    {
4655
0
    *errorcodeptr = ERR52;
4656
0
    goto FAILED;
4657
0
    }
4658
4659
  /* If in \Q...\E, check for the end; if not, we have a literal. Otherwise an
4660
  isolated \E is ignored. */
4661
4662
3.50M
  if (c != CHAR_NULL)
4663
3.47M
    {
4664
3.47M
    if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E)
4665
3.17k
      {
4666
3.17k
      inescq = FALSE;
4667
3.17k
      ptr++;
4668
3.17k
      continue;
4669
3.17k
      }
4670
3.46M
    else if (inescq)
4671
62.9k
      {
4672
62.9k
      if (previous_callout != NULL)
4673
1.57k
        {
4674
1.57k
        if (lengthptr == NULL)  /* Don't attempt in pre-compile phase */
4675
765
          complete_callout(previous_callout, ptr, cd);
4676
1.57k
        previous_callout = NULL;
4677
1.57k
        }
4678
62.9k
      if ((options & PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0)
4679
0
        {
4680
0
        previous_callout = code;
4681
0
        code = auto_callout(code, ptr, cd);
4682
0
        }
4683
62.9k
      goto NORMAL_CHAR;
4684
62.9k
      }
4685
4686
    /* Check for the start of a \Q...\E sequence. We must do this here rather
4687
    than later in case it is immediately followed by \E, which turns it into a
4688
    "do nothing" sequence. */
4689
4690
3.40M
    if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_Q)
4691
2.04k
      {
4692
2.04k
      inescq = TRUE;
4693
2.04k
      ptr++;
4694
2.04k
      continue;
4695
2.04k
      }
4696
3.40M
    }
4697
4698
  /* In extended mode, skip white space and comments. */
4699
4700
3.43M
  if ((options & PCRE_EXTENDED) != 0)
4701
92.8k
    {
4702
92.8k
    const pcre_uchar *wscptr = ptr;
4703
93.5k
    while (MAX_255(c) && (cd->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) != 0) c = *(++ptr);
4704
92.8k
    if (c == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
4705
1.81k
      {
4706
1.81k
      ptr++;
4707
4.67k
      while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL)
4708
4.60k
        {
4709
4.60k
        if (IS_NEWLINE(ptr))         /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */
4710
1.74k
          {                          /* IS_NEWLINE sets cd->nllen. */
4711
1.74k
          ptr += cd->nllen;
4712
1.74k
          break;
4713
1.74k
          }
4714
2.86k
        ptr++;
4715
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4716
        if (utf) FORWARDCHAR(ptr);
4717
#endif
4718
2.86k
        }
4719
1.81k
      }
4720
4721
    /* If we skipped any characters, restart the loop. Otherwise, we didn't see
4722
    a comment. */
4723
4724
92.8k
    if (ptr > wscptr) goto REDO_LOOP;
4725
92.8k
    }
4726
4727
  /* Skip over (?# comments. We need to do this here because we want to know if
4728
  the next thing is a quantifier, and these comments may come between an item
4729
  and its quantifier. */
4730
4731
3.43M
  if (c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
4732
3.43M
      ptr[2] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
4733
241
    {
4734
241
    ptr += 3;
4735
766
    while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++;
4736
241
    if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL)
4737
16
      {
4738
16
      *errorcodeptr = ERR18;
4739
16
      goto FAILED;
4740
16
      }
4741
225
    continue;
4742
241
    }
4743
4744
  /* See if the next thing is a quantifier. */
4745
4746
3.43M
  is_quantifier =
4747
3.43M
    c == CHAR_ASTERISK || c == CHAR_PLUS || c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK ||
4748
3.43M
    (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET && is_counted_repeat(ptr+1));
4749
4750
  /* Fill in length of a previous callout, except when the next thing is a
4751
  quantifier or when processing a property substitution string in UCP mode. */
4752
4753
3.43M
  if (!is_quantifier && previous_callout != NULL && nestptr == NULL &&
4754
3.43M
       after_manual_callout-- <= 0)
4755
863
    {
4756
863
    if (lengthptr == NULL)      /* Don't attempt in pre-compile phase */
4757
346
      complete_callout(previous_callout, ptr, cd);
4758
863
    previous_callout = NULL;
4759
863
    }
4760
4761
  /* Create auto callout, except for quantifiers, or while processing property
4762
  strings that are substituted for \w etc in UCP mode. */
4763
4764
3.43M
  if ((options & PCRE_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0 && !is_quantifier && nestptr == NULL)
4765
0
    {
4766
0
    previous_callout = code;
4767
0
    code = auto_callout(code, ptr, cd);
4768
0
    }
4769
4770
  /* Process the next pattern item. */
4771
4772
3.43M
  switch(c)
4773
3.43M
    {
4774
    /* ===================================================================*/
4775
31.7k
    case CHAR_NULL:                /* The branch terminates at string end */
4776
132k
    case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE:       /* or | or ) */
4777
949k
    case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS:
4778
949k
    *firstcharptr = firstchar;
4779
949k
    *firstcharflagsptr = firstcharflags;
4780
949k
    *reqcharptr = reqchar;
4781
949k
    *reqcharflagsptr = reqcharflags;
4782
949k
    *codeptr = code;
4783
949k
    *ptrptr = ptr;
4784
949k
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
4785
762k
      {
4786
762k
      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < code - last_code)
4787
0
        {
4788
0
        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
4789
0
        goto FAILED;
4790
0
        }
4791
762k
      *lengthptr += (int)(code - last_code);   /* To include callout length */
4792
762k
      DPRINTF((">> end branch\n"));
4793
762k
      }
4794
949k
    return TRUE;
4795
4796
4797
    /* ===================================================================*/
4798
    /* Handle single-character metacharacters. In multiline mode, ^ disables
4799
    the setting of any following char as a first character. */
4800
4801
90.0k
    case CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT:
4802
90.0k
    previous = NULL;
4803
90.0k
    if ((options & PCRE_MULTILINE) != 0)
4804
39.3k
      {
4805
39.3k
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
4806
10.0k
        zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
4807
39.3k
      *code++ = OP_CIRCM;
4808
39.3k
      }
4809
50.6k
    else *code++ = OP_CIRC;
4810
90.0k
    break;
4811
4812
2.52k
    case CHAR_DOLLAR_SIGN:
4813
2.52k
    previous = NULL;
4814
2.52k
    *code++ = ((options & PCRE_MULTILINE) != 0)? OP_DOLLM : OP_DOLL;
4815
2.52k
    break;
4816
4817
    /* There can never be a first char if '.' is first, whatever happens about
4818
    repeats. The value of reqchar doesn't change either. */
4819
4820
36.0k
    case CHAR_DOT:
4821
36.0k
    if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
4822
36.0k
    zerofirstchar = firstchar;
4823
36.0k
    zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
4824
36.0k
    zeroreqchar = reqchar;
4825
36.0k
    zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
4826
36.0k
    previous = code;
4827
36.0k
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
4828
36.0k
    *code++ = ((options & PCRE_DOTALL) != 0)? OP_ALLANY: OP_ANY;
4829
36.0k
    break;
4830
4831
4832
    /* ===================================================================*/
4833
    /* Character classes. If the included characters are all < 256, we build a
4834
    32-byte bitmap of the permitted characters, except in the special case
4835
    where there is only one such character. For negated classes, we build the
4836
    map as usual, then invert it at the end. However, we use a different opcode
4837
    so that data characters > 255 can be handled correctly.
4838
4839
    If the class contains characters outside the 0-255 range, a different
4840
    opcode is compiled. It may optionally have a bit map for characters < 256,
4841
    but those above are are explicitly listed afterwards. A flag byte tells
4842
    whether the bitmap is present, and whether this is a negated class or not.
4843
4844
    In JavaScript compatibility mode, an isolated ']' causes an error. In
4845
    default (Perl) mode, it is treated as a data character. */
4846
4847
12.3k
    case CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET:
4848
12.3k
    if ((cd->external_options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
4849
0
      {
4850
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR64;
4851
0
      goto FAILED;
4852
0
      }
4853
12.3k
    goto NORMAL_CHAR;
4854
4855
    /* In another (POSIX) regex library, the ugly syntax [[:<:]] and [[:>:]] is
4856
    used for "start of word" and "end of word". As these are otherwise illegal
4857
    sequences, we don't break anything by recognizing them. They are replaced
4858
    by \b(?=\w) and \b(?<=\w) respectively. Sequences like [a[:<:]] are
4859
    erroneous and are handled by the normal code below. */
4860
4861
17.9k
    case CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET:
4862
17.9k
    if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+1, STRING_WEIRD_STARTWORD, 6) == 0)
4863
303
      {
4864
303
      nestptr = ptr + 7;
4865
303
      ptr = sub_start_of_word;
4866
303
      goto REDO_LOOP;
4867
303
      }
4868
4869
17.6k
    if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+1, STRING_WEIRD_ENDWORD, 6) == 0)
4870
240
      {
4871
240
      nestptr = ptr + 7;
4872
240
      ptr = sub_end_of_word;
4873
240
      goto REDO_LOOP;
4874
240
      }
4875
4876
    /* Handle a real character class. */
4877
4878
17.3k
    previous = code;
4879
17.3k
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
4880
4881
    /* PCRE supports POSIX class stuff inside a class. Perl gives an error if
4882
    they are encountered at the top level, so we'll do that too. */
4883
4884
17.3k
    if ((ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT ||
4885
17.3k
         ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
4886
17.3k
        check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr))
4887
2
      {
4888
2
      *errorcodeptr = (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON)? ERR13 : ERR31;
4889
2
      goto FAILED;
4890
2
      }
4891
4892
    /* If the first character is '^', set the negation flag and skip it. Also,
4893
    if the first few characters (either before or after ^) are \Q\E or \E we
4894
    skip them too. This makes for compatibility with Perl. */
4895
4896
17.3k
    negate_class = FALSE;
4897
17.3k
    for (;;)
4898
22.1k
      {
4899
22.1k
      c = *(++ptr);
4900
22.1k
      if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
4901
1.81k
        {
4902
1.81k
        if (ptr[1] == CHAR_E)
4903
247
          ptr++;
4904
1.57k
        else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr + 1, STR_Q STR_BACKSLASH STR_E, 3) == 0)
4905
201
          ptr += 3;
4906
1.37k
        else
4907
1.37k
          break;
4908
1.81k
        }
4909
20.3k
      else if (!negate_class && c == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
4910
4.31k
        negate_class = TRUE;
4911
15.9k
      else break;
4912
22.1k
      }
4913
4914
    /* Empty classes are allowed in JavaScript compatibility mode. Otherwise,
4915
    an initial ']' is taken as a data character -- the code below handles
4916
    that. In JS mode, [] must always fail, so generate OP_FAIL, whereas
4917
    [^] must match any character, so generate OP_ALLANY. */
4918
4919
17.3k
    if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
4920
17.3k
        (cd->external_options & PCRE_JAVASCRIPT_COMPAT) != 0)
4921
0
      {
4922
0
      *code++ = negate_class? OP_ALLANY : OP_FAIL;
4923
0
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
4924
0
      zerofirstchar = firstchar;
4925
0
      zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
4926
0
      break;
4927
0
      }
4928
4929
    /* If a class contains a negative special such as \S, we need to flip the
4930
    negation flag at the end, so that support for characters > 255 works
4931
    correctly (they are all included in the class). */
4932
4933
17.3k
    should_flip_negation = FALSE;
4934
4935
    /* Extended class (xclass) will be used when characters > 255
4936
    might match. */
4937
4938
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4939
    xclass = FALSE;
4940
    class_uchardata = code + LINK_SIZE + 2;   /* For XCLASS items */
4941
    class_uchardata_base = class_uchardata;   /* Save the start */
4942
#endif
4943
4944
    /* For optimization purposes, we track some properties of the class:
4945
    class_has_8bitchar will be non-zero if the class contains at least one <
4946
    256 character; class_one_char will be 1 if the class contains just one
4947
    character; xclass_has_prop will be TRUE if unicode property checks
4948
    are present in the class. */
4949
4950
17.3k
    class_has_8bitchar = 0;
4951
17.3k
    class_one_char = 0;
4952
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4953
    xclass_has_prop = FALSE;
4954
#endif
4955
4956
    /* Initialize the 32-char bit map to all zeros. We build the map in a
4957
    temporary bit of memory, in case the class contains fewer than two
4958
    8-bit characters because in that case the compiled code doesn't use the bit
4959
    map. */
4960
4961
17.3k
    memset(classbits, 0, 32 * sizeof(pcre_uint8));
4962
4963
    /* Process characters until ] is reached. By writing this as a "do" it
4964
    means that an initial ] is taken as a data character. At the start of the
4965
    loop, c contains the first byte of the character. */
4966
4967
17.3k
    if (c != CHAR_NULL) do
4968
599k
      {
4969
599k
      const pcre_uchar *oldptr;
4970
4971
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
4972
      if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(c))
4973
        {                           /* Braces are required because the */
4974
        GETCHARLEN(c, ptr, ptr);    /* macro generates multiple statements */
4975
        }
4976
#endif
4977
4978
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
4979
      /* In the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length of any extra
4980
      data and reset the pointer. This is so that very large classes that
4981
      contain a zillion > 255 characters no longer overwrite the work space
4982
      (which is on the stack). We have to remember that there was XCLASS data,
4983
      however. */
4984
4985
      if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) xclass = TRUE;
4986
4987
      if (lengthptr != NULL && class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base)
4988
        {
4989
        *lengthptr += (int)(class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base);
4990
        class_uchardata = class_uchardata_base;
4991
        }
4992
#endif
4993
4994
      /* Inside \Q...\E everything is literal except \E */
4995
4996
599k
      if (inescq)
4997
3.60k
        {
4998
3.60k
        if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E)  /* If we are at \E */
4999
415
          {
5000
415
          inescq = FALSE;                   /* Reset literal state */
5001
415
          ptr++;                            /* Skip the 'E' */
5002
415
          continue;                         /* Carry on with next */
5003
415
          }
5004
3.19k
        goto CHECK_RANGE;                   /* Could be range if \E follows */
5005
3.60k
        }
5006
5007
      /* Handle POSIX class names. Perl allows a negation extension of the
5008
      form [:^name:]. A square bracket that doesn't match the syntax is
5009
      treated as a literal. We also recognize the POSIX constructions
5010
      [.ch.] and [=ch=] ("collating elements") and fault them, as Perl
5011
      5.6 and 5.8 do. */
5012
5013
595k
      if (c == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
5014
595k
          (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT ||
5015
8.00k
           ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) && check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr))
5016
1.14k
        {
5017
1.14k
        BOOL local_negate = FALSE;
5018
1.14k
        int posix_class, taboffset, tabopt;
5019
1.14k
        register const pcre_uint8 *cbits = cd->cbits;
5020
1.14k
        pcre_uint8 pbits[32];
5021
5022
1.14k
        if (ptr[1] != CHAR_COLON)
5023
2
          {
5024
2
          *errorcodeptr = ERR31;
5025
2
          goto FAILED;
5026
2
          }
5027
5028
1.14k
        ptr += 2;
5029
1.14k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT)
5030
202
          {
5031
202
          local_negate = TRUE;
5032
202
          should_flip_negation = TRUE;  /* Note negative special */
5033
202
          ptr++;
5034
202
          }
5035
5036
1.14k
        posix_class = check_posix_name(ptr, (int)(tempptr - ptr));
5037
1.14k
        if (posix_class < 0)
5038
67
          {
5039
67
          *errorcodeptr = ERR30;
5040
67
          goto FAILED;
5041
67
          }
5042
5043
        /* If matching is caseless, upper and lower are converted to
5044
        alpha. This relies on the fact that the class table starts with
5045
        alpha, lower, upper as the first 3 entries. */
5046
5047
1.07k
        if ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0 && posix_class <= 2)
5048
286
          posix_class = 0;
5049
5050
        /* When PCRE_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to
5051
        different escape sequences that use Unicode properties \p or \P. Others
5052
        that are not available via \p or \P generate XCL_PROP/XCL_NOTPROP
5053
        directly. */
5054
5055
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5056
        if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0)
5057
          {
5058
          unsigned int ptype = 0;
5059
          int pc = posix_class + ((local_negate)? POSIX_SUBSIZE/2 : 0);
5060
5061
          /* The posix_substitutes table specifies which POSIX classes can be
5062
          converted to \p or \P items. */
5063
5064
          if (posix_substitutes[pc] != NULL)
5065
            {
5066
            nestptr = tempptr + 1;
5067
            ptr = posix_substitutes[pc] - 1;
5068
            continue;
5069
            }
5070
5071
          /* There are three other classes that generate special property calls
5072
          that are recognized only in an XCLASS. */
5073
5074
          else switch(posix_class)
5075
            {
5076
            case PC_GRAPH:
5077
            ptype = PT_PXGRAPH;
5078
            /* Fall through */
5079
            case PC_PRINT:
5080
            if (ptype == 0) ptype = PT_PXPRINT;
5081
            /* Fall through */
5082
            case PC_PUNCT:
5083
            if (ptype == 0) ptype = PT_PXPUNCT;
5084
            *class_uchardata++ = local_negate? XCL_NOTPROP : XCL_PROP;
5085
            *class_uchardata++ = ptype;
5086
            *class_uchardata++ = 0;
5087
            xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
5088
            ptr = tempptr + 1;
5089
            continue;
5090
5091
            /* For the other POSIX classes (ascii, cntrl, xdigit) we are going
5092
            to fall through to the non-UCP case and build a bit map for
5093
            characters with code points less than 256. If we are in a negated
5094
            POSIX class, characters with code points greater than 255 must
5095
            either all match or all not match. In the special case where we
5096
            have not yet generated any xclass data, and this is the final item
5097
            in the overall class, we need do nothing: later on, the opcode
5098
            OP_NCLASS will be used to indicate that characters greater than 255
5099
            are acceptable. If we have already seen an xclass item or one may
5100
            follow (we have to assume that it might if this is not the end of
5101
            the class), explicitly list all wide codepoints, which will then
5102
            either not match or match, depending on whether the class is or is
5103
            not negated. */
5104
5105
            default:
5106
            if (local_negate &&
5107
                (xclass || tempptr[2] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET))
5108
              {
5109
              *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
5110
              class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata);
5111
              class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x10ffff, class_uchardata);
5112
              }
5113
            break;
5114
            }
5115
          }
5116
#endif
5117
        /* In the non-UCP case, or when UCP makes no difference, we build the
5118
        bit map for the POSIX class in a chunk of local store because we may be
5119
        adding and subtracting from it, and we don't want to subtract bits that
5120
        may be in the main map already. At the end we or the result into the
5121
        bit map that is being built. */
5122
5123
1.07k
        posix_class *= 3;
5124
5125
        /* Copy in the first table (always present) */
5126
5127
1.07k
        memcpy(pbits, cbits + posix_class_maps[posix_class],
5128
1.07k
          32 * sizeof(pcre_uint8));
5129
5130
        /* If there is a second table, add or remove it as required. */
5131
5132
1.07k
        taboffset = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 1];
5133
1.07k
        tabopt = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 2];
5134
5135
1.07k
        if (taboffset >= 0)
5136
706
          {
5137
706
          if (tabopt >= 0)
5138
6.40k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) pbits[c] |= cbits[c + taboffset];
5139
512
          else
5140
16.8k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) pbits[c] &= ~cbits[c + taboffset];
5141
706
          }
5142
5143
        /* Now see if we need to remove any special characters. An option
5144
        value of 1 removes vertical space and 2 removes underscore. */
5145
5146
1.07k
        if (tabopt < 0) tabopt = -tabopt;
5147
1.07k
        if (tabopt == 1) pbits[1] &= ~0x3c;
5148
868
          else if (tabopt == 2) pbits[11] &= 0x7f;
5149
5150
        /* Add the POSIX table or its complement into the main table that is
5151
        being built and we are done. */
5152
5153
1.07k
        if (local_negate)
5154
6.60k
          for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~pbits[c];
5155
879
        else
5156
29.0k
          for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= pbits[c];
5157
5158
1.07k
        ptr = tempptr + 1;
5159
        /* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */
5160
1.07k
        class_has_8bitchar = 1;
5161
        /* Every class contains at least two characters. */
5162
1.07k
        class_one_char = 2;
5163
1.07k
        continue;    /* End of POSIX syntax handling */
5164
1.14k
        }
5165
5166
      /* Backslash may introduce a single character, or it may introduce one
5167
      of the specials, which just set a flag. The sequence \b is a special
5168
      case. Inside a class (and only there) it is treated as backspace. We
5169
      assume that other escapes have more than one character in them, so
5170
      speculatively set both class_has_8bitchar and class_one_char bigger
5171
      than one. Unrecognized escapes fall through and are either treated
5172
      as literal characters (by default), or are faulted if
5173
      PCRE_EXTRA is set. */
5174
5175
594k
      if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
5176
288k
        {
5177
288k
        escape = check_escape(&ptr, &ec, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options,
5178
288k
          TRUE);
5179
288k
        if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
5180
288k
        if (escape == 0) c = ec;
5181
261k
        else if (escape == ESC_b) c = CHAR_BS; /* \b is backspace in a class */
5182
261k
        else if (escape == ESC_N)          /* \N is not supported in a class */
5183
3
          {
5184
3
          *errorcodeptr = ERR71;
5185
3
          goto FAILED;
5186
3
          }
5187
261k
        else if (escape == ESC_Q)            /* Handle start of quoted string */
5188
1.04k
          {
5189
1.04k
          if (ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[2] == CHAR_E)
5190
523
            {
5191
523
            ptr += 2; /* avoid empty string */
5192
523
            }
5193
519
          else inescq = TRUE;
5194
1.04k
          continue;
5195
1.04k
          }
5196
260k
        else if (escape == ESC_E) continue;  /* Ignore orphan \E */
5197
5198
260k
        else
5199
260k
          {
5200
260k
          register const pcre_uint8 *cbits = cd->cbits;
5201
          /* Every class contains at least two < 256 characters. */
5202
260k
          class_has_8bitchar++;
5203
          /* Every class contains at least two characters. */
5204
260k
          class_one_char += 2;
5205
5206
260k
          switch (escape)
5207
260k
            {
5208
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5209
            case ESC_du:     /* These are the values given for \d etc */
5210
            case ESC_DU:     /* when PCRE_UCP is set. We replace the */
5211
            case ESC_wu:     /* escape sequence with an appropriate \p */
5212
            case ESC_WU:     /* or \P to test Unicode properties instead */
5213
            case ESC_su:     /* of the default ASCII testing. */
5214
            case ESC_SU:
5215
            nestptr = ptr;
5216
            ptr = substitutes[escape - ESC_DU] - 1;  /* Just before substitute */
5217
            class_has_8bitchar--;                /* Undo! */
5218
            continue;
5219
#endif
5220
229
            case ESC_d:
5221
7.55k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_digit];
5222
229
            continue;
5223
5224
516
            case ESC_D:
5225
516
            should_flip_negation = TRUE;
5226
17.0k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_digit];
5227
516
            continue;
5228
5229
218
            case ESC_w:
5230
7.19k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_word];
5231
218
            continue;
5232
5233
468
            case ESC_W:
5234
468
            should_flip_negation = TRUE;
5235
15.4k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_word];
5236
468
            continue;
5237
5238
            /* Perl 5.004 onwards omitted VT from \s, but restored it at Perl
5239
            5.18. Before PCRE 8.34, we had to preserve the VT bit if it was
5240
            previously set by something earlier in the character class.
5241
            Luckily, the value of CHAR_VT is 0x0b in both ASCII and EBCDIC, so
5242
            we could just adjust the appropriate bit. From PCRE 8.34 we no
5243
            longer treat \s and \S specially. */
5244
5245
246k
            case ESC_s:
5246
8.11M
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= cbits[c+cbit_space];
5247
246k
            continue;
5248
5249
532
            case ESC_S:
5250
532
            should_flip_negation = TRUE;
5251
17.5k
            for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] |= ~cbits[c+cbit_space];
5252
532
            continue;
5253
5254
            /* The rest apply in both UCP and non-UCP cases. */
5255
5256
484
            case ESC_h:
5257
484
            (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd,
5258
484
              PRIV(hspace_list), NOTACHAR);
5259
484
            continue;
5260
5261
463
            case ESC_H:
5262
463
            (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options,
5263
463
              cd, PRIV(hspace_list));
5264
463
            continue;
5265
5266
322
            case ESC_v:
5267
322
            (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd,
5268
322
              PRIV(vspace_list), NOTACHAR);
5269
322
            continue;
5270
5271
227
            case ESC_V:
5272
227
            (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options,
5273
227
              cd, PRIV(vspace_list));
5274
227
            continue;
5275
5276
2
            case ESC_p:
5277
4
            case ESC_P:
5278
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5279
              {
5280
              BOOL negated;
5281
              unsigned int ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
5282
              if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, errorcodeptr))
5283
                goto FAILED;
5284
              *class_uchardata++ = ((escape == ESC_p) != negated)?
5285
                XCL_PROP : XCL_NOTPROP;
5286
              *class_uchardata++ = ptype;
5287
              *class_uchardata++ = pdata;
5288
              xclass_has_prop = TRUE;
5289
              class_has_8bitchar--;                /* Undo! */
5290
              continue;
5291
              }
5292
#else
5293
4
            *errorcodeptr = ERR45;
5294
4
            goto FAILED;
5295
0
#endif
5296
            /* Unrecognized escapes are faulted if PCRE is running in its
5297
            strict mode. By default, for compatibility with Perl, they are
5298
            treated as literals. */
5299
5300
10.7k
            default:
5301
10.7k
            if ((options & PCRE_EXTRA) != 0)
5302
1
              {
5303
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR7;
5304
1
              goto FAILED;
5305
1
              }
5306
10.7k
            class_has_8bitchar--;    /* Undo the speculative increase. */
5307
10.7k
            class_one_char -= 2;     /* Undo the speculative increase. */
5308
10.7k
            c = *ptr;                /* Get the final character and fall through */
5309
10.7k
            break;
5310
260k
            }
5311
260k
          }
5312
5313
        /* Fall through if the escape just defined a single character (c >= 0).
5314
        This may be greater than 256. */
5315
5316
37.2k
        escape = 0;
5317
5318
37.2k
        }   /* End of backslash handling */
5319
5320
      /* A character may be followed by '-' to form a range. However, Perl does
5321
      not permit ']' to be the end of the range. A '-' character at the end is
5322
      treated as a literal. Perl ignores orphaned \E sequences entirely. The
5323
      code for handling \Q and \E is messy. */
5324
5325
346k
      CHECK_RANGE:
5326
348k
      while (ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[2] == CHAR_E)
5327
1.72k
        {
5328
1.72k
        inescq = FALSE;
5329
1.72k
        ptr += 2;
5330
1.72k
        }
5331
346k
      oldptr = ptr;
5332
5333
      /* Remember if \r or \n were explicitly used */
5334
5335
346k
      if (c == CHAR_CR || c == CHAR_NL) cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF;
5336
5337
      /* Check for range */
5338
5339
346k
      if (!inescq && ptr[1] == CHAR_MINUS)
5340
5.55k
        {
5341
5.55k
        pcre_uint32 d;
5342
5.55k
        ptr += 2;
5343
6.48k
        while (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E) ptr += 2;
5344
5345
        /* If we hit \Q (not followed by \E) at this point, go into escaped
5346
        mode. */
5347
5348
5.75k
        while (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_Q)
5349
735
          {
5350
735
          ptr += 2;
5351
735
          if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr[1] == CHAR_E)
5352
200
            { ptr += 2; continue; }
5353
535
          inescq = TRUE;
5354
535
          break;
5355
735
          }
5356
5357
        /* Minus (hyphen) at the end of a class is treated as a literal, so put
5358
        back the pointer and jump to handle the character that preceded it. */
5359
5360
5.55k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL || (!inescq && *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET))
5361
1.11k
          {
5362
1.11k
          ptr = oldptr;
5363
1.11k
          goto CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER;
5364
1.11k
          }
5365
5366
        /* Otherwise, we have a potential range; pick up the next character */
5367
5368
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
5369
        if (utf)
5370
          {                           /* Braces are required because the */
5371
          GETCHARLEN(d, ptr, ptr);    /* macro generates multiple statements */
5372
          }
5373
        else
5374
#endif
5375
4.44k
        d = *ptr;  /* Not UTF-8 mode */
5376
5377
        /* The second part of a range can be a single-character escape
5378
        sequence, but not any of the other escapes. Perl treats a hyphen as a
5379
        literal in such circumstances. However, in Perl's warning mode, a
5380
        warning is given, so PCRE now faults it as it is almost certainly a
5381
        mistake on the user's part. */
5382
5383
4.44k
        if (!inescq)
5384
3.91k
          {
5385
3.91k
          if (d == CHAR_BACKSLASH)
5386
569
            {
5387
569
            int descape;
5388
569
            descape = check_escape(&ptr, &d, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options, TRUE);
5389
569
            if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
5390
5391
            /* 0 means a character was put into d; \b is backspace; any other
5392
            special causes an error. */
5393
5394
567
            if (descape != 0)
5395
249
              {
5396
249
              if (descape == ESC_b) d = CHAR_BS; else
5397
8
                {
5398
8
                *errorcodeptr = ERR83;
5399
8
                goto FAILED;
5400
8
                }
5401
249
              }
5402
567
            }
5403
5404
          /* A hyphen followed by a POSIX class is treated in the same way. */
5405
5406
3.34k
          else if (d == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET &&
5407
3.34k
                   (ptr[1] == CHAR_COLON || ptr[1] == CHAR_DOT ||
5408
963
                    ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) &&
5409
3.34k
                   check_posix_syntax(ptr, &tempptr))
5410
1
            {
5411
1
            *errorcodeptr = ERR83;
5412
1
            goto FAILED;
5413
1
            }
5414
3.91k
          }
5415
5416
        /* Check that the two values are in the correct order. Optimize
5417
        one-character ranges. */
5418
5419
4.43k
        if (d < c)
5420
15
          {
5421
15
          *errorcodeptr = ERR8;
5422
15
          goto FAILED;
5423
15
          }
5424
4.41k
        if (d == c) goto CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER;  /* A few lines below */
5425
5426
        /* We have found a character range, so single character optimizations
5427
        cannot be done anymore. Any value greater than 1 indicates that there
5428
        is more than one character. */
5429
5430
4.14k
        class_one_char = 2;
5431
5432
        /* Remember an explicit \r or \n, and add the range to the class. */
5433
5434
4.14k
        if (d == CHAR_CR || d == CHAR_NL) cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF;
5435
5436
4.14k
        class_has_8bitchar +=
5437
4.14k
          add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, c, d);
5438
5439
4.14k
        continue;   /* Go get the next char in the class */
5440
4.41k
        }
5441
5442
      /* Handle a single character - we can get here for a normal non-escape
5443
      char, or after \ that introduces a single character or for an apparent
5444
      range that isn't. Only the value 1 matters for class_one_char, so don't
5445
      increase it if it is already 2 or more ... just in case there's a class
5446
      with a zillion characters in it. */
5447
5448
342k
      CLASS_SINGLE_CHARACTER:
5449
342k
      if (class_one_char < 2) class_one_char++;
5450
5451
      /* If xclass_has_prop is false and class_one_char is 1, we have the first
5452
      single character in the class, and there have been no prior ranges, or
5453
      XCLASS items generated by escapes. If this is the final character in the
5454
      class, we can optimize by turning the item into a 1-character OP_CHAR[I]
5455
      if it's positive, or OP_NOT[I] if it's negative. In the positive case, it
5456
      can cause firstchar to be set. Otherwise, there can be no first char if
5457
      this item is first, whatever repeat count may follow. In the case of
5458
      reqchar, save the previous value for reinstating. */
5459
5460
342k
      if (!inescq &&
5461
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5462
          !xclass_has_prop &&
5463
#endif
5464
342k
          class_one_char == 1 && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET)
5465
4.33k
        {
5466
4.33k
        ptr++;
5467
4.33k
        zeroreqchar = reqchar;
5468
4.33k
        zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
5469
5470
4.33k
        if (negate_class)
5471
3.30k
          {
5472
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5473
          int d;
5474
#endif
5475
3.30k
          if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
5476
3.30k
          zerofirstchar = firstchar;
5477
3.30k
          zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
5478
5479
          /* For caseless UTF-8 mode when UCP support is available, check
5480
          whether this character has more than one other case. If so, generate
5481
          a special OP_NOTPROP item instead of OP_NOTI. */
5482
5483
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
5484
          if (utf && (options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0 &&
5485
              (d = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
5486
            {
5487
            *code++ = OP_NOTPROP;
5488
            *code++ = PT_CLIST;
5489
            *code++ = d;
5490
            }
5491
          else
5492
#endif
5493
          /* Char has only one other case, or UCP not available */
5494
5495
3.30k
            {
5496
3.30k
            *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_NOTI: OP_NOT;
5497
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5498
            if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR)
5499
              code += PRIV(ord2utf)(c, code);
5500
            else
5501
#endif
5502
3.30k
              *code++ = c;
5503
3.30k
            }
5504
5505
          /* We are finished with this character class */
5506
5507
3.30k
          goto END_CLASS;
5508
3.30k
          }
5509
5510
        /* For a single, positive character, get the value into mcbuffer, and
5511
        then we can handle this with the normal one-character code. */
5512
5513
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5514
        if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR)
5515
          mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(c, mcbuffer);
5516
        else
5517
#endif
5518
1.02k
          {
5519
1.02k
          mcbuffer[0] = c;
5520
1.02k
          mclength = 1;
5521
1.02k
          }
5522
1.02k
        goto ONE_CHAR;
5523
4.33k
        }       /* End of 1-char optimization */
5524
5525
      /* There is more than one character in the class, or an XCLASS item
5526
      has been generated. Add this character to the class. */
5527
5528
338k
      class_has_8bitchar +=
5529
338k
        add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cd, c, c);
5530
338k
      }
5531
5532
    /* Loop until ']' reached. This "while" is the end of the "do" far above.
5533
    If we are at the end of an internal nested string, revert to the outer
5534
    string. */
5535
5536
594k
    while (((c = *(++ptr)) != CHAR_NULL ||
5537
594k
           (nestptr != NULL &&
5538
291
             (ptr = nestptr, nestptr = NULL, c = *(++ptr)) != CHAR_NULL)) &&
5539
594k
           (c != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET || inescq));
5540
5541
    /* Check for missing terminating ']' */
5542
5543
12.9k
    if (c == CHAR_NULL)
5544
323
      {
5545
323
      *errorcodeptr = ERR6;
5546
323
      goto FAILED;
5547
323
      }
5548
5549
    /* We will need an XCLASS if data has been placed in class_uchardata. In
5550
    the second phase this is a sufficient test. However, in the pre-compile
5551
    phase, class_uchardata gets emptied to prevent workspace overflow, so it
5552
    only if the very last character in the class needs XCLASS will it contain
5553
    anything at this point. For this reason, xclass gets set TRUE above when
5554
    uchar_classdata is emptied, and that's why this code is the way it is here
5555
    instead of just doing a test on class_uchardata below. */
5556
5557
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5558
    if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) xclass = TRUE;
5559
#endif
5560
5561
    /* If this is the first thing in the branch, there can be no first char
5562
    setting, whatever the repeat count. Any reqchar setting must remain
5563
    unchanged after any kind of repeat. */
5564
5565
12.5k
    if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
5566
12.5k
    zerofirstchar = firstchar;
5567
12.5k
    zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
5568
12.5k
    zeroreqchar = reqchar;
5569
12.5k
    zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
5570
5571
    /* If there are characters with values > 255, we have to compile an
5572
    extended class, with its own opcode, unless there was a negated special
5573
    such as \S in the class, and PCRE_UCP is not set, because in that case all
5574
    characters > 255 are in the class, so any that were explicitly given as
5575
    well can be ignored. If (when there are explicit characters > 255 that must
5576
    be listed) there are no characters < 256, we can omit the bitmap in the
5577
    actual compiled code. */
5578
5579
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
5580
    if (xclass && (xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation ||
5581
        (options & PCRE_UCP) != 0))
5582
#elif !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5583
    if (xclass && (xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation))
5584
#endif
5585
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5586
      {
5587
      /* For non-UCP wide characters, in a non-negative class containing \S or
5588
      similar (should_flip_negation is set), all characters greater than 255
5589
      must be in the class. */
5590
5591
      if (
5592
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
5593
           utf &&
5594
#endif
5595
           should_flip_negation && !negate_class && (options & PCRE_UCP) == 0)
5596
        {
5597
        *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE;
5598
        if (utf)   /* Will always be utf in the 8-bit library */
5599
          {
5600
          class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata);
5601
          class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x10ffff, class_uchardata);
5602
          }
5603
        else       /* Can only happen for the 16-bit & 32-bit libraries */
5604
          {
5605
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE16
5606
          *class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
5607
          *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffu;
5608
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5609
          *class_uchardata++ = 0x100;
5610
          *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffffffu;
5611
#endif
5612
          }
5613
        }
5614
5615
      *class_uchardata++ = XCL_END;    /* Marks the end of extra data */
5616
      *code++ = OP_XCLASS;
5617
      code += LINK_SIZE;
5618
      *code = negate_class? XCL_NOT:0;
5619
      if (xclass_has_prop) *code |= XCL_HASPROP;
5620
5621
      /* If the map is required, move up the extra data to make room for it;
5622
      otherwise just move the code pointer to the end of the extra data. */
5623
5624
      if (class_has_8bitchar > 0)
5625
        {
5626
        *code++ |= XCL_MAP;
5627
        memmove(code + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar)), code,
5628
          IN_UCHARS(class_uchardata - code));
5629
        if (negate_class && !xclass_has_prop)
5630
          for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] = ~classbits[c];
5631
        memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
5632
        code = class_uchardata + (32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar));
5633
        }
5634
      else code = class_uchardata;
5635
5636
      /* Now fill in the complete length of the item */
5637
5638
      PUT(previous, 1, (int)(code - previous));
5639
      break;   /* End of class handling */
5640
      }
5641
5642
    /* Even though any XCLASS list is now discarded, we must allow for
5643
    its memory. */
5644
5645
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
5646
      *lengthptr += (int)(class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base);
5647
#endif
5648
5649
    /* If there are no characters > 255, or they are all to be included or
5650
    excluded, set the opcode to OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, depending on whether the
5651
    whole class was negated and whether there were negative specials such as \S
5652
    (non-UCP) in the class. Then copy the 32-byte map into the code vector,
5653
    negating it if necessary. */
5654
5655
12.5k
    *code++ = (negate_class == should_flip_negation) ? OP_CLASS : OP_NCLASS;
5656
12.5k
    if (lengthptr == NULL)    /* Save time in the pre-compile phase */
5657
5.68k
      {
5658
5.68k
      if (negate_class)
5659
15.8k
        for (c = 0; c < 32; c++) classbits[c] = ~classbits[c];
5660
5.68k
      memcpy(code, classbits, 32);
5661
5.68k
      }
5662
12.5k
    code += 32 / sizeof(pcre_uchar);
5663
5664
15.8k
    END_CLASS:
5665
15.8k
    break;
5666
5667
5668
    /* ===================================================================*/
5669
    /* Various kinds of repeat; '{' is not necessarily a quantifier, but this
5670
    has been tested above. */
5671
5672
35.1k
    case CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET:
5673
35.1k
    if (!is_quantifier) goto NORMAL_CHAR;
5674
19.5k
    ptr = read_repeat_counts(ptr+1, &repeat_min, &repeat_max, errorcodeptr);
5675
19.5k
    if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
5676
19.5k
    goto REPEAT;
5677
5678
34.7k
    case CHAR_ASTERISK:
5679
34.7k
    repeat_min = 0;
5680
34.7k
    repeat_max = -1;
5681
34.7k
    goto REPEAT;
5682
5683
33.6k
    case CHAR_PLUS:
5684
33.6k
    repeat_min = 1;
5685
33.6k
    repeat_max = -1;
5686
33.6k
    goto REPEAT;
5687
5688
21.3k
    case CHAR_QUESTION_MARK:
5689
21.3k
    repeat_min = 0;
5690
21.3k
    repeat_max = 1;
5691
5692
109k
    REPEAT:
5693
109k
    if (previous == NULL)
5694
66
      {
5695
66
      *errorcodeptr = ERR9;
5696
66
      goto FAILED;
5697
66
      }
5698
5699
109k
    if (repeat_min == 0)
5700
59.5k
      {
5701
59.5k
      firstchar = zerofirstchar;    /* Adjust for zero repeat */
5702
59.5k
      firstcharflags = zerofirstcharflags;
5703
59.5k
      reqchar = zeroreqchar;        /* Ditto */
5704
59.5k
      reqcharflags = zeroreqcharflags;
5705
59.5k
      }
5706
5707
    /* Remember whether this is a variable length repeat */
5708
5709
109k
    reqvary = (repeat_min == repeat_max)? 0 : REQ_VARY;
5710
5711
109k
    op_type = 0;                    /* Default single-char op codes */
5712
109k
    possessive_quantifier = FALSE;  /* Default not possessive quantifier */
5713
5714
    /* Save start of previous item, in case we have to move it up in order to
5715
    insert something before it. */
5716
5717
109k
    tempcode = previous;
5718
5719
    /* Before checking for a possessive quantifier, we must skip over
5720
    whitespace and comments in extended mode because Perl allows white space at
5721
    this point. */
5722
5723
109k
    if ((options & PCRE_EXTENDED) != 0)
5724
1.02k
      {
5725
1.02k
      const pcre_uchar *p = ptr + 1;
5726
1.02k
      for (;;)
5727
1.94k
        {
5728
2.32k
        while (MAX_255(*p) && (cd->ctypes[*p] & ctype_space) != 0) p++;
5729
1.94k
        if (*p != CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN) break;
5730
915
        p++;
5731
2.53k
        while (*p != CHAR_NULL)
5732
2.48k
          {
5733
2.48k
          if (IS_NEWLINE(p))         /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */
5734
864
            {                        /* IS_NEWLINE sets cd->nllen. */
5735
864
            p += cd->nllen;
5736
864
            break;
5737
864
            }
5738
1.61k
          p++;
5739
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
5740
          if (utf) FORWARDCHAR(p);
5741
#endif
5742
1.61k
          }           /* Loop for comment characters */
5743
915
        }             /* Loop for multiple comments */
5744
1.02k
      ptr = p - 1;    /* Character before the next significant one. */
5745
1.02k
      }
5746
5747
    /* We also need to skip over (?# comments, which are not dependent on
5748
    extended mode. */
5749
5750
109k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[2] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
5751
109k
        ptr[3] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN)
5752
242
      {
5753
242
      ptr += 4;
5754
1.76k
      while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++;
5755
242
      if (*ptr == CHAR_NULL)
5756
10
        {
5757
10
        *errorcodeptr = ERR18;
5758
10
        goto FAILED;
5759
10
        }
5760
242
      }
5761
5762
    /* If the next character is '+', we have a possessive quantifier. This
5763
    implies greediness, whatever the setting of the PCRE_UNGREEDY option.
5764
    If the next character is '?' this is a minimizing repeat, by default,
5765
    but if PCRE_UNGREEDY is set, it works the other way round. We change the
5766
    repeat type to the non-default. */
5767
5768
109k
    if (ptr[1] == CHAR_PLUS)
5769
12.5k
      {
5770
12.5k
      repeat_type = 0;                  /* Force greedy */
5771
12.5k
      possessive_quantifier = TRUE;
5772
12.5k
      ptr++;
5773
12.5k
      }
5774
96.6k
    else if (ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
5775
4.03k
      {
5776
4.03k
      repeat_type = greedy_non_default;
5777
4.03k
      ptr++;
5778
4.03k
      }
5779
92.6k
    else repeat_type = greedy_default;
5780
5781
    /* If previous was a recursion call, wrap it in atomic brackets so that
5782
    previous becomes the atomic group. All recursions were so wrapped in the
5783
    past, but it no longer happens for non-repeated recursions. In fact, the
5784
    repeated ones could be re-implemented independently so as not to need this,
5785
    but for the moment we rely on the code for repeating groups. */
5786
5787
109k
    if (*previous == OP_RECURSE)
5788
3.32k
      {
5789
3.32k
      memmove(previous + 1 + LINK_SIZE, previous, IN_UCHARS(1 + LINK_SIZE));
5790
3.32k
      *previous = OP_ONCE;
5791
3.32k
      PUT(previous, 1, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
5792
3.32k
      previous[2 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = OP_KET;
5793
3.32k
      PUT(previous, 3 + 2*LINK_SIZE, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE);
5794
3.32k
      code += 2 + 2 * LINK_SIZE;
5795
3.32k
      length_prevgroup = 3 + 3*LINK_SIZE;
5796
5797
      /* When actually compiling, we need to check whether this was a forward
5798
      reference, and if so, adjust the offset. */
5799
5800
3.32k
      if (lengthptr == NULL && cd->hwm >= cd->start_workspace + LINK_SIZE)
5801
1.19k
        {
5802
1.19k
        int offset = GET(cd->hwm, -LINK_SIZE);
5803
1.19k
        if (offset == previous + 1 - cd->start_code)
5804
310
          PUT(cd->hwm, -LINK_SIZE, offset + 1 + LINK_SIZE);
5805
1.19k
        }
5806
3.32k
      }
5807
5808
    /* Now handle repetition for the different types of item. */
5809
5810
    /* If previous was a character or negated character match, abolish the item
5811
    and generate a repeat item instead. If a char item has a minimum of more
5812
    than one, ensure that it is set in reqchar - it might not be if a sequence
5813
    such as x{3} is the first thing in a branch because the x will have gone
5814
    into firstchar instead.  */
5815
5816
109k
    if (*previous == OP_CHAR || *previous == OP_CHARI
5817
109k
        || *previous == OP_NOT || *previous == OP_NOTI)
5818
38.0k
      {
5819
38.0k
      switch (*previous)
5820
38.0k
        {
5821
0
        default: /* Make compiler happy. */
5822
27.2k
        case OP_CHAR:  op_type = OP_STAR - OP_STAR; break;
5823
8.84k
        case OP_CHARI: op_type = OP_STARI - OP_STAR; break;
5824
1.05k
        case OP_NOT:   op_type = OP_NOTSTAR - OP_STAR; break;
5825
898
        case OP_NOTI:  op_type = OP_NOTSTARI - OP_STAR; break;
5826
38.0k
        }
5827
5828
      /* Deal with UTF characters that take up more than one character. It's
5829
      easier to write this out separately than try to macrify it. Use c to
5830
      hold the length of the character in bytes, plus UTF_LENGTH to flag that
5831
      it's a length rather than a small character. */
5832
5833
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5834
      if (utf && NOT_FIRSTCHAR(code[-1]))
5835
        {
5836
        pcre_uchar *lastchar = code - 1;
5837
        BACKCHAR(lastchar);
5838
        c = (int)(code - lastchar);     /* Length of UTF-8 character */
5839
        memcpy(utf_chars, lastchar, IN_UCHARS(c)); /* Save the char */
5840
        c |= UTF_LENGTH;                /* Flag c as a length */
5841
        }
5842
      else
5843
#endif /* SUPPORT_UTF */
5844
5845
      /* Handle the case of a single charater - either with no UTF support, or
5846
      with UTF disabled, or for a single character UTF character. */
5847
38.0k
        {
5848
38.0k
        c = code[-1];
5849
38.0k
        if (*previous <= OP_CHARI && repeat_min > 1)
5850
3.44k
          {
5851
3.44k
          reqchar = c;
5852
3.44k
          reqcharflags = req_caseopt | cd->req_varyopt;
5853
3.44k
          }
5854
38.0k
        }
5855
5856
38.0k
      goto OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT;   /* Code shared with single character types */
5857
38.0k
      }
5858
5859
    /* If previous was a character type match (\d or similar), abolish it and
5860
    create a suitable repeat item. The code is shared with single-character
5861
    repeats by setting op_type to add a suitable offset into repeat_type. Note
5862
    the the Unicode property types will be present only when SUPPORT_UCP is
5863
    defined, but we don't wrap the little bits of code here because it just
5864
    makes it horribly messy. */
5865
5866
71.2k
    else if (*previous < OP_EODN)
5867
30.2k
      {
5868
30.2k
      pcre_uchar *oldcode;
5869
30.2k
      int prop_type, prop_value;
5870
30.2k
      op_type = OP_TYPESTAR - OP_STAR;  /* Use type opcodes */
5871
30.2k
      c = *previous;
5872
5873
68.3k
      OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT:
5874
68.3k
      if (*previous == OP_PROP || *previous == OP_NOTPROP)
5875
0
        {
5876
0
        prop_type = previous[1];
5877
0
        prop_value = previous[2];
5878
0
        }
5879
68.3k
      else prop_type = prop_value = -1;
5880
5881
68.3k
      oldcode = code;
5882
68.3k
      code = previous;                  /* Usually overwrite previous item */
5883
5884
      /* If the maximum is zero then the minimum must also be zero; Perl allows
5885
      this case, so we do too - by simply omitting the item altogether. */
5886
5887
68.3k
      if (repeat_max == 0) goto END_REPEAT;
5888
5889
      /* Combine the op_type with the repeat_type */
5890
5891
67.7k
      repeat_type += op_type;
5892
5893
      /* A minimum of zero is handled either as the special case * or ?, or as
5894
      an UPTO, with the maximum given. */
5895
5896
67.7k
      if (repeat_min == 0)
5897
44.4k
        {
5898
44.4k
        if (repeat_max == -1) *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
5899
14.6k
          else if (repeat_max == 1) *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
5900
478
        else
5901
478
          {
5902
478
          *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
5903
478
          PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
5904
478
          }
5905
44.4k
        }
5906
5907
      /* A repeat minimum of 1 is optimized into some special cases. If the
5908
      maximum is unlimited, we use OP_PLUS. Otherwise, the original item is
5909
      left in place and, if the maximum is greater than 1, we use OP_UPTO with
5910
      one less than the maximum. */
5911
5912
23.3k
      else if (repeat_min == 1)
5913
18.4k
        {
5914
18.4k
        if (repeat_max == -1)
5915
16.7k
          *code++ = OP_PLUS + repeat_type;
5916
1.73k
        else
5917
1.73k
          {
5918
1.73k
          code = oldcode;                 /* leave previous item in place */
5919
1.73k
          if (repeat_max == 1) goto END_REPEAT;
5920
1.39k
          *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
5921
1.39k
          PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max - 1);
5922
1.39k
          }
5923
18.4k
        }
5924
5925
      /* The case {n,n} is just an EXACT, while the general case {n,m} is
5926
      handled as an EXACT followed by an UPTO. */
5927
5928
4.82k
      else
5929
4.82k
        {
5930
4.82k
        *code++ = OP_EXACT + op_type;  /* NB EXACT doesn't have repeat_type */
5931
4.82k
        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
5932
5933
        /* If the maximum is unlimited, insert an OP_STAR. Before doing so,
5934
        we have to insert the character for the previous code. For a repeated
5935
        Unicode property match, there are two extra bytes that define the
5936
        required property. In UTF-8 mode, long characters have their length in
5937
        c, with the UTF_LENGTH bit as a flag. */
5938
5939
4.82k
        if (repeat_max < 0)
5940
614
          {
5941
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5942
          if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0)
5943
            {
5944
            memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7));
5945
            code += c & 7;
5946
            }
5947
          else
5948
#endif
5949
614
            {
5950
614
            *code++ = c;
5951
614
            if (prop_type >= 0)
5952
0
              {
5953
0
              *code++ = prop_type;
5954
0
              *code++ = prop_value;
5955
0
              }
5956
614
            }
5957
614
          *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type;
5958
614
          }
5959
5960
        /* Else insert an UPTO if the max is greater than the min, again
5961
        preceded by the character, for the previously inserted code. If the
5962
        UPTO is just for 1 instance, we can use QUERY instead. */
5963
5964
4.21k
        else if (repeat_max != repeat_min)
5965
542
          {
5966
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5967
          if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0)
5968
            {
5969
            memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7));
5970
            code += c & 7;
5971
            }
5972
          else
5973
#endif
5974
542
          *code++ = c;
5975
542
          if (prop_type >= 0)
5976
0
            {
5977
0
            *code++ = prop_type;
5978
0
            *code++ = prop_value;
5979
0
            }
5980
542
          repeat_max -= repeat_min;
5981
5982
542
          if (repeat_max == 1)
5983
206
            {
5984
206
            *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type;
5985
206
            }
5986
336
          else
5987
336
            {
5988
336
            *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type;
5989
336
            PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
5990
336
            }
5991
542
          }
5992
4.82k
        }
5993
5994
      /* The character or character type itself comes last in all cases. */
5995
5996
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
5997
      if (utf && (c & UTF_LENGTH) != 0)
5998
        {
5999
        memcpy(code, utf_chars, IN_UCHARS(c & 7));
6000
        code += c & 7;
6001
        }
6002
      else
6003
#endif
6004
67.4k
      *code++ = c;
6005
6006
      /* For a repeated Unicode property match, there are two extra bytes that
6007
      define the required property. */
6008
6009
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
6010
      if (prop_type >= 0)
6011
        {
6012
        *code++ = prop_type;
6013
        *code++ = prop_value;
6014
        }
6015
#endif
6016
67.4k
      }
6017
6018
    /* If previous was a character class or a back reference, we put the repeat
6019
    stuff after it, but just skip the item if the repeat was {0,0}. */
6020
6021
40.9k
    else if (*previous == OP_CLASS || *previous == OP_NCLASS ||
6022
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
6023
             *previous == OP_XCLASS ||
6024
#endif
6025
40.9k
             *previous == OP_REF   || *previous == OP_REFI ||
6026
40.9k
             *previous == OP_DNREF || *previous == OP_DNREFI)
6027
10.6k
      {
6028
10.6k
      if (repeat_max == 0)
6029
267
        {
6030
267
        code = previous;
6031
267
        goto END_REPEAT;
6032
267
        }
6033
6034
10.3k
      if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == -1)
6035
918
        *code++ = OP_CRSTAR + repeat_type;
6036
9.41k
      else if (repeat_min == 1 && repeat_max == -1)
6037
4.67k
        *code++ = OP_CRPLUS + repeat_type;
6038
4.73k
      else if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == 1)
6039
3.38k
        *code++ = OP_CRQUERY + repeat_type;
6040
1.35k
      else
6041
1.35k
        {
6042
1.35k
        *code++ = OP_CRRANGE + repeat_type;
6043
1.35k
        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min);
6044
1.35k
        if (repeat_max == -1) repeat_max = 0;  /* 2-byte encoding for max */
6045
1.35k
        PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max);
6046
1.35k
        }
6047
10.3k
      }
6048
6049
    /* If previous was a bracket group, we may have to replicate it in certain
6050
    cases. Note that at this point we can encounter only the "basic" bracket
6051
    opcodes such as BRA and CBRA, as this is the place where they get converted
6052
    into the more special varieties such as BRAPOS and SBRA. A test for >=
6053
    OP_ASSERT and <= OP_COND includes ASSERT, ASSERT_NOT, ASSERTBACK,
6054
    ASSERTBACK_NOT, ONCE, ONCE_NC, BRA, BRAPOS, CBRA, CBRAPOS, and COND.
6055
    Originally, PCRE did not allow repetition of assertions, but now it does,
6056
    for Perl compatibility. */
6057
6058
30.3k
    else if (*previous >= OP_ASSERT && *previous <= OP_COND)
6059
30.3k
      {
6060
30.3k
      register int i;
6061
30.3k
      int len = (int)(code - previous);
6062
30.3k
      size_t base_hwm_offset = item_hwm_offset;
6063
30.3k
      pcre_uchar *bralink = NULL;
6064
30.3k
      pcre_uchar *brazeroptr = NULL;
6065
6066
      /* Repeating a DEFINE group is pointless, but Perl allows the syntax, so
6067
      we just ignore the repeat. */
6068
6069
30.3k
      if (*previous == OP_COND && previous[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEF)
6070
200
        goto END_REPEAT;
6071
6072
      /* There is no sense in actually repeating assertions. The only potential
6073
      use of repetition is in cases when the assertion is optional. Therefore,
6074
      if the minimum is greater than zero, just ignore the repeat. If the
6075
      maximum is not zero or one, set it to 1. */
6076
6077
30.1k
      if (*previous < OP_ONCE)    /* Assertion */
6078
1.93k
        {
6079
1.93k
        if (repeat_min > 0) goto END_REPEAT;
6080
1.56k
        if (repeat_max < 0 || repeat_max > 1) repeat_max = 1;
6081
1.56k
        }
6082
6083
      /* The case of a zero minimum is special because of the need to stick
6084
      OP_BRAZERO in front of it, and because the group appears once in the
6085
      data, whereas in other cases it appears the minimum number of times. For
6086
      this reason, it is simplest to treat this case separately, as otherwise
6087
      the code gets far too messy. There are several special subcases when the
6088
      minimum is zero. */
6089
6090
29.7k
      if (repeat_min == 0)
6091
9.52k
        {
6092
        /* If the maximum is also zero, we used to just omit the group from the
6093
        output altogether, like this:
6094
6095
        ** if (repeat_max == 0)
6096
        **   {
6097
        **   code = previous;
6098
        **   goto END_REPEAT;
6099
        **   }
6100
6101
        However, that fails when a group or a subgroup within it is referenced
6102
        as a subroutine from elsewhere in the pattern, so now we stick in
6103
        OP_SKIPZERO in front of it so that it is skipped on execution. As we
6104
        don't have a list of which groups are referenced, we cannot do this
6105
        selectively.
6106
6107
        If the maximum is 1 or unlimited, we just have to stick in the BRAZERO
6108
        and do no more at this point. However, we do need to adjust any
6109
        OP_RECURSE calls inside the group that refer to the group itself or any
6110
        internal or forward referenced group, because the offset is from the
6111
        start of the whole regex. Temporarily terminate the pattern while doing
6112
        this. */
6113
6114
9.52k
        if (repeat_max <= 1)    /* Covers 0, 1, and unlimited */
6115
8.66k
          {
6116
8.66k
          *code = OP_END;
6117
8.66k
          adjust_recurse(previous, 1, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6118
8.66k
          memmove(previous + 1, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6119
8.66k
          code++;
6120
8.66k
          if (repeat_max == 0)
6121
442
            {
6122
442
            *previous++ = OP_SKIPZERO;
6123
442
            goto END_REPEAT;
6124
442
            }
6125
8.21k
          brazeroptr = previous;    /* Save for possessive optimizing */
6126
8.21k
          *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
6127
8.21k
          }
6128
6129
        /* If the maximum is greater than 1 and limited, we have to replicate
6130
        in a nested fashion, sticking OP_BRAZERO before each set of brackets.
6131
        The first one has to be handled carefully because it's the original
6132
        copy, which has to be moved up. The remainder can be handled by code
6133
        that is common with the non-zero minimum case below. We have to
6134
        adjust the value or repeat_max, since one less copy is required. Once
6135
        again, we may have to adjust any OP_RECURSE calls inside the group. */
6136
6137
863
        else
6138
863
          {
6139
863
          int offset;
6140
863
          *code = OP_END;
6141
863
          adjust_recurse(previous, 2 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6142
863
          memmove(previous + 2 + LINK_SIZE, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6143
863
          code += 2 + LINK_SIZE;
6144
863
          *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
6145
863
          *previous++ = OP_BRA;
6146
6147
          /* We chain together the bracket offset fields that have to be
6148
          filled in later when the ends of the brackets are reached. */
6149
6150
863
          offset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(previous - bralink);
6151
863
          bralink = previous;
6152
863
          PUTINC(previous, 0, offset);
6153
863
          }
6154
6155
9.08k
        repeat_max--;
6156
9.08k
        }
6157
6158
      /* If the minimum is greater than zero, replicate the group as many
6159
      times as necessary, and adjust the maximum to the number of subsequent
6160
      copies that we need. If we set a first char from the group, and didn't
6161
      set a required char, copy the latter from the former. If there are any
6162
      forward reference subroutine calls in the group, there will be entries on
6163
      the workspace list; replicate these with an appropriate increment. */
6164
6165
20.2k
      else
6166
20.2k
        {
6167
20.2k
        if (repeat_min > 1)
6168
7.96k
          {
6169
          /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
6170
          just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for
6171
          potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit
6172
          integer type when available, otherwise double. */
6173
6174
7.96k
          if (lengthptr != NULL)
6175
4.39k
            {
6176
4.39k
            int delta = (repeat_min - 1)*length_prevgroup;
6177
4.39k
            if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(repeat_min - 1)*
6178
4.39k
                  (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)length_prevgroup >
6179
4.39k
                    (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
6180
4.39k
                OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
6181
28
              {
6182
28
              *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
6183
28
              goto FAILED;
6184
28
              }
6185
4.36k
            *lengthptr += delta;
6186
4.36k
            }
6187
6188
          /* This is compiling for real. If there is a set first byte for
6189
          the group, and we have not yet set a "required byte", set it. Make
6190
          sure there is enough workspace for copying forward references before
6191
          doing the copy. */
6192
6193
3.57k
          else
6194
3.57k
            {
6195
3.57k
            if (groupsetfirstchar && reqcharflags < 0)
6196
212
              {
6197
212
              reqchar = firstchar;
6198
212
              reqcharflags = firstcharflags;
6199
212
              }
6200
6201
920k
            for (i = 1; i < repeat_min; i++)
6202
917k
              {
6203
917k
              pcre_uchar *hc;
6204
917k
              size_t this_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
6205
917k
              memcpy(code, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6206
6207
917k
              while (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
6208
917k
                     WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN -
6209
917k
                     (this_hwm_offset - base_hwm_offset))
6210
31
                {
6211
31
                *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd);
6212
31
                if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
6213
31
                }
6214
6215
917k
              for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + base_hwm_offset;
6216
1.04M
                   hc < (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + this_hwm_offset;
6217
917k
                   hc += LINK_SIZE)
6218
128k
                {
6219
128k
                PUT(cd->hwm, 0, GET(hc, 0) + len);
6220
128k
                cd->hwm += LINK_SIZE;
6221
128k
                }
6222
917k
              base_hwm_offset = this_hwm_offset;
6223
917k
              code += len;
6224
917k
              }
6225
3.57k
            }
6226
7.96k
          }
6227
6228
20.2k
        if (repeat_max > 0) repeat_max -= repeat_min;
6229
20.2k
        }
6230
6231
      /* This code is common to both the zero and non-zero minimum cases. If
6232
      the maximum is limited, it replicates the group in a nested fashion,
6233
      remembering the bracket starts on a stack. In the case of a zero minimum,
6234
      the first one was set up above. In all cases the repeat_max now specifies
6235
      the number of additional copies needed. Again, we must remember to
6236
      replicate entries on the forward reference list. */
6237
6238
29.3k
      if (repeat_max >= 0)
6239
13.1k
        {
6240
        /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We
6241
        just adjust the length as if we had. For each repetition we must add 1
6242
        to the length for BRAZERO and for all but the last repetition we must
6243
        add 2 + 2*LINKSIZE to allow for the nesting that occurs. Do some
6244
        paranoid checks to avoid integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is
6245
        a 64-bit integer type when available, otherwise double. */
6246
6247
13.1k
        if (lengthptr != NULL && repeat_max > 0)
6248
871
          {
6249
871
          int delta = repeat_max * (length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) -
6250
871
                      2 - 2*LINK_SIZE;   /* Last one doesn't nest */
6251
871
          if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)repeat_max *
6252
871
                (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE)
6253
871
                  > (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX ||
6254
871
              OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta)
6255
35
            {
6256
35
            *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
6257
35
            goto FAILED;
6258
35
            }
6259
836
          *lengthptr += delta;
6260
836
          }
6261
6262
        /* This is compiling for real */
6263
6264
35.2k
        else for (i = repeat_max - 1; i >= 0; i--)
6265
22.9k
          {
6266
22.9k
          pcre_uchar *hc;
6267
22.9k
          size_t this_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
6268
6269
22.9k
          *code++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type;
6270
6271
          /* All but the final copy start a new nesting, maintaining the
6272
          chain of brackets outstanding. */
6273
6274
22.9k
          if (i != 0)
6275
22.4k
            {
6276
22.4k
            int offset;
6277
22.4k
            *code++ = OP_BRA;
6278
22.4k
            offset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(code - bralink);
6279
22.4k
            bralink = code;
6280
22.4k
            PUTINC(code, 0, offset);
6281
22.4k
            }
6282
6283
22.9k
          memcpy(code, previous, IN_UCHARS(len));
6284
6285
          /* Ensure there is enough workspace for forward references before
6286
          copying them. */
6287
6288
22.9k
          while (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
6289
22.9k
                 WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN -
6290
22.9k
                 (this_hwm_offset - base_hwm_offset))
6291
3
            {
6292
3
            *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd);
6293
3
            if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
6294
3
            }
6295
6296
22.9k
          for (hc = (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + base_hwm_offset;
6297
33.4k
               hc < (pcre_uchar *)cd->start_workspace + this_hwm_offset;
6298
22.9k
               hc += LINK_SIZE)
6299
10.5k
            {
6300
10.5k
            PUT(cd->hwm, 0, GET(hc, 0) + len + ((i != 0)? 2+LINK_SIZE : 1));
6301
10.5k
            cd->hwm += LINK_SIZE;
6302
10.5k
            }
6303
22.9k
          base_hwm_offset = this_hwm_offset;
6304
22.9k
          code += len;
6305
22.9k
          }
6306
6307
        /* Now chain through the pending brackets, and fill in their length
6308
        fields (which are holding the chain links pro tem). */
6309
6310
36.4k
        while (bralink != NULL)
6311
23.3k
          {
6312
23.3k
          int oldlinkoffset;
6313
23.3k
          int offset = (int)(code - bralink + 1);
6314
23.3k
          pcre_uchar *bra = code - offset;
6315
23.3k
          oldlinkoffset = GET(bra, 1);
6316
23.3k
          bralink = (oldlinkoffset == 0)? NULL : bralink - oldlinkoffset;
6317
23.3k
          *code++ = OP_KET;
6318
23.3k
          PUTINC(code, 0, offset);
6319
23.3k
          PUT(bra, 1, offset);
6320
23.3k
          }
6321
13.1k
        }
6322
6323
      /* If the maximum is unlimited, set a repeater in the final copy. For
6324
      ONCE brackets, that's all we need to do. However, possessively repeated
6325
      ONCE brackets can be converted into non-capturing brackets, as the
6326
      behaviour of (?:xx)++ is the same as (?>xx)++ and this saves having to
6327
      deal with possessive ONCEs specially.
6328
6329
      Otherwise, when we are doing the actual compile phase, check to see
6330
      whether this group is one that could match an empty string. If so,
6331
      convert the initial operator to the S form (e.g. OP_BRA -> OP_SBRA) so
6332
      that runtime checking can be done. [This check is also applied to ONCE
6333
      groups at runtime, but in a different way.]
6334
6335
      Then, if the quantifier was possessive and the bracket is not a
6336
      conditional, we convert the BRA code to the POS form, and the KET code to
6337
      KETRPOS. (It turns out to be convenient at runtime to detect this kind of
6338
      subpattern at both the start and at the end.) The use of special opcodes
6339
      makes it possible to reduce greatly the stack usage in pcre_exec(). If
6340
      the group is preceded by OP_BRAZERO, convert this to OP_BRAPOSZERO.
6341
6342
      Then, if the minimum number of matches is 1 or 0, cancel the possessive
6343
      flag so that the default action below, of wrapping everything inside
6344
      atomic brackets, does not happen. When the minimum is greater than 1,
6345
      there will be earlier copies of the group, and so we still have to wrap
6346
      the whole thing. */
6347
6348
16.1k
      else
6349
16.1k
        {
6350
16.1k
        pcre_uchar *ketcode = code - 1 - LINK_SIZE;
6351
16.1k
        pcre_uchar *bracode = ketcode - GET(ketcode, 1);
6352
6353
        /* Convert possessive ONCE brackets to non-capturing */
6354
6355
16.1k
        if ((*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_ONCE_NC) &&
6356
16.1k
            possessive_quantifier) *bracode = OP_BRA;
6357
6358
        /* For non-possessive ONCE brackets, all we need to do is to
6359
        set the KET. */
6360
6361
16.1k
        if (*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_ONCE_NC)
6362
1.94k
          *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
6363
6364
        /* Handle non-ONCE brackets and possessive ONCEs (which have been
6365
        converted to non-capturing above). */
6366
6367
14.2k
        else
6368
14.2k
          {
6369
          /* In the compile phase, check for empty string matching. */
6370
6371
14.2k
          if (lengthptr == NULL)
6372
6.46k
            {
6373
6.46k
            pcre_uchar *scode = bracode;
6374
6.46k
            do
6375
8.06k
              {
6376
8.06k
              if (could_be_empty_branch(scode, ketcode, utf, cd, NULL))
6377
3.63k
                {
6378
3.63k
                *bracode += OP_SBRA - OP_BRA;
6379
3.63k
                break;
6380
3.63k
                }
6381
4.43k
              scode += GET(scode, 1);
6382
4.43k
              }
6383
6.46k
            while (*scode == OP_ALT);
6384
6.46k
            }
6385
6386
          /* A conditional group with only one branch has an implicit empty
6387
          alternative branch. */
6388
6389
14.2k
          if (*bracode == OP_COND && bracode[GET(bracode,1)] != OP_ALT)
6390
1.58k
            *bracode = OP_SCOND;
6391
6392
          /* Handle possessive quantifiers. */
6393
6394
14.2k
          if (possessive_quantifier)
6395
5.07k
            {
6396
            /* For COND brackets, we wrap the whole thing in a possessively
6397
            repeated non-capturing bracket, because we have not invented POS
6398
            versions of the COND opcodes. Because we are moving code along, we
6399
            must ensure that any pending recursive references are updated. */
6400
6401
5.07k
            if (*bracode == OP_COND || *bracode == OP_SCOND)
6402
1.22k
              {
6403
1.22k
              int nlen = (int)(code - bracode);
6404
1.22k
              *code = OP_END;
6405
1.22k
              adjust_recurse(bracode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6406
1.22k
              memmove(bracode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, bracode, IN_UCHARS(nlen));
6407
1.22k
              code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6408
1.22k
              nlen += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6409
1.22k
              *bracode = (*bracode == OP_COND)? OP_BRAPOS : OP_SBRAPOS;
6410
1.22k
              *code++ = OP_KETRPOS;
6411
1.22k
              PUTINC(code, 0, nlen);
6412
1.22k
              PUT(bracode, 1, nlen);
6413
1.22k
              }
6414
6415
            /* For non-COND brackets, we modify the BRA code and use KETRPOS. */
6416
6417
3.85k
            else
6418
3.85k
              {
6419
3.85k
              *bracode += 1;              /* Switch to xxxPOS opcodes */
6420
3.85k
              *ketcode = OP_KETRPOS;
6421
3.85k
              }
6422
6423
            /* If the minimum is zero, mark it as possessive, then unset the
6424
            possessive flag when the minimum is 0 or 1. */
6425
6426
5.07k
            if (brazeroptr != NULL) *brazeroptr = OP_BRAPOSZERO;
6427
5.07k
            if (repeat_min < 2) possessive_quantifier = FALSE;
6428
5.07k
            }
6429
6430
          /* Non-possessive quantifier */
6431
6432
9.12k
          else *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type;
6433
14.2k
          }
6434
16.1k
        }
6435
29.3k
      }
6436
6437
    /* If previous is OP_FAIL, it was generated by an empty class [] in
6438
    JavaScript mode. The other ways in which OP_FAIL can be generated, that is
6439
    by (*FAIL) or (?!) set previous to NULL, which gives a "nothing to repeat"
6440
    error above. We can just ignore the repeat in JS case. */
6441
6442
0
    else if (*previous == OP_FAIL) goto END_REPEAT;
6443
6444
    /* Else there's some kind of shambles */
6445
6446
0
    else
6447
0
      {
6448
0
      *errorcodeptr = ERR11;
6449
0
      goto FAILED;
6450
0
      }
6451
6452
    /* If the character following a repeat is '+', possessive_quantifier is
6453
    TRUE. For some opcodes, there are special alternative opcodes for this
6454
    case. For anything else, we wrap the entire repeated item inside OP_ONCE
6455
    brackets. Logically, the '+' notation is just syntactic sugar, taken from
6456
    Sun's Java package, but the special opcodes can optimize it.
6457
6458
    Some (but not all) possessively repeated subpatterns have already been
6459
    completely handled in the code just above. For them, possessive_quantifier
6460
    is always FALSE at this stage. Note that the repeated item starts at
6461
    tempcode, not at previous, which might be the first part of a string whose
6462
    (former) last char we repeated. */
6463
6464
107k
    if (possessive_quantifier)
6465
7.99k
      {
6466
7.99k
      int len;
6467
6468
      /* Possessifying an EXACT quantifier has no effect, so we can ignore it.
6469
      However, QUERY, STAR, or UPTO may follow (for quantifiers such as {5,6},
6470
      {5,}, or {5,10}). We skip over an EXACT item; if the length of what
6471
      remains is greater than zero, there's a further opcode that can be
6472
      handled. If not, do nothing, leaving the EXACT alone. */
6473
6474
7.99k
      switch(*tempcode)
6475
7.99k
        {
6476
214
        case OP_TYPEEXACT:
6477
214
        tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode] +
6478
214
          ((tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP
6479
214
          || tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)? 2 : 0);
6480
214
        break;
6481
6482
        /* CHAR opcodes are used for exacts whose count is 1. */
6483
6484
358
        case OP_CHAR:
6485
713
        case OP_CHARI:
6486
931
        case OP_NOT:
6487
1.13k
        case OP_NOTI:
6488
1.44k
        case OP_EXACT:
6489
1.68k
        case OP_EXACTI:
6490
1.95k
        case OP_NOTEXACT:
6491
2.29k
        case OP_NOTEXACTI:
6492
2.29k
        tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode];
6493
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
6494
        if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]))
6495
          tempcode += GET_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]);
6496
#endif
6497
2.29k
        break;
6498
6499
        /* For the class opcodes, the repeat operator appears at the end;
6500
        adjust tempcode to point to it. */
6501
6502
357
        case OP_CLASS:
6503
651
        case OP_NCLASS:
6504
651
        tempcode += 1 + 32/sizeof(pcre_uchar);
6505
651
        break;
6506
6507
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF || !defined COMPILE_PCRE8
6508
        case OP_XCLASS:
6509
        tempcode += GET(tempcode, 1);
6510
        break;
6511
#endif
6512
7.99k
        }
6513
6514
      /* If tempcode is equal to code (which points to the end of the repeated
6515
      item), it means we have skipped an EXACT item but there is no following
6516
      QUERY, STAR, or UPTO; the value of len will be 0, and we do nothing. In
6517
      all other cases, tempcode will be pointing to the repeat opcode, and will
6518
      be less than code, so the value of len will be greater than 0. */
6519
6520
7.99k
      len = (int)(code - tempcode);
6521
7.99k
      if (len > 0)
6522
6.81k
        {
6523
6.81k
        unsigned int repcode = *tempcode;
6524
6525
        /* There is a table for possessifying opcodes, all of which are less
6526
        than OP_CALLOUT. A zero entry means there is no possessified version.
6527
        */
6528
6529
6.81k
        if (repcode < OP_CALLOUT && opcode_possessify[repcode] > 0)
6530
4.55k
          *tempcode = opcode_possessify[repcode];
6531
6532
        /* For opcode without a special possessified version, wrap the item in
6533
        ONCE brackets. Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any
6534
        pending recursive references are updated. */
6535
6536
2.26k
        else
6537
2.26k
          {
6538
2.26k
          *code = OP_END;
6539
2.26k
          adjust_recurse(tempcode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6540
2.26k
          memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, IN_UCHARS(len));
6541
2.26k
          code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6542
2.26k
          len += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6543
2.26k
          tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE;
6544
2.26k
          *code++ = OP_KET;
6545
2.26k
          PUTINC(code, 0, len);
6546
2.26k
          PUT(tempcode, 1, len);
6547
2.26k
          }
6548
6.81k
        }
6549
6550
#ifdef NEVER
6551
      if (len > 0) switch (*tempcode)
6552
        {
6553
        case OP_STAR:  *tempcode = OP_POSSTAR; break;
6554
        case OP_PLUS:  *tempcode = OP_POSPLUS; break;
6555
        case OP_QUERY: *tempcode = OP_POSQUERY; break;
6556
        case OP_UPTO:  *tempcode = OP_POSUPTO; break;
6557
6558
        case OP_STARI:  *tempcode = OP_POSSTARI; break;
6559
        case OP_PLUSI:  *tempcode = OP_POSPLUSI; break;
6560
        case OP_QUERYI: *tempcode = OP_POSQUERYI; break;
6561
        case OP_UPTOI:  *tempcode = OP_POSUPTOI; break;
6562
6563
        case OP_NOTSTAR:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSSTAR; break;
6564
        case OP_NOTPLUS:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSPLUS; break;
6565
        case OP_NOTQUERY: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSQUERY; break;
6566
        case OP_NOTUPTO:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSUPTO; break;
6567
6568
        case OP_NOTSTARI:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSSTARI; break;
6569
        case OP_NOTPLUSI:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSPLUSI; break;
6570
        case OP_NOTQUERYI: *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSQUERYI; break;
6571
        case OP_NOTUPTOI:  *tempcode = OP_NOTPOSUPTOI; break;
6572
6573
        case OP_TYPESTAR:  *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSSTAR; break;
6574
        case OP_TYPEPLUS:  *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSPLUS; break;
6575
        case OP_TYPEQUERY: *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSQUERY; break;
6576
        case OP_TYPEUPTO:  *tempcode = OP_TYPEPOSUPTO; break;
6577
6578
        case OP_CRSTAR:   *tempcode = OP_CRPOSSTAR; break;
6579
        case OP_CRPLUS:   *tempcode = OP_CRPOSPLUS; break;
6580
        case OP_CRQUERY:  *tempcode = OP_CRPOSQUERY; break;
6581
        case OP_CRRANGE:  *tempcode = OP_CRPOSRANGE; break;
6582
6583
        /* Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any
6584
        pending recursive references are updated. */
6585
6586
        default:
6587
        *code = OP_END;
6588
        adjust_recurse(tempcode, 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf, cd, item_hwm_offset);
6589
        memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, IN_UCHARS(len));
6590
        code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6591
        len += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
6592
        tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE;
6593
        *code++ = OP_KET;
6594
        PUTINC(code, 0, len);
6595
        PUT(tempcode, 1, len);
6596
        break;
6597
        }
6598
#endif
6599
7.99k
      }
6600
6601
    /* In all case we no longer have a previous item. We also set the
6602
    "follows varying string" flag for subsequently encountered reqchars if
6603
    it isn't already set and we have just passed a varying length item. */
6604
6605
109k
    END_REPEAT:
6606
109k
    previous = NULL;
6607
109k
    cd->req_varyopt |= reqvary;
6608
109k
    break;
6609
6610
6611
    /* ===================================================================*/
6612
    /* Start of nested parenthesized sub-expression, or comment or lookahead or
6613
    lookbehind or option setting or condition or all the other extended
6614
    parenthesis forms.  */
6615
6616
854k
    case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
6617
854k
    ptr++;
6618
6619
    /* Now deal with various "verbs" that can be introduced by '*'. */
6620
6621
854k
    if (ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK && (ptr[1] == ':'
6622
3.92k
         || (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && ((cd->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_letter) != 0))))
6623
3.90k
      {
6624
3.90k
      int i, namelen;
6625
3.90k
      int arglen = 0;
6626
3.90k
      const char *vn = verbnames;
6627
3.90k
      const pcre_uchar *name = ptr + 1;
6628
3.90k
      const pcre_uchar *arg = NULL;
6629
3.90k
      previous = NULL;
6630
3.90k
      ptr++;
6631
1.33M
      while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_letter) != 0) ptr++;
6632
3.90k
      namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
6633
6634
      /* It appears that Perl allows any characters whatsoever, other than
6635
      a closing parenthesis, to appear in arguments, so we no longer insist on
6636
      letters, digits, and underscores. */
6637
6638
3.90k
      if (*ptr == CHAR_COLON)
6639
1.71k
        {
6640
1.71k
        arg = ++ptr;
6641
135k
        while (*ptr != CHAR_NULL && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) ptr++;
6642
1.71k
        arglen = (int)(ptr - arg);
6643
1.71k
        if ((unsigned int)arglen > MAX_MARK)
6644
7
          {
6645
7
          *errorcodeptr = ERR75;
6646
7
          goto FAILED;
6647
7
          }
6648
1.71k
        }
6649
6650
3.89k
      if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
6651
767
        {
6652
767
        *errorcodeptr = ERR60;
6653
767
        goto FAILED;
6654
767
        }
6655
6656
      /* Scan the table of verb names */
6657
6658
16.0k
      for (i = 0; i < verbcount; i++)
6659
16.0k
        {
6660
16.0k
        if (namelen == verbs[i].len &&
6661
16.0k
            STRNCMP_UC_C8(name, vn, namelen) == 0)
6662
3.06k
          {
6663
3.06k
          int setverb;
6664
6665
          /* Check for open captures before ACCEPT and convert it to
6666
          ASSERT_ACCEPT if in an assertion. */
6667
6668
3.06k
          if (verbs[i].op == OP_ACCEPT)
6669
522
            {
6670
522
            open_capitem *oc;
6671
522
            if (arglen != 0)
6672
1
              {
6673
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR59;
6674
1
              goto FAILED;
6675
1
              }
6676
521
            cd->had_accept = TRUE;
6677
3.18k
            for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
6678
2.66k
              {
6679
2.66k
              if (lengthptr != NULL)
6680
2.41k
                {
6681
2.41k
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
6682
2.41k
                *lengthptr += 1 + IMM2_SIZE;
6683
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
6684
                *lengthptr += 2 + IMM2_SIZE;
6685
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
6686
                *lengthptr += 4 + IMM2_SIZE;
6687
#endif
6688
2.41k
                }
6689
241
              else
6690
241
                {
6691
241
                *code++ = OP_CLOSE;
6692
241
                PUT2INC(code, 0, oc->number);
6693
241
                }
6694
2.66k
              }
6695
521
            setverb = *code++ =
6696
521
              (cd->assert_depth > 0)? OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT : OP_ACCEPT;
6697
6698
            /* Do not set firstchar after *ACCEPT */
6699
521
            if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
6700
521
            }
6701
6702
          /* Handle other cases with/without an argument */
6703
6704
2.54k
          else if (arglen == 0)
6705
876
            {
6706
876
            if (verbs[i].op < 0)   /* Argument is mandatory */
6707
3
              {
6708
3
              *errorcodeptr = ERR66;
6709
3
              goto FAILED;
6710
3
              }
6711
873
            setverb = *code++ = verbs[i].op;
6712
873
            }
6713
6714
1.66k
          else
6715
1.66k
            {
6716
1.66k
            if (verbs[i].op_arg < 0)   /* Argument is forbidden */
6717
1
              {
6718
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR59;
6719
1
              goto FAILED;
6720
1
              }
6721
1.66k
            setverb = *code++ = verbs[i].op_arg;
6722
1.66k
            if (lengthptr != NULL)    /* In pass 1 just add in the length */
6723
852
              {                       /* to avoid potential workspace */
6724
852
              *lengthptr += arglen;   /* overflow. */
6725
852
              *code++ = 0;
6726
852
              }
6727
814
            else
6728
814
              {
6729
814
              *code++ = arglen;
6730
814
              memcpy(code, arg, IN_UCHARS(arglen));
6731
814
              code += arglen;
6732
814
              }
6733
1.66k
            *code++ = 0;
6734
1.66k
            }
6735
6736
3.06k
          switch (setverb)
6737
3.06k
            {
6738
243
            case OP_THEN:
6739
539
            case OP_THEN_ARG:
6740
539
            cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASTHEN;
6741
539
            break;
6742
6743
318
            case OP_PRUNE:
6744
526
            case OP_PRUNE_ARG:
6745
756
            case OP_SKIP:
6746
1.03k
            case OP_SKIP_ARG:
6747
1.03k
            cd->had_pruneorskip = TRUE;
6748
1.03k
            break;
6749
3.06k
            }
6750
6751
3.06k
          break;  /* Found verb, exit loop */
6752
3.06k
          }
6753
6754
12.9k
        vn += verbs[i].len + 1;
6755
12.9k
        }
6756
6757
3.12k
      if (i < verbcount) continue;    /* Successfully handled a verb */
6758
63
      *errorcodeptr = ERR60;          /* Verb not recognized */
6759
63
      goto FAILED;
6760
3.12k
      }
6761
6762
    /* Initialize for "real" parentheses */
6763
6764
850k
    newoptions = options;
6765
850k
    skipbytes = 0;
6766
850k
    bravalue = OP_CBRA;
6767
850k
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
6768
850k
    reset_bracount = FALSE;
6769
6770
    /* Deal with the extended parentheses; all are introduced by '?', and the
6771
    appearance of any of them means that this is not a capturing group. */
6772
6773
850k
    if (*ptr == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)
6774
208k
      {
6775
208k
      int i, set, unset, namelen;
6776
208k
      int *optset;
6777
208k
      const pcre_uchar *name;
6778
208k
      pcre_uchar *slot;
6779
6780
208k
      switch (*(++ptr))
6781
208k
        {
6782
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
6783
2.69k
        case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE:  /* Reset capture count for each branch */
6784
2.69k
        reset_bracount = TRUE;
6785
2.69k
        cd->dupgroups = TRUE;     /* Record (?| encountered */
6786
        /* Fall through */
6787
6788
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
6789
3.47k
        case CHAR_COLON:          /* Non-capturing bracket */
6790
3.47k
        bravalue = OP_BRA;
6791
3.47k
        ptr++;
6792
3.47k
        break;
6793
6794
6795
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
6796
13.2k
        case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS:
6797
13.2k
        bravalue = OP_COND;       /* Conditional group */
6798
13.2k
        tempptr = ptr;
6799
6800
        /* A condition can be an assertion, a number (referring to a numbered
6801
        group's having been set), a name (referring to a named group), or 'R',
6802
        referring to recursion. R<digits> and R&name are also permitted for
6803
        recursion tests.
6804
6805
        There are ways of testing a named group: (?(name)) is used by Python;
6806
        Perl 5.10 onwards uses (?(<name>) or (?('name')).
6807
6808
        There is one unfortunate ambiguity, caused by history. 'R' can be the
6809
        recursive thing or the name 'R' (and similarly for 'R' followed by
6810
        digits). We look for a name first; if not found, we try the other case.
6811
6812
        For compatibility with auto-callouts, we allow a callout to be
6813
        specified before a condition that is an assertion. First, check for the
6814
        syntax of a callout; if found, adjust the temporary pointer that is
6815
        used to check for an assertion condition. That's all that is needed! */
6816
6817
13.2k
        if (ptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && ptr[2] == CHAR_C)
6818
266
          {
6819
474
          for (i = 3;; i++) if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[i])) break;
6820
266
          if (ptr[i] == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
6821
241
            tempptr += i + 1;
6822
6823
          /* tempptr should now be pointing to the opening parenthesis of the
6824
          assertion condition. */
6825
6826
266
          if (*tempptr != CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS)
6827
11
            {
6828
11
            *errorcodeptr = ERR28;
6829
11
            goto FAILED;
6830
11
            }
6831
266
          }
6832
6833
        /* For conditions that are assertions, check the syntax, and then exit
6834
        the switch. This will take control down to where bracketed groups,
6835
        including assertions, are processed. */
6836
6837
13.2k
        if (tempptr[1] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
6838
13.2k
              (tempptr[2] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN ||
6839
2.01k
               tempptr[2] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK ||
6840
2.01k
                 (tempptr[2] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN &&
6841
445
                   (tempptr[3] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN ||
6842
411
                    tempptr[3] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK))))
6843
1.98k
          {
6844
1.98k
          cd->iscondassert = TRUE;
6845
1.98k
          break;
6846
1.98k
          }
6847
6848
        /* Other conditions use OP_CREF/OP_DNCREF/OP_RREF/OP_DNRREF, and all
6849
        need to skip at least 1+IMM2_SIZE bytes at the start of the group. */
6850
6851
11.2k
        code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_CREF;
6852
11.2k
        skipbytes = 1+IMM2_SIZE;
6853
11.2k
        refsign = -1;     /* => not a number */
6854
11.2k
        namelen = -1;     /* => not a name; must set to avoid warning */
6855
11.2k
        name = NULL;      /* Always set to avoid warning */
6856
11.2k
        recno = 0;        /* Always set to avoid warning */
6857
6858
        /* Check for a test for recursion in a named group. */
6859
6860
11.2k
        ptr++;
6861
11.2k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_R && ptr[1] == CHAR_AMPERSAND)
6862
1.05k
          {
6863
1.05k
          terminator = -1;
6864
1.05k
          ptr += 2;
6865
1.05k
          code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF;    /* Change the type of test */
6866
1.05k
          }
6867
6868
        /* Check for a test for a named group's having been set, using the Perl
6869
        syntax (?(<name>) or (?('name'), and also allow for the original PCRE
6870
        syntax of (?(name) or for (?(+n), (?(-n), and just (?(n). */
6871
6872
10.2k
        else if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)
6873
291
          {
6874
291
          terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
6875
291
          ptr++;
6876
291
          }
6877
9.91k
        else if (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)
6878
484
          {
6879
484
          terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
6880
484
          ptr++;
6881
484
          }
6882
9.43k
        else
6883
9.43k
          {
6884
9.43k
          terminator = CHAR_NULL;
6885
9.43k
          if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS || *ptr == CHAR_PLUS) refsign = *ptr++;
6886
7.47k
            else if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) refsign = 0;
6887
9.43k
          }
6888
6889
        /* Handle a number */
6890
6891
11.2k
        if (refsign >= 0)
6892
3.28k
          {
6893
7.57k
          while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
6894
4.30k
            {
6895
4.30k
            if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1)  /* Integer overflow */
6896
12
              {
6897
214
              while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) ptr++;
6898
12
              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
6899
12
              goto FAILED;
6900
12
              }
6901
4.29k
            recno = recno * 10 + (int)(*ptr - CHAR_0);
6902
4.29k
            ptr++;
6903
4.29k
            }
6904
3.28k
          }
6905
6906
        /* Otherwise we expect to read a name; anything else is an error. When
6907
        a name is one of a number of duplicates, a different opcode is used and
6908
        it needs more memory. Unfortunately we cannot tell whether a name is a
6909
        duplicate in the first pass, so we have to allow for more memory. */
6910
6911
7.97k
        else
6912
7.97k
          {
6913
7.97k
          if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
6914
1
            {
6915
1
            *errorcodeptr = ERR84;
6916
1
            goto FAILED;
6917
1
            }
6918
7.97k
          if (!MAX_255(*ptr) || (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) == 0)
6919
57
            {
6920
57
            *errorcodeptr = ERR28;   /* Assertion expected */
6921
57
            goto FAILED;
6922
57
            }
6923
7.91k
          name = ptr++;
6924
15.5k
          while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0)
6925
7.58k
            {
6926
7.58k
            ptr++;
6927
7.58k
            }
6928
7.91k
          namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
6929
7.91k
          if (lengthptr != NULL) skipbytes += IMM2_SIZE;
6930
7.91k
          }
6931
6932
        /* Check the terminator */
6933
6934
11.1k
        if ((terminator > 0 && *ptr++ != (pcre_uchar)terminator) ||
6935
11.1k
            *ptr++ != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
6936
41
          {
6937
41
          ptr--;                  /* Error offset */
6938
41
          *errorcodeptr = ERR26;  /* Malformed number or name */
6939
41
          goto FAILED;
6940
41
          }
6941
6942
        /* Do no further checking in the pre-compile phase. */
6943
6944
11.1k
        if (lengthptr != NULL) break;
6945
6946
        /* In the real compile we do the work of looking for the actual
6947
        reference. If refsign is not negative, it means we have a number in
6948
        recno. */
6949
6950
4.94k
        if (refsign >= 0)
6951
1.46k
          {
6952
1.46k
          if (recno <= 0)
6953
10
            {
6954
10
            *errorcodeptr = ERR35;
6955
10
            goto FAILED;
6956
10
            }
6957
1.45k
          if (refsign != 0) recno = (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)?
6958
525
            cd->bracount - recno + 1 : recno + cd->bracount;
6959
1.45k
          if (recno <= 0 || recno > cd->final_bracount)
6960
91
            {
6961
91
            *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
6962
91
            goto FAILED;
6963
91
            }
6964
1.35k
          PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno);
6965
1.35k
          if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
6966
1.35k
          break;
6967
1.45k
          }
6968
6969
        /* Otherwise look for the name. */
6970
6971
3.48k
        slot = cd->name_table;
6972
135k
        for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++)
6973
133k
          {
6974
133k
          if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) == 0 &&
6975
133k
            slot[IMM2_SIZE+namelen] == 0) break;
6976
131k
          slot += cd->name_entry_size;
6977
131k
          }
6978
6979
        /* Found the named subpattern. If the name is duplicated, add one to
6980
        the opcode to change CREF/RREF into DNCREF/DNRREF and insert
6981
        appropriate data values. Otherwise, just insert the unique subpattern
6982
        number. */
6983
6984
3.48k
        if (i < cd->names_found)
6985
1.72k
          {
6986
1.72k
          int offset = i++;
6987
1.72k
          int count = 1;
6988
1.72k
          recno = GET2(slot, 0);   /* Number from first found */
6989
1.72k
          if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
6990
37.2k
          for (; i < cd->names_found; i++)
6991
36.6k
            {
6992
36.6k
            slot += cd->name_entry_size;
6993
36.6k
            if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) != 0 ||
6994
36.6k
              (slot+IMM2_SIZE)[namelen] != 0) break;
6995
35.5k
            count++;
6996
35.5k
            }
6997
6998
1.72k
          if (count > 1)
6999
1.07k
            {
7000
1.07k
            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, offset);
7001
1.07k
            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE+IMM2_SIZE, count);
7002
1.07k
            skipbytes += IMM2_SIZE;
7003
1.07k
            code[1+LINK_SIZE]++;
7004
1.07k
            }
7005
646
          else  /* Not a duplicated name */
7006
646
            {
7007
646
            PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno);
7008
646
            }
7009
1.72k
          }
7010
7011
        /* If terminator == CHAR_NULL it means that the name followed directly
7012
        after the opening parenthesis [e.g. (?(abc)...] and in this case there
7013
        are some further alternatives to try. For the cases where terminator !=
7014
        CHAR_NULL [things like (?(<name>... or (?('name')... or (?(R&name)... ]
7015
        we have now checked all the possibilities, so give an error. */
7016
7017
1.76k
        else if (terminator != CHAR_NULL)
7018
14
          {
7019
14
          *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7020
14
          goto FAILED;
7021
14
          }
7022
7023
        /* Check for (?(R) for recursion. Allow digits after R to specify a
7024
        specific group number. */
7025
7026
1.75k
        else if (*name == CHAR_R)
7027
1.41k
          {
7028
1.41k
          recno = 0;
7029
2.55k
          for (i = 1; i < namelen; i++)
7030
1.17k
            {
7031
1.17k
            if (!IS_DIGIT(name[i]))
7032
19
              {
7033
19
              *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7034
19
              goto FAILED;
7035
19
              }
7036
1.15k
            if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1)   /* Integer overflow */
7037
9
              {
7038
9
              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
7039
9
              goto FAILED;
7040
9
              }
7041
1.14k
            recno = recno * 10 + name[i] - CHAR_0;
7042
1.14k
            }
7043
1.38k
          if (recno == 0) recno = RREF_ANY;
7044
1.38k
          code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF;      /* Change test type */
7045
1.38k
          PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, recno);
7046
1.38k
          }
7047
7048
        /* Similarly, check for the (?(DEFINE) "condition", which is always
7049
        false. */
7050
7051
335
        else if (namelen == 6 && STRNCMP_UC_C8(name, STRING_DEFINE, 6) == 0)
7052
221
          {
7053
221
          code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_DEF;
7054
221
          skipbytes = 1;
7055
221
          }
7056
7057
        /* Reference to an unidentified subpattern. */
7058
7059
114
        else
7060
114
          {
7061
114
          *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7062
114
          goto FAILED;
7063
114
          }
7064
3.33k
        break;
7065
7066
7067
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7068
7.25k
        case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:                 /* Positive lookahead */
7069
7.25k
        bravalue = OP_ASSERT;
7070
7.25k
        cd->assert_depth += 1;
7071
7.25k
        ptr++;
7072
7.25k
        break;
7073
7074
        /* Optimize (?!) to (*FAIL) unless it is quantified - which is a weird
7075
        thing to do, but Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when
7076
        they contain capturing parentheses there may be a potential use for
7077
        this feature. Not that that applies to a quantified (?!) but we allow
7078
        it for uniformity. */
7079
7080
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7081
3.09k
        case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:            /* Negative lookahead */
7082
3.09k
        ptr++;
7083
3.09k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && ptr[1] != CHAR_ASTERISK &&
7084
3.09k
             ptr[1] != CHAR_PLUS && ptr[1] != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK &&
7085
3.09k
            (ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET || !is_counted_repeat(ptr+2)))
7086
1.02k
          {
7087
1.02k
          *code++ = OP_FAIL;
7088
1.02k
          previous = NULL;
7089
1.02k
          continue;
7090
1.02k
          }
7091
2.07k
        bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NOT;
7092
2.07k
        cd->assert_depth += 1;
7093
2.07k
        break;
7094
7095
7096
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7097
10.0k
        case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN:              /* Lookbehind or named define */
7098
10.0k
        switch (ptr[1])
7099
10.0k
          {
7100
1.62k
          case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN:               /* Positive lookbehind */
7101
1.62k
          bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK;
7102
1.62k
          cd->assert_depth += 1;
7103
1.62k
          ptr += 2;
7104
1.62k
          break;
7105
7106
2.61k
          case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK:          /* Negative lookbehind */
7107
2.61k
          bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT;
7108
2.61k
          cd->assert_depth += 1;
7109
2.61k
          ptr += 2;
7110
2.61k
          break;
7111
7112
5.76k
          default:                /* Could be name define, else bad */
7113
5.76k
          if (MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (cd->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_word) != 0)
7114
5.75k
            goto DEFINE_NAME;
7115
8
          ptr++;                  /* Correct offset for error */
7116
8
          *errorcodeptr = ERR24;
7117
8
          goto FAILED;
7118
10.0k
          }
7119
4.24k
        break;
7120
7121
7122
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7123
4.24k
        case CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN:           /* One-time brackets */
7124
3.88k
        bravalue = OP_ONCE;
7125
3.88k
        ptr++;
7126
3.88k
        break;
7127
7128
7129
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7130
2.64k
        case CHAR_C:                 /* Callout - may be followed by digits; */
7131
2.64k
        previous_callout = code;     /* Save for later completion */
7132
2.64k
        after_manual_callout = 1;    /* Skip one item before completing */
7133
2.64k
        *code++ = OP_CALLOUT;
7134
2.64k
          {
7135
2.64k
          int n = 0;
7136
2.64k
          ptr++;
7137
2.84k
          while(IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7138
202
            {
7139
202
            n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
7140
202
            if (n > 255)
7141
1
              {
7142
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR38;
7143
1
              goto FAILED;
7144
1
              }
7145
202
            }
7146
2.63k
          if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7147
15
            {
7148
15
            *errorcodeptr = ERR39;
7149
15
            goto FAILED;
7150
15
            }
7151
2.62k
          *code++ = n;
7152
2.62k
          PUT(code, 0, (int)(ptr - cd->start_pattern + 1)); /* Pattern offset */
7153
2.62k
          PUT(code, LINK_SIZE, 0);                          /* Default length */
7154
2.62k
          code += 2 * LINK_SIZE;
7155
2.62k
          }
7156
0
        previous = NULL;
7157
2.62k
        continue;
7158
7159
7160
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7161
627
        case CHAR_P:              /* Python-style named subpattern handling */
7162
627
        if (*(++ptr) == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN ||
7163
627
            *ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN)  /* Reference or recursion */
7164
423
          {
7165
423
          is_recurse = *ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN;
7166
423
          terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
7167
423
          goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE;
7168
423
          }
7169
204
        else if (*ptr != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)  /* Test for Python-style defn */
7170
7
          {
7171
7
          *errorcodeptr = ERR41;
7172
7
          goto FAILED;
7173
7
          }
7174
        /* Fall through to handle (?P< as (?< is handled */
7175
7176
7177
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7178
5.95k
        DEFINE_NAME:    /* Come here from (?< handling */
7179
148k
        case CHAR_APOSTROPHE:
7180
148k
        terminator = (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
7181
142k
          CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
7182
148k
        name = ++ptr;
7183
148k
        if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7184
6
          {
7185
6
          *errorcodeptr = ERR84;   /* Group name must start with non-digit */
7186
6
          goto FAILED;
7187
6
          }
7188
2.25M
        while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) ptr++;
7189
148k
        namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
7190
7191
        /* In the pre-compile phase, do a syntax check, remember the longest
7192
        name, and then remember the group in a vector, expanding it if
7193
        necessary. Duplicates for the same number are skipped; other duplicates
7194
        are checked for validity. In the actual compile, there is nothing to
7195
        do. */
7196
7197
148k
        if (lengthptr != NULL)
7198
113k
          {
7199
113k
          named_group *ng;
7200
113k
          pcre_uint32 number = cd->bracount + 1;
7201
7202
113k
          if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
7203
27
            {
7204
27
            *errorcodeptr = ERR42;
7205
27
            goto FAILED;
7206
27
            }
7207
7208
113k
          if (cd->names_found >= MAX_NAME_COUNT)
7209
1
            {
7210
1
            *errorcodeptr = ERR49;
7211
1
            goto FAILED;
7212
1
            }
7213
7214
113k
          if (namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1 > cd->name_entry_size)
7215
1.36k
            {
7216
1.36k
            cd->name_entry_size = namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1;
7217
1.36k
            if (namelen > MAX_NAME_SIZE)
7218
24
              {
7219
24
              *errorcodeptr = ERR48;
7220
24
              goto FAILED;
7221
24
              }
7222
1.36k
            }
7223
7224
          /* Scan the list to check for duplicates. For duplicate names, if the
7225
          number is the same, break the loop, which causes the name to be
7226
          discarded; otherwise, if DUPNAMES is not set, give an error.
7227
          If it is set, allow the name with a different number, but continue
7228
          scanning in case this is a duplicate with the same number. For
7229
          non-duplicate names, give an error if the number is duplicated. */
7230
7231
113k
          ng = cd->named_groups;
7232
308M
          for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++, ng++)
7233
308M
            {
7234
308M
            if (namelen == ng->length &&
7235
308M
                STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, ng->name, namelen) == 0)
7236
306M
              {
7237
306M
              if (ng->number == number) break;
7238
306M
              if ((options & PCRE_DUPNAMES) == 0)
7239
11
                {
7240
11
                *errorcodeptr = ERR43;
7241
11
                goto FAILED;
7242
11
                }
7243
306M
              cd->dupnames = TRUE;  /* Duplicate names exist */
7244
306M
              }
7245
2.43M
            else if (ng->number == number)
7246
2
              {
7247
2
              *errorcodeptr = ERR65;
7248
2
              goto FAILED;
7249
2
              }
7250
308M
            }
7251
7252
113k
          if (i >= cd->names_found)     /* Not a duplicate with same number */
7253
112k
            {
7254
            /* Increase the list size if necessary */
7255
7256
112k
            if (cd->names_found >= cd->named_group_list_size)
7257
379
              {
7258
379
              int newsize = cd->named_group_list_size * 2;
7259
379
              named_group *newspace = (PUBL(malloc))
7260
379
                (newsize * sizeof(named_group));
7261
7262
379
              if (newspace == NULL)
7263
0
                {
7264
0
                *errorcodeptr = ERR21;
7265
0
                goto FAILED;
7266
0
                }
7267
7268
379
              memcpy(newspace, cd->named_groups,
7269
379
                cd->named_group_list_size * sizeof(named_group));
7270
379
              if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
7271
280
                (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups);
7272
379
              cd->named_groups = newspace;
7273
379
              cd->named_group_list_size = newsize;
7274
379
              }
7275
7276
112k
            cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].name = name;
7277
112k
            cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].length = namelen;
7278
112k
            cd->named_groups[cd->names_found].number = number;
7279
112k
            cd->names_found++;
7280
112k
            }
7281
113k
          }
7282
7283
147k
        ptr++;                    /* Move past > or ' in both passes. */
7284
147k
        goto NUMBERED_GROUP;
7285
7286
7287
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7288
1.09k
        case CHAR_AMPERSAND:            /* Perl recursion/subroutine syntax */
7289
1.09k
        terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
7290
1.09k
        is_recurse = TRUE;
7291
        /* Fall through */
7292
7293
        /* We come here from the Python syntax above that handles both
7294
        references (?P=name) and recursion (?P>name), as well as falling
7295
        through from the Perl recursion syntax (?&name). We also come here from
7296
        the Perl \k<name> or \k'name' back reference syntax and the \k{name}
7297
        .NET syntax, and the Oniguruma \g<...> and \g'...' subroutine syntax. */
7298
7299
8.64k
        NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE:
7300
8.64k
        name = ++ptr;
7301
8.64k
        if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7302
3
          {
7303
3
          *errorcodeptr = ERR84;   /* Group name must start with non-digit */
7304
3
          goto FAILED;
7305
3
          }
7306
114k
        while (MAX_255(*ptr) && (cd->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) ptr++;
7307
8.64k
        namelen = (int)(ptr - name);
7308
7309
        /* In the pre-compile phase, do a syntax check. We used to just set
7310
        a dummy reference number, because it was not used in the first pass.
7311
        However, with the change of recursive back references to be atomic,
7312
        we have to look for the number so that this state can be identified, as
7313
        otherwise the incorrect length is computed. If it's not a backwards
7314
        reference, the dummy number will do. */
7315
7316
8.64k
        if (lengthptr != NULL)
7317
5.08k
          {
7318
5.08k
          named_group *ng;
7319
5.08k
          recno = 0;
7320
7321
5.08k
          if (namelen == 0)
7322
35
            {
7323
35
            *errorcodeptr = ERR62;
7324
35
            goto FAILED;
7325
35
            }
7326
5.05k
          if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
7327
8
            {
7328
8
            *errorcodeptr = ERR42;
7329
8
            goto FAILED;
7330
8
            }
7331
5.04k
          if (namelen > MAX_NAME_SIZE)
7332
10
            {
7333
10
            *errorcodeptr = ERR48;
7334
10
            goto FAILED;
7335
10
            }
7336
7337
          /* Count named back references. */
7338
7339
5.03k
          if (!is_recurse) cd->namedrefcount++;
7340
7341
          /* We have to allow for a named reference to a duplicated name (this
7342
          cannot be determined until the second pass). This needs an extra
7343
          16-bit data item. */
7344
7345
5.03k
          *lengthptr += IMM2_SIZE;
7346
7347
          /* If this is a forward reference and we are within a (?|...) group,
7348
          the reference may end up as the number of a group which we are
7349
          currently inside, that is, it could be a recursive reference. In the
7350
          real compile this will be picked up and the reference wrapped with
7351
          OP_ONCE to make it atomic, so we must space in case this occurs. */
7352
7353
          /* In fact, this can happen for a non-forward reference because
7354
          another group with the same number might be created later. This
7355
          issue is fixed "properly" in PCRE2. As PCRE1 is now in maintenance
7356
          only mode, we finesse the bug by allowing more memory always. */
7357
7358
5.03k
          *lengthptr += 4 + 4*LINK_SIZE;
7359
7360
          /* It is even worse than that. The current reference may be to an
7361
          existing named group with a different number (so apparently not
7362
          recursive) but which later on is also attached to a group with the
7363
          current number. This can only happen if $(| has been previous
7364
          encountered. In that case, we allow yet more memory, just in case.
7365
          (Again, this is fixed "properly" in PCRE2. */
7366
7367
5.03k
          if (cd->dupgroups) *lengthptr += 4 + 4*LINK_SIZE;
7368
7369
          /* Otherwise, check for recursion here. The name table does not exist
7370
          in the first pass; instead we must scan the list of names encountered
7371
          so far in order to get the number. If the name is not found, leave
7372
          the value of recno as 0 for a forward reference. */
7373
7374
          /* This patch (removing "else") fixes a problem when a reference is
7375
          to multiple identically named nested groups from within the nest.
7376
          Once again, it is not the "proper" fix, and it results in an
7377
          over-allocation of memory. */
7378
7379
          /* else */
7380
5.03k
            {
7381
5.03k
            ng = cd->named_groups;
7382
999k
            for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++, ng++)
7383
994k
              {
7384
994k
              if (namelen == ng->length &&
7385
994k
                  STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, ng->name, namelen) == 0)
7386
36.8k
                {
7387
36.8k
                open_capitem *oc;
7388
36.8k
                recno = ng->number;
7389
36.8k
                if (is_recurse) break;
7390
1.55M
                for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
7391
1.52M
                  {
7392
1.52M
                  if (oc->number == recno)
7393
9.67k
                    {
7394
9.67k
                    oc->flag = TRUE;
7395
9.67k
                    break;
7396
9.67k
                    }
7397
1.52M
                  }
7398
36.1k
                }
7399
994k
              }
7400
5.03k
            }
7401
5.03k
          }
7402
7403
        /* In the real compile, search the name table. We check the name
7404
        first, and then check that we have reached the end of the name in the
7405
        table. That way, if the name is longer than any in the table, the
7406
        comparison will fail without reading beyond the table entry. */
7407
7408
3.55k
        else
7409
3.55k
          {
7410
3.55k
          slot = cd->name_table;
7411
146k
          for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++)
7412
146k
            {
7413
146k
            if (STRNCMP_UC_UC(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, namelen) == 0 &&
7414
146k
                slot[IMM2_SIZE+namelen] == 0)
7415
3.36k
              break;
7416
142k
            slot += cd->name_entry_size;
7417
142k
            }
7418
7419
3.55k
          if (i < cd->names_found)
7420
3.36k
            {
7421
3.36k
            recno = GET2(slot, 0);
7422
3.36k
            }
7423
186
          else
7424
186
            {
7425
186
            *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7426
186
            goto FAILED;
7427
186
            }
7428
3.55k
          }
7429
7430
        /* In both phases, for recursions, we can now go to the code than
7431
        handles numerical recursion. */
7432
7433
8.40k
        if (is_recurse) goto HANDLE_RECURSION;
7434
7435
        /* In the second pass we must see if the name is duplicated. If so, we
7436
        generate a different opcode. */
7437
7438
6.58k
        if (lengthptr == NULL && cd->dupnames)
7439
2.19k
          {
7440
2.19k
          int count = 1;
7441
2.19k
          unsigned int index = i;
7442
2.19k
          pcre_uchar *cslot = slot + cd->name_entry_size;
7443
7444
27.4k
          for (i++; i < cd->names_found; i++)
7445
25.7k
            {
7446
25.7k
            if (STRCMP_UC_UC(slot + IMM2_SIZE, cslot + IMM2_SIZE) != 0) break;
7447
25.2k
            count++;
7448
25.2k
            cslot += cd->name_entry_size;
7449
25.2k
            }
7450
7451
2.19k
          if (count > 1)
7452
1.78k
            {
7453
1.78k
            if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7454
1.78k
            previous = code;
7455
1.78k
            item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
7456
1.78k
            *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_DNREFI : OP_DNREF;
7457
1.78k
            PUT2INC(code, 0, index);
7458
1.78k
            PUT2INC(code, 0, count);
7459
7460
            /* Process each potentially referenced group. */
7461
7462
28.8k
            for (; slot < cslot; slot += cd->name_entry_size)
7463
27.0k
              {
7464
27.0k
              open_capitem *oc;
7465
27.0k
              recno = GET2(slot, 0);
7466
27.0k
              cd->backref_map |= (recno < 32)? (1U << recno) : 1;
7467
27.0k
              if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
7468
7469
              /* Check to see if this back reference is recursive, that it, it
7470
              is inside the group that it references. A flag is set so that the
7471
              group can be made atomic. */
7472
7473
573k
              for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
7474
551k
                {
7475
551k
                if (oc->number == recno)
7476
4.94k
                  {
7477
4.94k
                  oc->flag = TRUE;
7478
4.94k
                  break;
7479
4.94k
                  }
7480
551k
                }
7481
27.0k
              }
7482
7483
1.78k
            continue;  /* End of back ref handling */
7484
1.78k
            }
7485
2.19k
          }
7486
7487
        /* First pass, or a non-duplicated name. */
7488
7489
4.79k
        goto HANDLE_REFERENCE;
7490
7491
7492
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7493
4.79k
        case CHAR_R:              /* Recursion, same as (?0) */
7494
1.09k
        recno = 0;
7495
1.09k
        if (*(++ptr) != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7496
2
          {
7497
2
          *errorcodeptr = ERR29;
7498
2
          goto FAILED;
7499
2
          }
7500
1.09k
        goto HANDLE_RECURSION;
7501
7502
7503
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7504
1.70k
        case CHAR_MINUS: case CHAR_PLUS:  /* Recursion or subroutine */
7505
8.32k
        case CHAR_0: case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4:
7506
10.0k
        case CHAR_5: case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9:
7507
10.0k
          {
7508
10.0k
          const pcre_uchar *called;
7509
10.0k
          terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS;
7510
7511
          /* Come here from the \g<...> and \g'...' code (Oniguruma
7512
          compatibility). However, the syntax has been checked to ensure that
7513
          the ... are a (signed) number, so that neither ERR63 nor ERR29 will
7514
          be called on this path, nor with the jump to OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY
7515
          ever be taken. */
7516
7517
10.7k
          HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION:
7518
7519
10.7k
          if ((refsign = *ptr) == CHAR_PLUS)
7520
1.35k
            {
7521
1.35k
            ptr++;
7522
1.35k
            if (!IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7523
10
              {
7524
10
              *errorcodeptr = ERR63;
7525
10
              goto FAILED;
7526
10
              }
7527
1.35k
            }
7528
9.42k
          else if (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)
7529
753
            {
7530
753
            if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[1]))
7531
426
              goto OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY;
7532
327
            ptr++;
7533
327
            }
7534
7535
10.3k
          recno = 0;
7536
24.5k
          while(IS_DIGIT(*ptr))
7537
14.1k
            {
7538
14.1k
            if (recno > INT_MAX / 10 - 1) /* Integer overflow */
7539
14
              {
7540
219
              while (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) ptr++;
7541
14
              *errorcodeptr = ERR61;
7542
14
              goto FAILED;
7543
14
              }
7544
14.1k
            recno = recno * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0;
7545
14.1k
            }
7546
7547
10.3k
          if (*ptr != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
7548
33
            {
7549
33
            *errorcodeptr = ERR29;
7550
33
            goto FAILED;
7551
33
            }
7552
7553
10.2k
          if (refsign == CHAR_MINUS)
7554
323
            {
7555
323
            if (recno == 0)
7556
1
              {
7557
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR58;
7558
1
              goto FAILED;
7559
1
              }
7560
322
            recno = cd->bracount - recno + 1;
7561
322
            if (recno <= 0)
7562
46
              {
7563
46
              *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7564
46
              goto FAILED;
7565
46
              }
7566
322
            }
7567
9.97k
          else if (refsign == CHAR_PLUS)
7568
1.34k
            {
7569
1.34k
            if (recno == 0)
7570
1
              {
7571
1
              *errorcodeptr = ERR58;
7572
1
              goto FAILED;
7573
1
              }
7574
1.34k
            recno += cd->bracount;
7575
1.34k
            }
7576
7577
          /* Come here from code above that handles a named recursion */
7578
7579
13.1k
          HANDLE_RECURSION:
7580
7581
13.1k
          previous = code;
7582
13.1k
          item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
7583
13.1k
          called = cd->start_code;
7584
7585
          /* When we are actually compiling, find the bracket that is being
7586
          referenced. Temporarily end the regex in case it doesn't exist before
7587
          this point. If we end up with a forward reference, first check that
7588
          the bracket does occur later so we can give the error (and position)
7589
          now. Then remember this forward reference in the workspace so it can
7590
          be filled in at the end. */
7591
7592
13.1k
          if (lengthptr == NULL)
7593
5.73k
            {
7594
5.73k
            *code = OP_END;
7595
5.73k
            if (recno != 0)
7596
4.36k
              called = PRIV(find_bracket)(cd->start_code, utf, recno);
7597
7598
            /* Forward reference */
7599
7600
5.73k
            if (called == NULL)
7601
1.49k
              {
7602
1.49k
              if (recno > cd->final_bracount)
7603
318
                {
7604
318
                *errorcodeptr = ERR15;
7605
318
                goto FAILED;
7606
318
                }
7607
7608
              /* Fudge the value of "called" so that when it is inserted as an
7609
              offset below, what it actually inserted is the reference number
7610
              of the group. Then remember the forward reference. */
7611
7612
1.18k
              called = cd->start_code + recno;
7613
1.18k
              if (cd->hwm >= cd->start_workspace + cd->workspace_size -
7614
1.18k
                  WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN)
7615
3
                {
7616
3
                *errorcodeptr = expand_workspace(cd);
7617
3
                if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
7618
3
                }
7619
1.18k
              PUTINC(cd->hwm, 0, (int)(code + 1 - cd->start_code));
7620
1.18k
              }
7621
7622
            /* If not a forward reference, and the subpattern is still open,
7623
            this is a recursive call. We check to see if this is a left
7624
            recursion that could loop for ever, and diagnose that case. We
7625
            must not, however, do this check if we are in a conditional
7626
            subpattern because the condition might be testing for recursion in
7627
            a pattern such as /(?(R)a+|(?R)b)/, which is perfectly valid.
7628
            Forever loops are also detected at runtime, so those that occur in
7629
            conditional subpatterns will be picked up then. */
7630
7631
4.24k
            else if (GET(called, 1) == 0 && cond_depth <= 0 &&
7632
4.24k
                     could_be_empty(called, code, bcptr, utf, cd))
7633
31
              {
7634
31
              *errorcodeptr = ERR40;
7635
31
              goto FAILED;
7636
31
              }
7637
5.73k
            }
7638
7639
          /* Insert the recursion/subroutine item. It does not have a set first
7640
          character (relevant if it is repeated, because it will then be
7641
          wrapped with ONCE brackets). */
7642
7643
12.8k
          *code = OP_RECURSE;
7644
12.8k
          PUT(code, 1, (int)(called - cd->start_code));
7645
12.8k
          code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
7646
12.8k
          groupsetfirstchar = FALSE;
7647
12.8k
          }
7648
7649
        /* Can't determine a first byte now */
7650
7651
12.8k
        if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7652
12.8k
        zerofirstchar = firstchar;
7653
12.8k
        zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
7654
12.8k
        continue;
7655
7656
7657
        /* ------------------------------------------------------------ */
7658
9.91k
        default:              /* Other characters: check option setting */
7659
10.3k
        OTHER_CHAR_AFTER_QUERY:
7660
10.3k
        set = unset = 0;
7661
10.3k
        optset = &set;
7662
7663
24.1k
        while (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && *ptr != CHAR_COLON)
7664
13.8k
          {
7665
13.8k
          switch (*ptr++)
7666
13.8k
            {
7667
612
            case CHAR_MINUS: optset = &unset; break;
7668
7669
6.07k
            case CHAR_J:    /* Record that it changed in the external options */
7670
6.07k
            *optset |= PCRE_DUPNAMES;
7671
6.07k
            cd->external_flags |= PCRE_JCHANGED;
7672
6.07k
            break;
7673
7674
2.44k
            case CHAR_i: *optset |= PCRE_CASELESS; break;
7675
935
            case CHAR_m: *optset |= PCRE_MULTILINE; break;
7676
1.18k
            case CHAR_s: *optset |= PCRE_DOTALL; break;
7677
815
            case CHAR_x: *optset |= PCRE_EXTENDED; break;
7678
1.53k
            case CHAR_U: *optset |= PCRE_UNGREEDY; break;
7679
198
            case CHAR_X: *optset |= PCRE_EXTRA; break;
7680
7681
52
            default:  *errorcodeptr = ERR12;
7682
52
                      ptr--;    /* Correct the offset */
7683
52
                      goto FAILED;
7684
13.8k
            }
7685
13.8k
          }
7686
7687
        /* Set up the changed option bits, but don't change anything yet. */
7688
7689
10.2k
        newoptions = (options | set) & (~unset);
7690
7691
        /* If the options ended with ')' this is not the start of a nested
7692
        group with option changes, so the options change at this level.
7693
        If we are not at the pattern start, reset the greedy defaults and the
7694
        case value for firstchar and reqchar. */
7695
7696
10.2k
        if (*ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7697
5.15k
          {
7698
5.15k
          greedy_default = ((newoptions & PCRE_UNGREEDY) != 0);
7699
5.15k
          greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1;
7700
5.15k
          req_caseopt = ((newoptions & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS:0;
7701
7702
          /* Change options at this level, and pass them back for use
7703
          in subsequent branches. */
7704
7705
5.15k
          *optionsptr = options = newoptions;
7706
5.15k
          previous = NULL;       /* This item can't be repeated */
7707
5.15k
          continue;              /* It is complete */
7708
5.15k
          }
7709
7710
        /* If the options ended with ':' we are heading into a nested group
7711
        with possible change of options. Such groups are non-capturing and are
7712
        not assertions of any kind. All we need to do is skip over the ':';
7713
        the newoptions value is handled below. */
7714
7715
5.13k
        bravalue = OP_BRA;
7716
5.13k
        ptr++;
7717
208k
        }     /* End of switch for character following (? */
7718
208k
      }       /* End of (? handling */
7719
7720
    /* Opening parenthesis not followed by '*' or '?'. If PCRE_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE
7721
    is set, all unadorned brackets become non-capturing and behave like (?:...)
7722
    brackets. */
7723
7724
642k
    else if ((options & PCRE_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE) != 0)
7725
0
      {
7726
0
      bravalue = OP_BRA;
7727
0
      }
7728
7729
    /* Else we have a capturing group. */
7730
7731
642k
    else
7732
642k
      {
7733
790k
      NUMBERED_GROUP:
7734
790k
      cd->bracount += 1;
7735
790k
      PUT2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE, cd->bracount);
7736
790k
      skipbytes = IMM2_SIZE;
7737
790k
      }
7738
7739
    /* Process nested bracketed regex. First check for parentheses nested too
7740
    deeply. */
7741
7742
829k
    if ((cd->parens_depth += 1) > PARENS_NEST_LIMIT)
7743
3
      {
7744
3
      *errorcodeptr = ERR82;
7745
3
      goto FAILED;
7746
3
      }
7747
7748
    /* All assertions used not to be repeatable, but this was changed for Perl
7749
    compatibility. All kinds can now be repeated except for assertions that are
7750
    conditions (Perl also forbids these to be repeated). We copy code into a
7751
    non-register variable (tempcode) in order to be able to pass its address
7752
    because some compilers complain otherwise. At the start of a conditional
7753
    group whose condition is an assertion, cd->iscondassert is set. We unset it
7754
    here so as to allow assertions later in the group to be quantified. */
7755
7756
829k
    if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT &&
7757
829k
        cd->iscondassert)
7758
1.64k
      {
7759
1.64k
      previous = NULL;
7760
1.64k
      cd->iscondassert = FALSE;
7761
1.64k
      }
7762
827k
    else
7763
827k
      {
7764
827k
      previous = code;
7765
827k
      item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
7766
827k
      }
7767
7768
829k
    *code = bravalue;
7769
829k
    tempcode = code;
7770
829k
    tempreqvary = cd->req_varyopt;        /* Save value before bracket */
7771
829k
    tempbracount = cd->bracount;          /* Save value before bracket */
7772
829k
    length_prevgroup = 0;                 /* Initialize for pre-compile phase */
7773
7774
829k
    if (!compile_regex(
7775
829k
         newoptions,                      /* The complete new option state */
7776
829k
         &tempcode,                       /* Where to put code (updated) */
7777
829k
         &ptr,                            /* Input pointer (updated) */
7778
829k
         errorcodeptr,                    /* Where to put an error message */
7779
829k
         (bravalue == OP_ASSERTBACK ||
7780
829k
          bravalue == OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT), /* TRUE if back assert */
7781
829k
         reset_bracount,                  /* True if (?| group */
7782
829k
         skipbytes,                       /* Skip over bracket number */
7783
829k
         cond_depth +
7784
829k
           ((bravalue == OP_COND)?1:0),   /* Depth of condition subpatterns */
7785
829k
         &subfirstchar,                   /* For possible first char */
7786
829k
         &subfirstcharflags,
7787
829k
         &subreqchar,                     /* For possible last char */
7788
829k
         &subreqcharflags,
7789
829k
         bcptr,                           /* Current branch chain */
7790
829k
         cd,                              /* Tables block */
7791
829k
         (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL :      /* Actual compile phase */
7792
829k
           &length_prevgroup              /* Pre-compile phase */
7793
829k
         ))
7794
12.6k
      goto FAILED;
7795
7796
816k
    cd->parens_depth -= 1;
7797
7798
    /* If this was an atomic group and there are no capturing groups within it,
7799
    generate OP_ONCE_NC instead of OP_ONCE. */
7800
7801
816k
    if (bravalue == OP_ONCE && cd->bracount <= tempbracount)
7802
2.03k
      *code = OP_ONCE_NC;
7803
7804
816k
    if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT)
7805
12.9k
      cd->assert_depth -= 1;
7806
7807
    /* At the end of compiling, code is still pointing to the start of the
7808
    group, while tempcode has been updated to point past the end of the group.
7809
    The pattern pointer (ptr) is on the bracket.
7810
7811
    If this is a conditional bracket, check that there are no more than
7812
    two branches in the group, or just one if it's a DEFINE group. We do this
7813
    in the real compile phase, not in the pre-pass, where the whole group may
7814
    not be available. */
7815
7816
816k
    if (bravalue == OP_COND && lengthptr == NULL)
7817
5.50k
      {
7818
5.50k
      pcre_uchar *tc = code;
7819
5.50k
      int condcount = 0;
7820
7821
30.4k
      do {
7822
30.4k
         condcount++;
7823
30.4k
         tc += GET(tc,1);
7824
30.4k
         }
7825
30.4k
      while (*tc != OP_KET);
7826
7827
      /* A DEFINE group is never obeyed inline (the "condition" is always
7828
      false). It must have only one branch. */
7829
7830
5.50k
      if (code[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEF)
7831
221
        {
7832
221
        if (condcount > 1)
7833
1
          {
7834
1
          *errorcodeptr = ERR54;
7835
1
          goto FAILED;
7836
1
          }
7837
220
        bravalue = OP_DEF;   /* Just a flag to suppress char handling below */
7838
220
        }
7839
7840
      /* A "normal" conditional group. If there is just one branch, we must not
7841
      make use of its firstchar or reqchar, because this is equivalent to an
7842
      empty second branch. */
7843
7844
5.28k
      else
7845
5.28k
        {
7846
5.28k
        if (condcount > 2)
7847
23
          {
7848
23
          *errorcodeptr = ERR27;
7849
23
          goto FAILED;
7850
23
          }
7851
5.25k
        if (condcount == 1) subfirstcharflags = subreqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7852
5.25k
        }
7853
5.50k
      }
7854
7855
    /* Error if hit end of pattern */
7856
7857
816k
    if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)
7858
626
      {
7859
626
      *errorcodeptr = ERR14;
7860
626
      goto FAILED;
7861
626
      }
7862
7863
    /* In the pre-compile phase, update the length by the length of the group,
7864
    less the brackets at either end. Then reduce the compiled code to just a
7865
    set of non-capturing brackets so that it doesn't use much memory if it is
7866
    duplicated by a quantifier.*/
7867
7868
815k
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
7869
693k
      {
7870
693k
      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE)
7871
1
        {
7872
1
        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
7873
1
        goto FAILED;
7874
1
        }
7875
693k
      *lengthptr += length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE;
7876
693k
      code++;   /* This already contains bravalue */
7877
693k
      PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
7878
693k
      *code++ = OP_KET;
7879
693k
      PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
7880
693k
      break;    /* No need to waste time with special character handling */
7881
693k
      }
7882
7883
    /* Otherwise update the main code pointer to the end of the group. */
7884
7885
121k
    code = tempcode;
7886
7887
    /* For a DEFINE group, required and first character settings are not
7888
    relevant. */
7889
7890
121k
    if (bravalue == OP_DEF) break;
7891
7892
    /* Handle updating of the required and first characters for other types of
7893
    group. Update for normal brackets of all kinds, and conditions with two
7894
    branches (see code above). If the bracket is followed by a quantifier with
7895
    zero repeat, we have to back off. Hence the definition of zeroreqchar and
7896
    zerofirstchar outside the main loop so that they can be accessed for the
7897
    back off. */
7898
7899
121k
    zeroreqchar = reqchar;
7900
121k
    zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
7901
121k
    zerofirstchar = firstchar;
7902
121k
    zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
7903
121k
    groupsetfirstchar = FALSE;
7904
7905
121k
    if (bravalue >= OP_ONCE)
7906
115k
      {
7907
      /* If we have not yet set a firstchar in this branch, take it from the
7908
      subpattern, remembering that it was set here so that a repeat of more
7909
      than one can replicate it as reqchar if necessary. If the subpattern has
7910
      no firstchar, set "none" for the whole branch. In both cases, a zero
7911
      repeat forces firstchar to "none". */
7912
7913
115k
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
7914
63.1k
        {
7915
63.1k
        if (subfirstcharflags >= 0)
7916
28.9k
          {
7917
28.9k
          firstchar = subfirstchar;
7918
28.9k
          firstcharflags = subfirstcharflags;
7919
28.9k
          groupsetfirstchar = TRUE;
7920
28.9k
          }
7921
34.1k
        else firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7922
63.1k
        zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7923
63.1k
        }
7924
7925
      /* If firstchar was previously set, convert the subpattern's firstchar
7926
      into reqchar if there wasn't one, using the vary flag that was in
7927
      existence beforehand. */
7928
7929
52.3k
      else if (subfirstcharflags >= 0 && subreqcharflags < 0)
7930
3.81k
        {
7931
3.81k
        subreqchar = subfirstchar;
7932
3.81k
        subreqcharflags = subfirstcharflags | tempreqvary;
7933
3.81k
        }
7934
7935
      /* If the subpattern set a required byte (or set a first byte that isn't
7936
      really the first byte - see above), set it. */
7937
7938
115k
      if (subreqcharflags >= 0)
7939
43.6k
        {
7940
43.6k
        reqchar = subreqchar;
7941
43.6k
        reqcharflags = subreqcharflags;
7942
43.6k
        }
7943
115k
      }
7944
7945
    /* For a forward assertion, we take the reqchar, if set, provided that the
7946
    group has also set a first char. This can be helpful if the pattern that
7947
    follows the assertion doesn't set a different char. For example, it's
7948
    useful for /(?=abcde).+/. We can't set firstchar for an assertion, however
7949
    because it leads to incorrect effect for patterns such as /(?=a)a.+/ when
7950
    the "real" "a" would then become a reqchar instead of a firstchar. This is
7951
    overcome by a scan at the end if there's no firstchar, looking for an
7952
    asserted first char. */
7953
7954
6.17k
    else if (bravalue == OP_ASSERT && subreqcharflags >= 0 &&
7955
6.17k
             subfirstcharflags >= 0)
7956
1.09k
      {
7957
1.09k
      reqchar = subreqchar;
7958
1.09k
      reqcharflags = subreqcharflags;
7959
1.09k
      }
7960
121k
    break;     /* End of processing '(' */
7961
7962
7963
    /* ===================================================================*/
7964
    /* Handle metasequences introduced by \. For ones like \d, the ESC_ values
7965
    are arranged to be the negation of the corresponding OP_values in the
7966
    default case when PCRE_UCP is not set. For the back references, the values
7967
    are negative the reference number. Only back references and those types
7968
    that consume a character may be repeated. We can test for values between
7969
    ESC_b and ESC_Z for the latter; this may have to change if any new ones are
7970
    ever created. */
7971
7972
76.7k
    case CHAR_BACKSLASH:
7973
76.7k
    tempptr = ptr;
7974
76.7k
    escape = check_escape(&ptr, &ec, errorcodeptr, cd->bracount, options, FALSE);
7975
76.7k
    if (*errorcodeptr != 0) goto FAILED;
7976
7977
76.4k
    if (escape == 0)                  /* The escape coded a single character */
7978
47.1k
      c = ec;
7979
29.2k
    else
7980
29.2k
      {
7981
      /* For metasequences that actually match a character, we disable the
7982
      setting of a first character if it hasn't already been set. */
7983
7984
29.2k
      if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET && escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z)
7985
4.52k
        firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
7986
7987
      /* Set values to reset to if this is followed by a zero repeat. */
7988
7989
29.2k
      zerofirstchar = firstchar;
7990
29.2k
      zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
7991
29.2k
      zeroreqchar = reqchar;
7992
29.2k
      zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
7993
7994
      /* \g<name> or \g'name' is a subroutine call by name and \g<n> or \g'n'
7995
      is a subroutine call by number (Oniguruma syntax). In fact, the value
7996
      ESC_g is returned only for these cases. So we don't need to check for <
7997
      or ' if the value is ESC_g. For the Perl syntax \g{n} the value is
7998
      -n, and for the Perl syntax \g{name} the result is ESC_k (as
7999
      that is a synonym for a named back reference). */
8000
8001
29.2k
      if (escape == ESC_g)
8002
1.56k
        {
8003
1.56k
        const pcre_uchar *p;
8004
1.56k
        pcre_uint32 cf;
8005
8006
1.56k
        item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;   /* Normally this is set when '(' is read */
8007
1.56k
        terminator = (*(++ptr) == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
8008
901
          CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : CHAR_APOSTROPHE;
8009
8010
        /* These two statements stop the compiler for warning about possibly
8011
        unset variables caused by the jump to HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION. In
8012
        fact, because we do the check for a number below, the paths that
8013
        would actually be in error are never taken. */
8014
8015
1.56k
        skipbytes = 0;
8016
1.56k
        reset_bracount = FALSE;
8017
8018
        /* If it's not a signed or unsigned number, treat it as a name. */
8019
8020
1.56k
        cf = ptr[1];
8021
1.56k
        if (cf != CHAR_PLUS && cf != CHAR_MINUS && !IS_DIGIT(cf))
8022
804
          {
8023
804
          is_recurse = TRUE;
8024
804
          goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE;
8025
804
          }
8026
8027
        /* Signed or unsigned number (cf = ptr[1]) is known to be plus or minus
8028
        or a digit. */
8029
8030
764
        p = ptr + 2;
8031
1.39k
        while (IS_DIGIT(*p)) p++;
8032
764
        if (*p != (pcre_uchar)terminator)
8033
14
          {
8034
14
          *errorcodeptr = ERR57;
8035
14
          goto FAILED;
8036
14
          }
8037
750
        ptr++;
8038
750
        goto HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION;
8039
764
        }
8040
8041
      /* \k<name> or \k'name' is a back reference by name (Perl syntax).
8042
      We also support \k{name} (.NET syntax).  */
8043
8044
27.6k
      if (escape == ESC_k)
8045
6.33k
        {
8046
6.33k
        if ((ptr[1] != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN &&
8047
6.33k
          ptr[1] != CHAR_APOSTROPHE && ptr[1] != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET))
8048
13
          {
8049
13
          *errorcodeptr = ERR69;
8050
13
          goto FAILED;
8051
13
          }
8052
6.32k
        is_recurse = FALSE;
8053
6.32k
        terminator = (*(++ptr) == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)?
8054
5.69k
          CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)?
8055
4.81k
          CHAR_APOSTROPHE : CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET;
8056
6.32k
        goto NAMED_REF_OR_RECURSE;
8057
6.33k
        }
8058
8059
      /* Back references are handled specially; must disable firstchar if
8060
      not set to cope with cases like (?=(\w+))\1: which would otherwise set
8061
      ':' later. */
8062
8063
21.3k
      if (escape < 0)
8064
8.60k
        {
8065
8.60k
        open_capitem *oc;
8066
8.60k
        recno = -escape;
8067
8068
        /* Come here from named backref handling when the reference is to a
8069
        single group (i.e. not to a duplicated name. */
8070
8071
13.4k
        HANDLE_REFERENCE:
8072
13.4k
        if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET) zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8073
13.4k
        previous = code;
8074
13.4k
        item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8075
13.4k
        *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_REFI : OP_REF;
8076
13.4k
        PUT2INC(code, 0, recno);
8077
13.4k
        cd->backref_map |= (recno < 32)? (1U << recno) : 1;
8078
13.4k
        if (recno > cd->top_backref) cd->top_backref = recno;
8079
8080
        /* Check to see if this back reference is recursive, that it, it
8081
        is inside the group that it references. A flag is set so that the
8082
        group can be made atomic. */
8083
8084
76.4k
        for (oc = cd->open_caps; oc != NULL; oc = oc->next)
8085
70.2k
          {
8086
70.2k
          if (oc->number == recno)
8087
7.16k
            {
8088
7.16k
            oc->flag = TRUE;
8089
7.16k
            break;
8090
7.16k
            }
8091
70.2k
          }
8092
13.4k
        }
8093
8094
      /* So are Unicode property matches, if supported. */
8095
8096
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
8097
      else if (escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p)
8098
        {
8099
        BOOL negated;
8100
        unsigned int ptype = 0, pdata = 0;
8101
        if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, errorcodeptr))
8102
          goto FAILED;
8103
        previous = code;
8104
        item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8105
        *code++ = ((escape == ESC_p) != negated)? OP_PROP : OP_NOTPROP;
8106
        *code++ = ptype;
8107
        *code++ = pdata;
8108
        }
8109
#else
8110
8111
      /* If Unicode properties are not supported, \X, \P, and \p are not
8112
      allowed. */
8113
8114
12.7k
      else if (escape == ESC_X || escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p)
8115
5
        {
8116
5
        *errorcodeptr = ERR45;
8117
5
        goto FAILED;
8118
5
        }
8119
12.7k
#endif
8120
8121
      /* For the rest (including \X when Unicode properties are supported), we
8122
      can obtain the OP value by negating the escape value in the default
8123
      situation when PCRE_UCP is not set. When it *is* set, we substitute
8124
      Unicode property tests. Note that \b and \B do a one-character
8125
      lookbehind, and \A also behaves as if it does. */
8126
8127
12.7k
      else
8128
12.7k
        {
8129
12.7k
        if ((escape == ESC_b || escape == ESC_B || escape == ESC_A) &&
8130
12.7k
             cd->max_lookbehind == 0)
8131
327
          cd->max_lookbehind = 1;
8132
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
8133
        if (escape >= ESC_DU && escape <= ESC_wu)
8134
          {
8135
          nestptr = ptr + 1;                   /* Where to resume */
8136
          ptr = substitutes[escape - ESC_DU] - 1;  /* Just before substitute */
8137
          }
8138
        else
8139
#endif
8140
        /* In non-UTF-8 mode, we turn \C into OP_ALLANY instead of OP_ANYBYTE
8141
        so that it works in DFA mode and in lookbehinds. */
8142
8143
12.7k
          {
8144
12.7k
          previous = (escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z)? code : NULL;
8145
12.7k
          item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8146
12.7k
          *code++ = (!utf && escape == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : escape;
8147
12.7k
          }
8148
12.7k
        }
8149
26.1k
      continue;
8150
21.3k
      }
8151
8152
    /* We have a data character whose value is in c. In UTF-8 mode it may have
8153
    a value > 127. We set its representation in the length/buffer, and then
8154
    handle it as a data character. */
8155
8156
#if defined SUPPORT_UTF && !defined COMPILE_PCRE32
8157
    if (utf && c > MAX_VALUE_FOR_SINGLE_CHAR)
8158
      mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(c, mcbuffer);
8159
    else
8160
#endif
8161
8162
47.1k
     {
8163
47.1k
     mcbuffer[0] = c;
8164
47.1k
     mclength = 1;
8165
47.1k
     }
8166
47.1k
    goto ONE_CHAR;
8167
8168
8169
    /* ===================================================================*/
8170
    /* Handle a literal character. It is guaranteed not to be whitespace or #
8171
    when the extended flag is set. If we are in a UTF mode, it may be a
8172
    multi-unit literal character. */
8173
8174
1.26M
    default:
8175
1.36M
    NORMAL_CHAR:
8176
1.36M
    mclength = 1;
8177
1.36M
    mcbuffer[0] = c;
8178
8179
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
8180
    if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(c))
8181
      ACROSSCHAR(TRUE, ptr[1], mcbuffer[mclength++] = *(++ptr));
8182
#endif
8183
8184
    /* At this point we have the character's bytes in mcbuffer, and the length
8185
    in mclength. When not in UTF-8 mode, the length is always 1. */
8186
8187
1.40M
    ONE_CHAR:
8188
1.40M
    previous = code;
8189
1.40M
    item_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8190
8191
    /* For caseless UTF-8 mode when UCP support is available, check whether
8192
    this character has more than one other case. If so, generate a special
8193
    OP_PROP item instead of OP_CHARI. */
8194
8195
#ifdef SUPPORT_UCP
8196
    if (utf && (options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)
8197
      {
8198
      GETCHAR(c, mcbuffer);
8199
      if ((c = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0)
8200
        {
8201
        *code++ = OP_PROP;
8202
        *code++ = PT_CLIST;
8203
        *code++ = c;
8204
        if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
8205
          firstcharflags = zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8206
        break;
8207
        }
8208
      }
8209
#endif
8210
8211
    /* Caseful matches, or not one of the multicase characters. */
8212
8213
1.40M
    *code++ = ((options & PCRE_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_CHARI : OP_CHAR;
8214
2.81M
    for (c = 0; c < mclength; c++) *code++ = mcbuffer[c];
8215
8216
    /* Remember if \r or \n were seen */
8217
8218
1.40M
    if (mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_CR || mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_NL)
8219
5.94k
      cd->external_flags |= PCRE_HASCRORLF;
8220
8221
    /* Set the first and required bytes appropriately. If no previous first
8222
    byte, set it from this character, but revert to none on a zero repeat.
8223
    Otherwise, leave the firstchar value alone, and don't change it on a zero
8224
    repeat. */
8225
8226
1.40M
    if (firstcharflags == REQ_UNSET)
8227
194k
      {
8228
194k
      zerofirstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8229
194k
      zeroreqchar = reqchar;
8230
194k
      zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
8231
8232
      /* If the character is more than one byte long, we can set firstchar
8233
      only if it is not to be matched caselessly. */
8234
8235
194k
      if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
8236
194k
        {
8237
194k
        firstchar = mcbuffer[0];
8238
194k
        firstcharflags = req_caseopt;
8239
8240
194k
        if (mclength != 1)
8241
0
          {
8242
0
          reqchar = code[-1];
8243
0
          reqcharflags = cd->req_varyopt;
8244
0
          }
8245
194k
        }
8246
0
      else firstcharflags = reqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8247
194k
      }
8248
8249
    /* firstchar was previously set; we can set reqchar only if the length is
8250
    1 or the matching is caseful. */
8251
8252
1.21M
    else
8253
1.21M
      {
8254
1.21M
      zerofirstchar = firstchar;
8255
1.21M
      zerofirstcharflags = firstcharflags;
8256
1.21M
      zeroreqchar = reqchar;
8257
1.21M
      zeroreqcharflags = reqcharflags;
8258
1.21M
      if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0)
8259
1.21M
        {
8260
1.21M
        reqchar = code[-1];
8261
1.21M
        reqcharflags = req_caseopt | cd->req_varyopt;
8262
1.21M
        }
8263
1.21M
      }
8264
8265
1.40M
    break;            /* End of literal character handling */
8266
3.43M
    }
8267
3.43M
  }                   /* end of big loop */
8268
8269
8270
/* Control never reaches here by falling through, only by a goto for all the
8271
error states. Pass back the position in the pattern so that it can be displayed
8272
to the user for diagnosing the error. */
8273
8274
16.3k
FAILED:
8275
16.3k
*ptrptr = ptr;
8276
16.3k
return FALSE;
8277
965k
}
8278
8279
8280
8281
/*************************************************
8282
*     Compile sequence of alternatives           *
8283
*************************************************/
8284
8285
/* On entry, ptr is pointing past the bracket character, but on return it
8286
points to the closing bracket, or vertical bar, or end of string. The code
8287
variable is pointing at the byte into which the BRA operator has been stored.
8288
This function is used during the pre-compile phase when we are trying to find
8289
out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the real compile phase. The
8290
value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases.
8291
8292
Arguments:
8293
  options           option bits, including any changes for this subpattern
8294
  codeptr           -> the address of the current code pointer
8295
  ptrptr            -> the address of the current pattern pointer
8296
  errorcodeptr      -> pointer to error code variable
8297
  lookbehind        TRUE if this is a lookbehind assertion
8298
  reset_bracount    TRUE to reset the count for each branch
8299
  skipbytes         skip this many bytes at start (for brackets and OP_COND)
8300
  cond_depth        depth of nesting for conditional subpatterns
8301
  firstcharptr      place to put the first required character
8302
  firstcharflagsptr place to put the first character flags, or a negative number
8303
  reqcharptr        place to put the last required character
8304
  reqcharflagsptr   place to put the last required character flags, or a negative number
8305
  bcptr             pointer to the chain of currently open branches
8306
  cd                points to the data block with tables pointers etc.
8307
  lengthptr         NULL during the real compile phase
8308
                    points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase
8309
8310
Returns:            TRUE on success
8311
*/
8312
8313
static BOOL
8314
compile_regex(int options, pcre_uchar **codeptr, const pcre_uchar **ptrptr,
8315
  int *errorcodeptr, BOOL lookbehind, BOOL reset_bracount, int skipbytes,
8316
  int cond_depth,
8317
  pcre_uint32 *firstcharptr, pcre_int32 *firstcharflagsptr,
8318
  pcre_uint32 *reqcharptr, pcre_int32 *reqcharflagsptr,
8319
  branch_chain *bcptr, compile_data *cd, int *lengthptr)
8320
864k
{
8321
864k
const pcre_uchar *ptr = *ptrptr;
8322
864k
pcre_uchar *code = *codeptr;
8323
864k
pcre_uchar *last_branch = code;
8324
864k
pcre_uchar *start_bracket = code;
8325
864k
pcre_uchar *reverse_count = NULL;
8326
864k
open_capitem capitem;
8327
864k
int capnumber = 0;
8328
864k
pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar;
8329
864k
pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags;
8330
864k
pcre_uint32 branchfirstchar, branchreqchar;
8331
864k
pcre_int32 branchfirstcharflags, branchreqcharflags;
8332
864k
int length;
8333
864k
unsigned int orig_bracount;
8334
864k
unsigned int max_bracount;
8335
864k
branch_chain bc;
8336
864k
size_t save_hwm_offset;
8337
8338
/* If set, call the external function that checks for stack availability. */
8339
8340
864k
if (PUBL(stack_guard) != NULL && PUBL(stack_guard)())
8341
0
  {
8342
0
  *errorcodeptr= ERR85;
8343
0
  return FALSE;
8344
0
  }
8345
8346
/* Miscellaneous initialization */
8347
8348
864k
bc.outer = bcptr;
8349
864k
bc.current_branch = code;
8350
8351
864k
firstchar = reqchar = 0;
8352
864k
firstcharflags = reqcharflags = REQ_UNSET;
8353
8354
864k
save_hwm_offset = cd->hwm - cd->start_workspace;
8355
8356
/* Accumulate the length for use in the pre-compile phase. Start with the
8357
length of the BRA and KET and any extra bytes that are required at the
8358
beginning. We accumulate in a local variable to save frequent testing of
8359
lenthptr for NULL. We cannot do this by looking at the value of code at the
8360
start and end of each alternative, because compiled items are discarded during
8361
the pre-compile phase so that the work space is not exceeded. */
8362
8363
864k
length = 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE + skipbytes;
8364
8365
/* WARNING: If the above line is changed for any reason, you must also change
8366
the code that abstracts option settings at the start of the pattern and makes
8367
them global. It tests the value of length for (2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) in the
8368
pre-compile phase to find out whether anything has yet been compiled or not. */
8369
8370
/* If this is a capturing subpattern, add to the chain of open capturing items
8371
so that we can detect them if (*ACCEPT) is encountered. This is also used to
8372
detect groups that contain recursive back references to themselves. Note that
8373
only OP_CBRA need be tested here; changing this opcode to one of its variants,
8374
e.g. OP_SCBRAPOS, happens later, after the group has been compiled. */
8375
8376
864k
if (*code == OP_CBRA)
8377
790k
  {
8378
790k
  capnumber = GET2(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE);
8379
790k
  capitem.number = capnumber;
8380
790k
  capitem.next = cd->open_caps;
8381
790k
  capitem.flag = FALSE;
8382
790k
  cd->open_caps = &capitem;
8383
790k
  }
8384
8385
/* Offset is set zero to mark that this bracket is still open */
8386
8387
864k
PUT(code, 1, 0);
8388
864k
code += 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipbytes;
8389
8390
/* Loop for each alternative branch */
8391
8392
864k
orig_bracount = max_bracount = cd->bracount;
8393
864k
for (;;)
8394
965k
  {
8395
  /* For a (?| group, reset the capturing bracket count so that each branch
8396
  uses the same numbers. */
8397
8398
965k
  if (reset_bracount) cd->bracount = orig_bracount;
8399
8400
  /* Set up dummy OP_REVERSE if lookbehind assertion */
8401
8402
965k
  if (lookbehind)
8403
5.96k
    {
8404
5.96k
    *code++ = OP_REVERSE;
8405
5.96k
    reverse_count = code;
8406
5.96k
    PUTINC(code, 0, 0);
8407
5.96k
    length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8408
5.96k
    }
8409
8410
  /* Now compile the branch; in the pre-compile phase its length gets added
8411
  into the length. */
8412
8413
965k
  if (!compile_branch(&options, &code, &ptr, errorcodeptr, &branchfirstchar,
8414
965k
        &branchfirstcharflags, &branchreqchar, &branchreqcharflags, &bc,
8415
965k
        cond_depth, cd, (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : &length))
8416
16.3k
    {
8417
16.3k
    *ptrptr = ptr;
8418
16.3k
    return FALSE;
8419
16.3k
    }
8420
8421
  /* Keep the highest bracket count in case (?| was used and some branch
8422
  has fewer than the rest. */
8423
8424
949k
  if (cd->bracount > max_bracount) max_bracount = cd->bracount;
8425
8426
  /* In the real compile phase, there is some post-processing to be done. */
8427
8428
949k
  if (lengthptr == NULL)
8429
186k
    {
8430
    /* If this is the first branch, the firstchar and reqchar values for the
8431
    branch become the values for the regex. */
8432
8433
186k
    if (*last_branch != OP_ALT)
8434
137k
      {
8435
137k
      firstchar = branchfirstchar;
8436
137k
      firstcharflags = branchfirstcharflags;
8437
137k
      reqchar = branchreqchar;
8438
137k
      reqcharflags = branchreqcharflags;
8439
137k
      }
8440
8441
    /* If this is not the first branch, the first char and reqchar have to
8442
    match the values from all the previous branches, except that if the
8443
    previous value for reqchar didn't have REQ_VARY set, it can still match,
8444
    and we set REQ_VARY for the regex. */
8445
8446
48.9k
    else
8447
48.9k
      {
8448
      /* If we previously had a firstchar, but it doesn't match the new branch,
8449
      we have to abandon the firstchar for the regex, but if there was
8450
      previously no reqchar, it takes on the value of the old firstchar. */
8451
8452
48.9k
      if (firstcharflags >= 0 &&
8453
48.9k
          (firstcharflags != branchfirstcharflags || firstchar != branchfirstchar))
8454
2.87k
        {
8455
2.87k
        if (reqcharflags < 0)
8456
1.28k
          {
8457
1.28k
          reqchar = firstchar;
8458
1.28k
          reqcharflags = firstcharflags;
8459
1.28k
          }
8460
2.87k
        firstcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8461
2.87k
        }
8462
8463
      /* If we (now or from before) have no firstchar, a firstchar from the
8464
      branch becomes a reqchar if there isn't a branch reqchar. */
8465
8466
48.9k
      if (firstcharflags < 0 && branchfirstcharflags >= 0 && branchreqcharflags < 0)
8467
4.54k
        {
8468
4.54k
        branchreqchar = branchfirstchar;
8469
4.54k
        branchreqcharflags = branchfirstcharflags;
8470
4.54k
        }
8471
8472
      /* Now ensure that the reqchars match */
8473
8474
48.9k
      if (((reqcharflags & ~REQ_VARY) != (branchreqcharflags & ~REQ_VARY)) ||
8475
48.9k
          reqchar != branchreqchar)
8476
44.5k
        reqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
8477
4.36k
      else
8478
4.36k
        {
8479
4.36k
        reqchar = branchreqchar;
8480
4.36k
        reqcharflags |= branchreqcharflags; /* To "or" REQ_VARY */
8481
4.36k
        }
8482
48.9k
      }
8483
8484
    /* If lookbehind, check that this branch matches a fixed-length string, and
8485
    put the length into the OP_REVERSE item. Temporarily mark the end of the
8486
    branch with OP_END. If the branch contains OP_RECURSE, the result is -3
8487
    because there may be forward references that we can't check here. Set a
8488
    flag to cause another lookbehind check at the end. Why not do it all at the
8489
    end? Because common, erroneous checks are picked up here and the offset of
8490
    the problem can be shown. */
8491
8492
186k
    if (lookbehind)
8493
2.76k
      {
8494
2.76k
      int fixed_length;
8495
2.76k
      *code = OP_END;
8496
2.76k
      fixed_length = find_fixedlength(last_branch,  (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0,
8497
2.76k
        FALSE, cd, NULL);
8498
2.76k
      DPRINTF(("fixed length = %d\n", fixed_length));
8499
2.76k
      if (fixed_length == -3)
8500
641
        {
8501
641
        cd->check_lookbehind = TRUE;
8502
641
        }
8503
2.12k
      else if (fixed_length < 0)
8504
185
        {
8505
185
        *errorcodeptr = (fixed_length == -2)? ERR36 :
8506
185
                        (fixed_length == -4)? ERR70: ERR25;
8507
185
        *ptrptr = ptr;
8508
185
        return FALSE;
8509
185
        }
8510
1.94k
      else
8511
1.94k
        {
8512
1.94k
        if (fixed_length > cd->max_lookbehind)
8513
442
          cd->max_lookbehind = fixed_length;
8514
1.94k
        PUT(reverse_count, 0, fixed_length);
8515
1.94k
        }
8516
2.76k
      }
8517
186k
    }
8518
8519
  /* Reached end of expression, either ')' or end of pattern. In the real
8520
  compile phase, go back through the alternative branches and reverse the chain
8521
  of offsets, with the field in the BRA item now becoming an offset to the
8522
  first alternative. If there are no alternatives, it points to the end of the
8523
  group. The length in the terminating ket is always the length of the whole
8524
  bracketed item. Return leaving the pointer at the terminating char. */
8525
8526
949k
  if (*ptr != CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE)
8527
848k
    {
8528
848k
    if (lengthptr == NULL)
8529
137k
      {
8530
137k
      int branch_length = (int)(code - last_branch);
8531
137k
      do
8532
185k
        {
8533
185k
        int prev_length = GET(last_branch, 1);
8534
185k
        PUT(last_branch, 1, branch_length);
8535
185k
        branch_length = prev_length;
8536
185k
        last_branch -= branch_length;
8537
185k
        }
8538
185k
      while (branch_length > 0);
8539
137k
      }
8540
8541
    /* Fill in the ket */
8542
8543
848k
    *code = OP_KET;
8544
848k
    PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
8545
848k
    code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8546
8547
    /* If it was a capturing subpattern, check to see if it contained any
8548
    recursive back references. If so, we must wrap it in atomic brackets.
8549
    Because we are moving code along, we must ensure that any pending recursive
8550
    references are updated. In any event, remove the block from the chain. */
8551
8552
848k
    if (capnumber > 0)
8553
779k
      {
8554
779k
      if (cd->open_caps->flag)
8555
3.22k
        {
8556
3.22k
        *code = OP_END;
8557
3.22k
        adjust_recurse(start_bracket, 1 + LINK_SIZE,
8558
3.22k
          (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0, cd, save_hwm_offset);
8559
3.22k
        memmove(start_bracket + 1 + LINK_SIZE, start_bracket,
8560
3.22k
          IN_UCHARS(code - start_bracket));
8561
3.22k
        *start_bracket = OP_ONCE;
8562
3.22k
        code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8563
3.22k
        PUT(start_bracket, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
8564
3.22k
        *code = OP_KET;
8565
3.22k
        PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket));
8566
3.22k
        code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8567
3.22k
        length += 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE;
8568
3.22k
        }
8569
779k
      cd->open_caps = cd->open_caps->next;
8570
779k
      }
8571
8572
    /* Retain the highest bracket number, in case resetting was used. */
8573
8574
848k
    cd->bracount = max_bracount;
8575
8576
    /* Set values to pass back */
8577
8578
848k
    *codeptr = code;
8579
848k
    *ptrptr = ptr;
8580
848k
    *firstcharptr = firstchar;
8581
848k
    *firstcharflagsptr = firstcharflags;
8582
848k
    *reqcharptr = reqchar;
8583
848k
    *reqcharflagsptr = reqcharflags;
8584
848k
    if (lengthptr != NULL)
8585
711k
      {
8586
711k
      if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length)
8587
1
        {
8588
1
        *errorcodeptr = ERR20;
8589
1
        return FALSE;
8590
1
        }
8591
711k
      *lengthptr += length;
8592
711k
      }
8593
848k
    return TRUE;
8594
848k
    }
8595
8596
  /* Another branch follows. In the pre-compile phase, we can move the code
8597
  pointer back to where it was for the start of the first branch. (That is,
8598
  pretend that each branch is the only one.)
8599
8600
  In the real compile phase, insert an ALT node. Its length field points back
8601
  to the previous branch while the bracket remains open. At the end the chain
8602
  is reversed. It's done like this so that the start of the bracket has a
8603
  zero offset until it is closed, making it possible to detect recursion. */
8604
8605
100k
  if (lengthptr != NULL)
8606
51.5k
    {
8607
51.5k
    code = *codeptr + 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipbytes;
8608
51.5k
    length += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8609
51.5k
    }
8610
49.0k
  else
8611
49.0k
    {
8612
49.0k
    *code = OP_ALT;
8613
49.0k
    PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - last_branch));
8614
49.0k
    bc.current_branch = last_branch = code;
8615
49.0k
    code += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8616
49.0k
    }
8617
8618
100k
  ptr++;
8619
100k
  }
8620
/* Control never reaches here */
8621
864k
}
8622
8623
8624
8625
8626
/*************************************************
8627
*          Check for anchored expression         *
8628
*************************************************/
8629
8630
/* Try to find out if this is an anchored regular expression. Consider each
8631
alternative branch. If they all start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC, or with a bracket
8632
all of whose alternatives start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC (recurse ad lib), then
8633
it's anchored. However, if this is a multiline pattern, then only OP_SOD will
8634
be found, because ^ generates OP_CIRCM in that mode.
8635
8636
We can also consider a regex to be anchored if OP_SOM starts all its branches.
8637
This is the code for \G, which means "match at start of match position, taking
8638
into account the match offset".
8639
8640
A branch is also implicitly anchored if it starts with .* and DOTALL is set,
8641
because that will try the rest of the pattern at all possible matching points,
8642
so there is no point trying again.... er ....
8643
8644
.... except when the .* appears inside capturing parentheses, and there is a
8645
subsequent back reference to those parentheses. We haven't enough information
8646
to catch that case precisely.
8647
8648
At first, the best we could do was to detect when .* was in capturing brackets
8649
and the highest back reference was greater than or equal to that level.
8650
However, by keeping a bitmap of the first 31 back references, we can catch some
8651
of the more common cases more precisely.
8652
8653
... A second exception is when the .* appears inside an atomic group, because
8654
this prevents the number of characters it matches from being adjusted.
8655
8656
Arguments:
8657
  code           points to start of expression (the bracket)
8658
  bracket_map    a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
8659
                  handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
8660
                  the less precise approach
8661
  cd             points to the compile data block
8662
  atomcount      atomic group level
8663
8664
Returns:     TRUE or FALSE
8665
*/
8666
8667
static BOOL
8668
is_anchored(register const pcre_uchar *code, unsigned int bracket_map,
8669
  compile_data *cd, int atomcount)
8670
22.1k
{
8671
24.5k
do {
8672
24.5k
   const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(
8673
24.5k
     code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
8674
24.5k
   register int op = *scode;
8675
8676
   /* Non-capturing brackets */
8677
8678
24.5k
   if (op == OP_BRA  || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
8679
24.5k
       op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
8680
1.29k
     {
8681
1.29k
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8682
1.29k
     }
8683
8684
   /* Capturing brackets */
8685
8686
23.2k
   else if (op == OP_CBRA  || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
8687
23.2k
            op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
8688
4.18k
     {
8689
4.18k
     int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
8690
4.18k
     int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1U << n) : 1);
8691
4.18k
     if (!is_anchored(scode, new_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8692
4.18k
     }
8693
8694
   /* Positive forward assertion */
8695
8696
19.0k
   else if (op == OP_ASSERT)
8697
648
     {
8698
648
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8699
648
     }
8700
8701
   /* Condition; not anchored if no second branch */
8702
8703
18.3k
   else if (op == OP_COND)
8704
426
     {
8705
426
     if (scode[GET(scode,1)] != OP_ALT) return FALSE;
8706
271
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount)) return FALSE;
8707
271
     }
8708
8709
   /* Atomic groups */
8710
8711
17.9k
   else if (op == OP_ONCE || op == OP_ONCE_NC)
8712
1.04k
     {
8713
1.04k
     if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount + 1))
8714
933
       return FALSE;
8715
1.04k
     }
8716
8717
   /* .* is not anchored unless DOTALL is set (which generates OP_ALLANY) and
8718
   it isn't in brackets that are or may be referenced or inside an atomic
8719
   group. */
8720
8721
16.9k
   else if ((op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR ||
8722
16.9k
             op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR))
8723
1.10k
     {
8724
1.10k
     if (scode[1] != OP_ALLANY || (bracket_map & cd->backref_map) != 0 ||
8725
1.10k
         atomcount > 0 || cd->had_pruneorskip)
8726
195
       return FALSE;
8727
1.10k
     }
8728
8729
   /* Check for explicit anchoring */
8730
8731
15.8k
   else if (op != OP_SOD && op != OP_SOM && op != OP_CIRC) return FALSE;
8732
8733
3.77k
   code += GET(code, 1);
8734
3.77k
   }
8735
22.1k
while (*code == OP_ALT);   /* Loop for each alternative */
8736
1.35k
return TRUE;
8737
22.1k
}
8738
8739
8740
8741
/*************************************************
8742
*         Check for starting with ^ or .*        *
8743
*************************************************/
8744
8745
/* This is called to find out if every branch starts with ^ or .* so that
8746
"first char" processing can be done to speed things up in multiline
8747
matching and for non-DOTALL patterns that start with .* (which must start at
8748
the beginning or after \n). As in the case of is_anchored() (see above), we
8749
have to take account of back references to capturing brackets that contain .*
8750
because in that case we can't make the assumption. Also, the appearance of .*
8751
inside atomic brackets or in an assertion, or in a pattern that contains *PRUNE
8752
or *SKIP does not count, because once again the assumption no longer holds.
8753
8754
Arguments:
8755
  code           points to start of expression (the bracket)
8756
  bracket_map    a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this
8757
                  handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take
8758
                  the less precise approach
8759
  cd             points to the compile data
8760
  atomcount      atomic group level
8761
  inassert       TRUE if in an assertion
8762
8763
Returns:         TRUE or FALSE
8764
*/
8765
8766
static BOOL
8767
is_startline(const pcre_uchar *code, unsigned int bracket_map,
8768
  compile_data *cd, int atomcount, BOOL inassert)
8769
10.2k
{
8770
12.6k
do {
8771
12.6k
   const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(
8772
12.6k
     code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE);
8773
12.6k
   register int op = *scode;
8774
8775
   /* If we are at the start of a conditional assertion group, *both* the
8776
   conditional assertion *and* what follows the condition must satisfy the test
8777
   for start of line. Other kinds of condition fail. Note that there may be an
8778
   auto-callout at the start of a condition. */
8779
8780
12.6k
   if (op == OP_COND)
8781
278
     {
8782
278
     scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8783
278
     if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT) scode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT];
8784
278
     switch (*scode)
8785
278
       {
8786
35
       case OP_CREF:
8787
36
       case OP_DNCREF:
8788
135
       case OP_RREF:
8789
136
       case OP_DNRREF:
8790
142
       case OP_DEF:
8791
149
       case OP_FAIL:
8792
149
       return FALSE;
8793
8794
129
       default:     /* Assertion */
8795
129
       if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
8796
180
       do scode += GET(scode, 1); while (*scode == OP_ALT);
8797
80
       scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
8798
80
       break;
8799
278
       }
8800
80
     scode = first_significant_code(scode, FALSE);
8801
80
     op = *scode;
8802
80
     }
8803
8804
   /* Non-capturing brackets */
8805
8806
12.4k
   if (op == OP_BRA  || op == OP_BRAPOS ||
8807
12.4k
       op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS)
8808
1.22k
     {
8809
1.22k
     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
8810
1.22k
     }
8811
8812
   /* Capturing brackets */
8813
8814
11.2k
   else if (op == OP_CBRA  || op == OP_CBRAPOS ||
8815
11.2k
            op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS)
8816
3.49k
     {
8817
3.49k
     int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE);
8818
3.49k
     int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1U << n) : 1);
8819
3.49k
     if (!is_startline(scode, new_map, cd, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE;
8820
3.49k
     }
8821
8822
   /* Positive forward assertions */
8823
8824
7.72k
   else if (op == OP_ASSERT)
8825
349
     {
8826
349
     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE;
8827
349
     }
8828
8829
   /* Atomic brackets */
8830
8831
7.37k
   else if (op == OP_ONCE || op == OP_ONCE_NC)
8832
713
     {
8833
713
     if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cd, atomcount + 1, inassert)) return FALSE;
8834
713
     }
8835
8836
   /* .* means "start at start or after \n" if it isn't in atomic brackets or
8837
   brackets that may be referenced or an assertion, as long as the pattern does
8838
   not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP, because these break the feature. Consider, for
8839
   example, /.*?a(*PRUNE)b/ with the subject "aab", which matches "ab", i.e.
8840
   not at the start of a line. */
8841
8842
6.66k
   else if (op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR || op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR)
8843
1.34k
     {
8844
1.34k
     if (scode[1] != OP_ANY || (bracket_map & cd->backref_map) != 0 ||
8845
1.34k
         atomcount > 0 || cd->had_pruneorskip || inassert)
8846
133
       return FALSE;
8847
1.34k
     }
8848
8849
   /* Check for explicit circumflex; anything else gives a FALSE result. Note
8850
   in particular that this includes atomic brackets OP_ONCE and OP_ONCE_NC
8851
   because the number of characters matched by .* cannot be adjusted inside
8852
   them. */
8853
8854
5.31k
   else if (op != OP_CIRC && op != OP_CIRCM) return FALSE;
8855
8856
   /* Move on to the next alternative */
8857
8858
3.53k
   code += GET(code, 1);
8859
3.53k
   }
8860
10.2k
while (*code == OP_ALT);  /* Loop for each alternative */
8861
1.10k
return TRUE;
8862
10.2k
}
8863
8864
8865
8866
/*************************************************
8867
*       Check for asserted fixed first char      *
8868
*************************************************/
8869
8870
/* During compilation, the "first char" settings from forward assertions are
8871
discarded, because they can cause conflicts with actual literals that follow.
8872
However, if we end up without a first char setting for an unanchored pattern,
8873
it is worth scanning the regex to see if there is an initial asserted first
8874
char. If all branches start with the same asserted char, or with a
8875
non-conditional bracket all of whose alternatives start with the same asserted
8876
char (recurse ad lib), then we return that char, with the flags set to zero or
8877
REQ_CASELESS; otherwise return zero with REQ_NONE in the flags.
8878
8879
Arguments:
8880
  code       points to start of expression (the bracket)
8881
  flags      points to the first char flags, or to REQ_NONE
8882
  inassert   TRUE if in an assertion
8883
8884
Returns:     the fixed first char, or 0 with REQ_NONE in flags
8885
*/
8886
8887
static pcre_uint32
8888
find_firstassertedchar(const pcre_uchar *code, pcre_int32 *flags,
8889
  BOOL inassert)
8890
11.8k
{
8891
11.8k
register pcre_uint32 c = 0;
8892
11.8k
int cflags = REQ_NONE;
8893
8894
11.8k
*flags = REQ_NONE;
8895
15.3k
do {
8896
15.3k
   pcre_uint32 d;
8897
15.3k
   int dflags;
8898
15.3k
   int xl = (*code == OP_CBRA || *code == OP_SCBRA ||
8899
15.3k
             *code == OP_CBRAPOS || *code == OP_SCBRAPOS)? IMM2_SIZE:0;
8900
15.3k
   const pcre_uchar *scode = first_significant_code(code + 1+LINK_SIZE + xl,
8901
15.3k
     TRUE);
8902
15.3k
   register pcre_uchar op = *scode;
8903
8904
15.3k
   switch(op)
8905
15.3k
     {
8906
4.06k
     default:
8907
4.06k
     return 0;
8908
8909
573
     case OP_BRA:
8910
1.04k
     case OP_BRAPOS:
8911
4.44k
     case OP_CBRA:
8912
4.72k
     case OP_SCBRA:
8913
4.82k
     case OP_CBRAPOS:
8914
4.95k
     case OP_SCBRAPOS:
8915
6.39k
     case OP_ASSERT:
8916
7.17k
     case OP_ONCE:
8917
7.42k
     case OP_ONCE_NC:
8918
7.42k
     d = find_firstassertedchar(scode, &dflags, op == OP_ASSERT);
8919
7.42k
     if (dflags < 0)
8920
4.79k
       return 0;
8921
2.63k
     if (cflags < 0) { c = d; cflags = dflags; } else if (c != d || cflags != dflags) return 0;
8922
2.62k
     break;
8923
8924
2.62k
     case OP_EXACT:
8925
207
     scode += IMM2_SIZE;
8926
     /* Fall through */
8927
8928
1.86k
     case OP_CHAR:
8929
2.07k
     case OP_PLUS:
8930
2.27k
     case OP_MINPLUS:
8931
2.49k
     case OP_POSPLUS:
8932
2.49k
     if (!inassert) return 0;
8933
2.32k
     if (cflags < 0) { c = scode[1]; cflags = 0; }
8934
1.22k
       else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
8935
2.31k
     break;
8936
8937
2.31k
     case OP_EXACTI:
8938
198
     scode += IMM2_SIZE;
8939
     /* Fall through */
8940
8941
642
     case OP_CHARI:
8942
917
     case OP_PLUSI:
8943
1.12k
     case OP_MINPLUSI:
8944
1.35k
     case OP_POSPLUSI:
8945
1.35k
     if (!inassert) return 0;
8946
1.32k
     if (cflags < 0) { c = scode[1]; cflags = REQ_CASELESS; }
8947
1.22k
       else if (c != scode[1]) return 0;
8948
1.30k
     break;
8949
15.3k
     }
8950
8951
6.24k
   code += GET(code, 1);
8952
6.24k
   }
8953
11.8k
while (*code == OP_ALT);
8954
8955
2.71k
*flags = cflags;
8956
2.71k
return c;
8957
11.8k
}
8958
8959
8960
8961
/*************************************************
8962
*     Add an entry to the name/number table      *
8963
*************************************************/
8964
8965
/* This function is called between compiling passes to add an entry to the
8966
name/number table, maintaining alphabetical order. Checking for permitted
8967
and forbidden duplicates has already been done.
8968
8969
Arguments:
8970
  cd           the compile data block
8971
  name         the name to add
8972
  length       the length of the name
8973
  groupno      the group number
8974
8975
Returns:       nothing
8976
*/
8977
8978
static void
8979
add_name(compile_data *cd, const pcre_uchar *name, int length,
8980
  unsigned int groupno)
8981
35.0k
{
8982
35.0k
int i;
8983
35.0k
pcre_uchar *slot = cd->name_table;
8984
8985
41.5M
for (i = 0; i < cd->names_found; i++)
8986
41.5M
  {
8987
41.5M
  int crc = memcmp(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, IN_UCHARS(length));
8988
41.5M
  if (crc == 0 && slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] != 0)
8989
30.5k
    crc = -1; /* Current name is a substring */
8990
8991
  /* Make space in the table and break the loop for an earlier name. For a
8992
  duplicate or later name, carry on. We do this for duplicates so that in the
8993
  simple case (when ?(| is not used) they are in order of their numbers. In all
8994
  cases they are in the order in which they appear in the pattern. */
8995
8996
41.5M
  if (crc < 0)
8997
31.4k
    {
8998
31.4k
    memmove(slot + cd->name_entry_size, slot,
8999
31.4k
      IN_UCHARS((cd->names_found - i) * cd->name_entry_size));
9000
31.4k
    break;
9001
31.4k
    }
9002
9003
  /* Continue the loop for a later or duplicate name */
9004
9005
41.4M
  slot += cd->name_entry_size;
9006
41.4M
  }
9007
9008
35.0k
PUT2(slot, 0, groupno);
9009
35.0k
memcpy(slot + IMM2_SIZE, name, IN_UCHARS(length));
9010
35.0k
slot[IMM2_SIZE + length] = 0;
9011
35.0k
cd->names_found++;
9012
35.0k
}
9013
9014
9015
9016
/*************************************************
9017
*        Compile a Regular Expression            *
9018
*************************************************/
9019
9020
/* This function takes a string and returns a pointer to a block of store
9021
holding a compiled version of the expression. The original API for this
9022
function had no error code return variable; it is retained for backwards
9023
compatibility. The new function is given a new name.
9024
9025
Arguments:
9026
  pattern       the regular expression
9027
  options       various option bits
9028
  errorcodeptr  pointer to error code variable (pcre_compile2() only)
9029
                  can be NULL if you don't want a code value
9030
  errorptr      pointer to pointer to error text
9031
  erroroffset   ptr offset in pattern where error was detected
9032
  tables        pointer to character tables or NULL
9033
9034
Returns:        pointer to compiled data block, or NULL on error,
9035
                with errorptr and erroroffset set
9036
*/
9037
9038
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9039
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9040
pcre_compile(const char *pattern, int options, const char **errorptr,
9041
  int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9042
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9043
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre16 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9044
pcre16_compile(PCRE_SPTR16 pattern, int options, const char **errorptr,
9045
  int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9046
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9047
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre32 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9048
pcre32_compile(PCRE_SPTR32 pattern, int options, const char **errorptr,
9049
  int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9050
#endif
9051
19.3k
{
9052
19.3k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9053
19.3k
return pcre_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables);
9054
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9055
return pcre16_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables);
9056
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9057
return pcre32_compile2(pattern, options, NULL, errorptr, erroroffset, tables);
9058
#endif
9059
19.3k
}
9060
9061
9062
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9063
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9064
pcre_compile2(const char *pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr,
9065
  const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9066
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9067
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre16 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9068
pcre16_compile2(PCRE_SPTR16 pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr,
9069
  const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9070
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9071
PCRE_EXP_DEFN pcre32 * PCRE_CALL_CONVENTION
9072
pcre32_compile2(PCRE_SPTR32 pattern, int options, int *errorcodeptr,
9073
  const char **errorptr, int *erroroffset, const unsigned char *tables)
9074
#endif
9075
19.3k
{
9076
19.3k
REAL_PCRE *re;
9077
19.3k
int length = 1;  /* For final END opcode */
9078
19.3k
pcre_int32 firstcharflags, reqcharflags;
9079
19.3k
pcre_uint32 firstchar, reqchar;
9080
19.3k
pcre_uint32 limit_match = PCRE_UINT32_MAX;
9081
19.3k
pcre_uint32 limit_recursion = PCRE_UINT32_MAX;
9082
19.3k
int newline;
9083
19.3k
int errorcode = 0;
9084
19.3k
int skipatstart = 0;
9085
19.3k
BOOL utf;
9086
19.3k
BOOL never_utf = FALSE;
9087
19.3k
size_t size;
9088
19.3k
pcre_uchar *code;
9089
19.3k
const pcre_uchar *codestart;
9090
19.3k
const pcre_uchar *ptr;
9091
19.3k
compile_data compile_block;
9092
19.3k
compile_data *cd = &compile_block;
9093
9094
/* This space is used for "compiling" into during the first phase, when we are
9095
computing the amount of memory that is needed. Compiled items are thrown away
9096
as soon as possible, so that a fairly large buffer should be sufficient for
9097
this purpose. The same space is used in the second phase for remembering where
9098
to fill in forward references to subpatterns. That may overflow, in which case
9099
new memory is obtained from malloc(). */
9100
9101
19.3k
pcre_uchar cworkspace[COMPILE_WORK_SIZE];
9102
9103
/* This vector is used for remembering name groups during the pre-compile. In a
9104
similar way to cworkspace, it can be expanded using malloc() if necessary. */
9105
9106
19.3k
named_group named_groups[NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE];
9107
19.3k
cd->named_groups = named_groups;
9108
19.3k
cd->named_group_list_size = NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE;
9109
9110
/* Set this early so that early errors get offset 0. */
9111
9112
19.3k
ptr = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern;
9113
9114
/* We can't pass back an error message if errorptr is NULL; I guess the best we
9115
can do is just return NULL, but we can set a code value if there is a code
9116
pointer. */
9117
9118
19.3k
if (errorptr == NULL)
9119
0
  {
9120
0
  if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = 99;
9121
0
  return NULL;
9122
0
  }
9123
9124
19.3k
*errorptr = NULL;
9125
19.3k
if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR0;
9126
9127
/* However, we can give a message for this error */
9128
9129
19.3k
if (erroroffset == NULL)
9130
0
  {
9131
0
  errorcode = ERR16;
9132
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2;
9133
0
  }
9134
9135
19.3k
*erroroffset = 0;
9136
9137
/* Set up pointers to the individual character tables */
9138
9139
19.3k
if (tables == NULL) tables = PRIV(default_tables);
9140
19.3k
cd->lcc = tables + lcc_offset;
9141
19.3k
cd->fcc = tables + fcc_offset;
9142
19.3k
cd->cbits = tables + cbits_offset;
9143
19.3k
cd->ctypes = tables + ctypes_offset;
9144
9145
/* Check that all undefined public option bits are zero */
9146
9147
19.3k
if ((options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0)
9148
0
  {
9149
0
  errorcode = ERR17;
9150
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9151
0
  }
9152
9153
/* If PCRE_NEVER_UTF is set, remember it. */
9154
9155
19.3k
if ((options & PCRE_NEVER_UTF) != 0) never_utf = TRUE;
9156
9157
/* Check for global one-time settings at the start of the pattern, and remember
9158
the offset for later. */
9159
9160
19.3k
cd->external_flags = 0;   /* Initialize here for LIMIT_MATCH/RECURSION */
9161
9162
20.7k
while (ptr[skipatstart] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS &&
9163
20.7k
       ptr[skipatstart+1] == CHAR_ASTERISK)
9164
2.22k
  {
9165
2.22k
  int newnl = 0;
9166
2.22k
  int newbsr = 0;
9167
9168
/* For completeness and backward compatibility, (*UTFn) is supported in the
9169
relevant libraries, but (*UTF) is generic and always supported. Note that
9170
PCRE_UTF8 == PCRE_UTF16 == PCRE_UTF32. */
9171
9172
2.22k
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE8
9173
2.22k
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF8_RIGHTPAR, 5) == 0)
9174
18
    { skipatstart += 7; options |= PCRE_UTF8; continue; }
9175
2.20k
#endif
9176
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE16
9177
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF16_RIGHTPAR, 6) == 0)
9178
    { skipatstart += 8; options |= PCRE_UTF16; continue; }
9179
#endif
9180
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
9181
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF32_RIGHTPAR, 6) == 0)
9182
    { skipatstart += 8; options |= PCRE_UTF32; continue; }
9183
#endif
9184
9185
2.20k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UTF_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0)
9186
66
    { skipatstart += 6; options |= PCRE_UTF8; continue; }
9187
2.14k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_UCP_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0)
9188
34
    { skipatstart += 6; options |= PCRE_UCP; continue; }
9189
2.10k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_NO_AUTO_POSSESS_RIGHTPAR, 16) == 0)
9190
67
    { skipatstart += 18; options |= PCRE_NO_AUTO_POSSESS; continue; }
9191
2.04k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_NO_START_OPT_RIGHTPAR, 13) == 0)
9192
35
    { skipatstart += 15; options |= PCRE_NO_START_OPTIMIZE; continue; }
9193
9194
2.00k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LIMIT_MATCH_EQ, 12) == 0)
9195
404
    {
9196
404
    pcre_uint32 c = 0;
9197
404
    int p = skipatstart + 14;
9198
404
    while (isdigit(ptr[p]))
9199
1.27k
      {
9200
1.27k
      if (c > PCRE_UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break;   /* Integer overflow */
9201
1.27k
      c = c*10 + ptr[p++] - CHAR_0;
9202
1.27k
      }
9203
404
    if (ptr[p++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) break;
9204
392
    if (c < limit_match)
9205
90
      {
9206
90
      limit_match = c;
9207
90
      cd->external_flags |= PCRE_MLSET;
9208
90
      }
9209
392
    skipatstart = p;
9210
392
    continue;
9211
404
    }
9212
9213
1.60k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LIMIT_RECURSION_EQ, 16) == 0)
9214
110
    {
9215
110
    pcre_uint32 c = 0;
9216
110
    int p = skipatstart + 18;
9217
110
    while (isdigit(ptr[p]))
9218
414
      {
9219
414
      if (c > PCRE_UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break;   /* Integer overflow check */
9220
413
      c = c*10 + ptr[p++] - CHAR_0;
9221
413
      }
9222
110
    if (ptr[p++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) break;
9223
100
    if (c < limit_recursion)
9224
52
      {
9225
52
      limit_recursion = c;
9226
52
      cd->external_flags |= PCRE_RLSET;
9227
52
      }
9228
100
    skipatstart = p;
9229
100
    continue;
9230
110
    }
9231
9232
1.49k
  if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_CR_RIGHTPAR, 3) == 0)
9233
101
    { skipatstart += 5; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_CR; }
9234
1.39k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_LF_RIGHTPAR, 3)  == 0)
9235
17
    { skipatstart += 5; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_LF; }
9236
1.37k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_CRLF_RIGHTPAR, 5)  == 0)
9237
234
    { skipatstart += 7; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_CR + PCRE_NEWLINE_LF; }
9238
1.14k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_ANY_RIGHTPAR, 4) == 0)
9239
108
    { skipatstart += 6; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_ANY; }
9240
1.03k
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 8) == 0)
9241
45
    { skipatstart += 10; newnl = PCRE_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF; }
9242
9243
987
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_BSR_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 12) == 0)
9244
26
    { skipatstart += 14; newbsr = PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF; }
9245
961
  else if (STRNCMP_UC_C8(ptr+skipatstart+2, STRING_BSR_UNICODE_RIGHTPAR, 12) == 0)
9246
73
    { skipatstart += 14; newbsr = PCRE_BSR_UNICODE; }
9247
9248
1.49k
  if (newnl != 0)
9249
505
    options = (options & ~PCRE_NEWLINE_BITS) | newnl;
9250
987
  else if (newbsr != 0)
9251
99
    options = (options & ~(PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE)) | newbsr;
9252
888
  else break;
9253
1.49k
  }
9254
9255
/* PCRE_UTF(16|32) have the same value as PCRE_UTF8. */
9256
19.3k
utf = (options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0;
9257
19.3k
if (utf && never_utf)
9258
0
  {
9259
0
  errorcode = ERR78;
9260
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2;
9261
0
  }
9262
9263
/* Can't support UTF unless PCRE has been compiled to include the code. The
9264
return of an error code from PRIV(valid_utf)() is a new feature, introduced in
9265
release 8.13. It is passed back from pcre_[dfa_]exec(), but at the moment is
9266
not used here. */
9267
9268
#ifdef SUPPORT_UTF
9269
if (utf && (options & PCRE_NO_UTF8_CHECK) == 0 &&
9270
     (errorcode = PRIV(valid_utf)((PCRE_PUCHAR)pattern, -1, erroroffset)) != 0)
9271
  {
9272
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9273
  errorcode = ERR44;
9274
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9275
  errorcode = ERR74;
9276
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9277
  errorcode = ERR77;
9278
#endif
9279
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2;
9280
  }
9281
#else
9282
19.3k
if (utf)
9283
12
  {
9284
12
  errorcode = ERR32;
9285
12
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9286
12
  }
9287
19.3k
#endif
9288
9289
/* Can't support UCP unless PCRE has been compiled to include the code. */
9290
9291
19.3k
#ifndef SUPPORT_UCP
9292
19.3k
if ((options & PCRE_UCP) != 0)
9293
6
  {
9294
6
  errorcode = ERR67;
9295
6
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9296
6
  }
9297
19.3k
#endif
9298
9299
/* Check validity of \R options. */
9300
9301
19.3k
if ((options & (PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE)) ==
9302
19.3k
     (PCRE_BSR_ANYCRLF|PCRE_BSR_UNICODE))
9303
0
  {
9304
0
  errorcode = ERR56;
9305
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9306
0
  }
9307
9308
/* Handle different types of newline. The three bits give seven cases. The
9309
current code allows for fixed one- or two-byte sequences, plus "any" and
9310
"anycrlf". */
9311
9312
19.3k
switch (options & PCRE_NEWLINE_BITS)
9313
19.3k
  {
9314
19.1k
  case 0: newline = NEWLINE; break;   /* Build-time default */
9315
12
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_CR: newline = CHAR_CR; break;
9316
7
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_LF: newline = CHAR_NL; break;
9317
48
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_CR+
9318
48
       PCRE_NEWLINE_LF: newline = (CHAR_CR << 8) | CHAR_NL; break;
9319
80
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_ANY: newline = -1; break;
9320
39
  case PCRE_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF: newline = -2; break;
9321
0
  default: errorcode = ERR56; goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9322
19.3k
  }
9323
9324
19.3k
if (newline == -2)
9325
39
  {
9326
39
  cd->nltype = NLTYPE_ANYCRLF;
9327
39
  }
9328
19.3k
else if (newline < 0)
9329
80
  {
9330
80
  cd->nltype = NLTYPE_ANY;
9331
80
  }
9332
19.2k
else
9333
19.2k
  {
9334
19.2k
  cd->nltype = NLTYPE_FIXED;
9335
19.2k
  if (newline > 255)
9336
48
    {
9337
48
    cd->nllen = 2;
9338
48
    cd->nl[0] = (newline >> 8) & 255;
9339
48
    cd->nl[1] = newline & 255;
9340
48
    }
9341
19.2k
  else
9342
19.2k
    {
9343
19.2k
    cd->nllen = 1;
9344
19.2k
    cd->nl[0] = newline;
9345
19.2k
    }
9346
19.2k
  }
9347
9348
/* Maximum back reference and backref bitmap. The bitmap records up to 31 back
9349
references to help in deciding whether (.*) can be treated as anchored or not.
9350
*/
9351
9352
19.3k
cd->top_backref = 0;
9353
19.3k
cd->backref_map = 0;
9354
9355
/* Reflect pattern for debugging output */
9356
9357
19.3k
DPRINTF(("------------------------------------------------------------------\n"));
9358
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
9359
print_puchar(stdout, (PCRE_PUCHAR)pattern);
9360
#endif
9361
19.3k
DPRINTF(("\n"));
9362
9363
/* Pretend to compile the pattern while actually just accumulating the length
9364
of memory required. This behaviour is triggered by passing a non-NULL final
9365
argument to compile_regex(). We pass a block of workspace (cworkspace) for it
9366
to compile parts of the pattern into; the compiled code is discarded when it is
9367
no longer needed, so hopefully this workspace will never overflow, though there
9368
is a test for its doing so. */
9369
9370
19.3k
cd->bracount = cd->final_bracount = 0;
9371
19.3k
cd->names_found = 0;
9372
19.3k
cd->name_entry_size = 0;
9373
19.3k
cd->name_table = NULL;
9374
19.3k
cd->dupnames = FALSE;
9375
19.3k
cd->dupgroups = FALSE;
9376
19.3k
cd->namedrefcount = 0;
9377
19.3k
cd->start_code = cworkspace;
9378
19.3k
cd->hwm = cworkspace;
9379
19.3k
cd->iscondassert = FALSE;
9380
19.3k
cd->start_workspace = cworkspace;
9381
19.3k
cd->workspace_size = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE;
9382
19.3k
cd->start_pattern = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern;
9383
19.3k
cd->end_pattern = (const pcre_uchar *)(pattern + STRLEN_UC((const pcre_uchar *)pattern));
9384
19.3k
cd->req_varyopt = 0;
9385
19.3k
cd->parens_depth = 0;
9386
19.3k
cd->assert_depth = 0;
9387
19.3k
cd->max_lookbehind = 0;
9388
19.3k
cd->external_options = options;
9389
19.3k
cd->open_caps = NULL;
9390
9391
/* Now do the pre-compile. On error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we
9392
don't need to look at the result of the function here. The initial options have
9393
been put into the cd block so that they can be changed if an option setting is
9394
found within the regex right at the beginning. Bringing initial option settings
9395
outside can help speed up starting point checks. */
9396
9397
19.3k
ptr += skipatstart;
9398
19.3k
code = cworkspace;
9399
19.3k
*code = OP_BRA;
9400
9401
19.3k
(void)compile_regex(cd->external_options, &code, &ptr, &errorcode, FALSE,
9402
19.3k
  FALSE, 0, 0, &firstchar, &firstcharflags, &reqchar, &reqcharflags, NULL,
9403
19.3k
  cd, &length);
9404
19.3k
if (errorcode != 0) goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9405
9406
16.5k
DPRINTF(("end pre-compile: length=%d workspace=%d\n", length,
9407
16.5k
  (int)(cd->hwm - cworkspace)));
9408
9409
16.5k
if (length > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE)
9410
98
  {
9411
98
  errorcode = ERR20;
9412
98
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9413
98
  }
9414
9415
/* Compute the size of the data block for storing the compiled pattern. Integer
9416
overflow should no longer be possible because nowadays we limit the maximum
9417
value of cd->names_found and cd->name_entry_size. */
9418
9419
16.4k
size = sizeof(REAL_PCRE) +
9420
16.4k
  (length + cd->names_found * cd->name_entry_size) * sizeof(pcre_uchar);
9421
9422
/* Get the memory. */
9423
9424
16.4k
re = (REAL_PCRE *)(PUBL(malloc))(size);
9425
16.4k
if (re == NULL)
9426
0
  {
9427
0
  errorcode = ERR21;
9428
0
  goto PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN;
9429
0
  }
9430
9431
/* Put in the magic number, and save the sizes, initial options, internal
9432
flags, and character table pointer. NULL is used for the default character
9433
tables. The nullpad field is at the end; it's there to help in the case when a
9434
regex compiled on a system with 4-byte pointers is run on another with 8-byte
9435
pointers. */
9436
9437
16.4k
re->magic_number = MAGIC_NUMBER;
9438
16.4k
re->size = (int)size;
9439
16.4k
re->options = cd->external_options;
9440
16.4k
re->flags = cd->external_flags;
9441
16.4k
re->limit_match = limit_match;
9442
16.4k
re->limit_recursion = limit_recursion;
9443
16.4k
re->first_char = 0;
9444
16.4k
re->req_char = 0;
9445
16.4k
re->name_table_offset = sizeof(REAL_PCRE) / sizeof(pcre_uchar);
9446
16.4k
re->name_entry_size = cd->name_entry_size;
9447
16.4k
re->name_count = cd->names_found;
9448
16.4k
re->ref_count = 0;
9449
16.4k
re->tables = (tables == PRIV(default_tables))? NULL : tables;
9450
16.4k
re->nullpad = NULL;
9451
#ifdef COMPILE_PCRE32
9452
re->dummy = 0;
9453
#else
9454
16.4k
re->dummy1 = re->dummy2 = re->dummy3 = 0;
9455
16.4k
#endif
9456
9457
/* The starting points of the name/number translation table and of the code are
9458
passed around in the compile data block. The start/end pattern and initial
9459
options are already set from the pre-compile phase, as is the name_entry_size
9460
field. Reset the bracket count and the names_found field. Also reset the hwm
9461
field; this time it's used for remembering forward references to subpatterns.
9462
*/
9463
9464
16.4k
cd->final_bracount = cd->bracount;  /* Save for checking forward references */
9465
16.4k
cd->parens_depth = 0;
9466
16.4k
cd->assert_depth = 0;
9467
16.4k
cd->bracount = 0;
9468
16.4k
cd->max_lookbehind = 0;
9469
16.4k
cd->name_table = (pcre_uchar *)re + re->name_table_offset;
9470
16.4k
codestart = cd->name_table + re->name_entry_size * re->name_count;
9471
16.4k
cd->start_code = codestart;
9472
16.4k
cd->hwm = (pcre_uchar *)(cd->start_workspace);
9473
16.4k
cd->iscondassert = FALSE;
9474
16.4k
cd->req_varyopt = 0;
9475
16.4k
cd->had_accept = FALSE;
9476
16.4k
cd->had_pruneorskip = FALSE;
9477
16.4k
cd->check_lookbehind = FALSE;
9478
16.4k
cd->open_caps = NULL;
9479
9480
/* If any named groups were found, create the name/number table from the list
9481
created in the first pass. */
9482
9483
16.4k
if (cd->names_found > 0)
9484
860
  {
9485
860
  int i = cd->names_found;
9486
860
  named_group *ng = cd->named_groups;
9487
860
  cd->names_found = 0;
9488
35.8k
  for (; i > 0; i--, ng++)
9489
35.0k
    add_name(cd, ng->name, ng->length, ng->number);
9490
860
  if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
9491
53
    (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups);
9492
860
  cd->named_group_list_size = 0;   /* So we don't free it twice */
9493
860
  }
9494
9495
/* Set up a starting, non-extracting bracket, then compile the expression. On
9496
error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the result
9497
of the function here. */
9498
9499
16.4k
ptr = (const pcre_uchar *)pattern + skipatstart;
9500
16.4k
code = (pcre_uchar *)codestart;
9501
16.4k
*code = OP_BRA;
9502
16.4k
(void)compile_regex(re->options, &code, &ptr, &errorcode, FALSE, FALSE, 0, 0,
9503
16.4k
  &firstchar, &firstcharflags, &reqchar, &reqcharflags, NULL, cd, NULL);
9504
16.4k
re->top_bracket = cd->bracount;
9505
16.4k
re->top_backref = cd->top_backref;
9506
16.4k
re->max_lookbehind = cd->max_lookbehind;
9507
16.4k
re->flags = cd->external_flags | PCRE_MODE;
9508
9509
16.4k
if (cd->had_accept)
9510
45
  {
9511
45
  reqchar = 0;              /* Must disable after (*ACCEPT) */
9512
45
  reqcharflags = REQ_NONE;
9513
45
  }
9514
9515
/* If not reached end of pattern on success, there's an excess bracket. */
9516
9517
16.4k
if (errorcode == 0 && *ptr != CHAR_NULL) errorcode = ERR22;
9518
9519
/* Fill in the terminating state and check for disastrous overflow, but
9520
if debugging, leave the test till after things are printed out. */
9521
9522
16.4k
*code++ = OP_END;
9523
9524
16.4k
#ifndef PCRE_DEBUG
9525
16.4k
if (code - codestart > length) errorcode = ERR23;
9526
16.4k
#endif
9527
9528
#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND
9529
/* If the estimated length exceeds the really used length, mark the extra
9530
allocated memory as unaddressable, so that any out-of-bound reads can be
9531
detected. */
9532
VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(code, (length - (code - codestart)) * sizeof(pcre_uchar));
9533
#endif
9534
9535
/* Fill in any forward references that are required. There may be repeated
9536
references; optimize for them, as searching a large regex takes time. */
9537
9538
16.4k
if (cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace)
9539
323
  {
9540
323
  int prev_recno = -1;
9541
323
  const pcre_uchar *groupptr = NULL;
9542
128k
  while (errorcode == 0 && cd->hwm > cd->start_workspace)
9543
128k
    {
9544
128k
    int offset, recno;
9545
128k
    cd->hwm -= LINK_SIZE;
9546
128k
    offset = GET(cd->hwm, 0);
9547
9548
    /* Check that the hwm handling hasn't gone wrong. This whole area is
9549
    rewritten in PCRE2 because there are some obscure cases. */
9550
9551
128k
    if (offset == 0 || codestart[offset-1] != OP_RECURSE)
9552
3
      {
9553
3
      errorcode = ERR10;
9554
3
      break;
9555
3
      }
9556
9557
128k
    recno = GET(codestart, offset);
9558
128k
    if (recno != prev_recno)
9559
1.16k
      {
9560
1.16k
      groupptr = PRIV(find_bracket)(codestart, utf, recno);
9561
1.16k
      prev_recno = recno;
9562
1.16k
      }
9563
128k
    if (groupptr == NULL) errorcode = ERR53;
9564
128k
      else PUT(((pcre_uchar *)codestart), offset, (int)(groupptr - codestart));
9565
128k
    }
9566
323
  }
9567
9568
/* If the workspace had to be expanded, free the new memory. Set the pointer to
9569
NULL to indicate that forward references have been filled in. */
9570
9571
16.4k
if (cd->workspace_size > COMPILE_WORK_SIZE)
9572
21
  (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->start_workspace);
9573
16.4k
cd->start_workspace = NULL;
9574
9575
/* Give an error if there's back reference to a non-existent capturing
9576
subpattern. */
9577
9578
16.4k
if (errorcode == 0 && re->top_backref > re->top_bracket) errorcode = ERR15;
9579
9580
/* Unless disabled, check whether any single character iterators can be
9581
auto-possessified. The function overwrites the appropriate opcode values, so
9582
the type of the pointer must be cast. NOTE: the intermediate variable "temp" is
9583
used in this code because at least one compiler gives a warning about loss of
9584
"const" attribute if the cast (pcre_uchar *)codestart is used directly in the
9585
function call. */
9586
9587
16.4k
if (errorcode == 0 && (options & PCRE_NO_AUTO_POSSESS) == 0)
9588
14.7k
  {
9589
14.7k
  pcre_uchar *temp = (pcre_uchar *)codestart;
9590
14.7k
  auto_possessify(temp, utf, cd);
9591
14.7k
  }
9592
9593
/* If there were any lookbehind assertions that contained OP_RECURSE
9594
(recursions or subroutine calls), a flag is set for them to be checked here,
9595
because they may contain forward references. Actual recursions cannot be fixed
9596
length, but subroutine calls can. It is done like this so that those without
9597
OP_RECURSE that are not fixed length get a diagnosic with a useful offset. The
9598
exceptional ones forgo this. We scan the pattern to check that they are fixed
9599
length, and set their lengths. */
9600
9601
16.4k
if (errorcode == 0 && cd->check_lookbehind)
9602
228
  {
9603
228
  pcre_uchar *cc = (pcre_uchar *)codestart;
9604
9605
  /* Loop, searching for OP_REVERSE items, and process those that do not have
9606
  their length set. (Actually, it will also re-process any that have a length
9607
  of zero, but that is a pathological case, and it does no harm.) When we find
9608
  one, we temporarily terminate the branch it is in while we scan it. */
9609
9610
228
  for (cc = (pcre_uchar *)PRIV(find_bracket)(codestart, utf, -1);
9611
2.66k
       cc != NULL;
9612
2.43k
       cc = (pcre_uchar *)PRIV(find_bracket)(cc, utf, -1))
9613
2.56k
    {
9614
2.56k
    if (GET(cc, 1) == 0)
9615
2.15k
      {
9616
2.15k
      int fixed_length;
9617
2.15k
      pcre_uchar *be = cc - 1 - LINK_SIZE + GET(cc, -LINK_SIZE);
9618
2.15k
      int end_op = *be;
9619
2.15k
      *be = OP_END;
9620
2.15k
      fixed_length = find_fixedlength(cc, (re->options & PCRE_UTF8) != 0, TRUE,
9621
2.15k
        cd, NULL);
9622
2.15k
      *be = end_op;
9623
2.15k
      DPRINTF(("fixed length = %d\n", fixed_length));
9624
2.15k
      if (fixed_length < 0)
9625
127
        {
9626
127
        errorcode = (fixed_length == -2)? ERR36 :
9627
127
                    (fixed_length == -4)? ERR70 : ERR25;
9628
127
        break;
9629
127
        }
9630
2.02k
      if (fixed_length > cd->max_lookbehind) cd->max_lookbehind = fixed_length;
9631
2.02k
      PUT(cc, 1, fixed_length);
9632
2.02k
      }
9633
2.43k
    cc += 1 + LINK_SIZE;
9634
2.43k
    }
9635
228
  }
9636
9637
/* Failed to compile, or error while post-processing */
9638
9639
16.4k
if (errorcode != 0)
9640
1.79k
  {
9641
1.79k
  (PUBL(free))(re);
9642
4.73k
  PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN:
9643
4.73k
  if (cd->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE)
9644
46
    (PUBL(free))((void *)cd->named_groups);
9645
4.73k
  *erroroffset = (int)(ptr - (const pcre_uchar *)pattern);
9646
4.73k
  PCRE_EARLY_ERROR_RETURN2:
9647
4.73k
  *errorptr = find_error_text(errorcode);
9648
4.73k
  if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = errorcode;
9649
4.73k
  return NULL;
9650
4.73k
  }
9651
9652
/* If the anchored option was not passed, set the flag if we can determine that
9653
the pattern is anchored by virtue of ^ characters or \A or anything else, such
9654
as starting with non-atomic .* when DOTALL is set and there are no occurrences
9655
of *PRUNE or *SKIP.
9656
9657
Otherwise, if we know what the first byte has to be, save it, because that
9658
speeds up unanchored matches no end. If not, see if we can set the
9659
PCRE_STARTLINE flag. This is helpful for multiline matches when all branches
9660
start with ^. and also when all branches start with non-atomic .* for
9661
non-DOTALL matches when *PRUNE and SKIP are not present. */
9662
9663
14.6k
if ((re->options & PCRE_ANCHORED) == 0)
9664
14.6k
  {
9665
14.6k
  if (is_anchored(codestart, 0, cd, 0)) re->options |= PCRE_ANCHORED;
9666
14.5k
  else
9667
14.5k
    {
9668
14.5k
    if (firstcharflags < 0)
9669
4.39k
      firstchar = find_firstassertedchar(codestart, &firstcharflags, FALSE);
9670
14.5k
    if (firstcharflags >= 0)   /* Remove caseless flag for non-caseable chars */
9671
10.2k
      {
9672
10.2k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9673
10.2k
      re->first_char = firstchar & 0xff;
9674
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9675
      re->first_char = firstchar & 0xffff;
9676
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9677
      re->first_char = firstchar;
9678
#endif
9679
10.2k
      if ((firstcharflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
9680
50
        {
9681
#if defined SUPPORT_UCP && !(defined COMPILE_PCRE8)
9682
        /* We ignore non-ASCII first chars in 8 bit mode. */
9683
        if (utf)
9684
          {
9685
          if (re->first_char < 128)
9686
            {
9687
            if (cd->fcc[re->first_char] != re->first_char)
9688
              re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS;
9689
            }
9690
          else if (UCD_OTHERCASE(re->first_char) != re->first_char)
9691
            re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS;
9692
          }
9693
        else
9694
#endif
9695
50
        if (MAX_255(re->first_char)
9696
50
            && cd->fcc[re->first_char] != re->first_char)
9697
10
          re->flags |= PCRE_FCH_CASELESS;
9698
50
        }
9699
9700
10.2k
      re->flags |= PCRE_FIRSTSET;
9701
10.2k
      }
9702
9703
4.31k
    else if (is_startline(codestart, 0, cd, 0, FALSE)) re->flags |= PCRE_STARTLINE;
9704
14.5k
    }
9705
14.6k
  }
9706
9707
/* For an anchored pattern, we use the "required byte" only if it follows a
9708
variable length item in the regex. Remove the caseless flag for non-caseable
9709
bytes. */
9710
9711
14.6k
if (reqcharflags >= 0 &&
9712
14.6k
     ((re->options & PCRE_ANCHORED) == 0 || (reqcharflags & REQ_VARY) != 0))
9713
10.7k
  {
9714
10.7k
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9715
10.7k
  re->req_char = reqchar & 0xff;
9716
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9717
  re->req_char = reqchar & 0xffff;
9718
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9719
  re->req_char = reqchar;
9720
#endif
9721
10.7k
  if ((reqcharflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0)
9722
54
    {
9723
#if defined SUPPORT_UCP && !(defined COMPILE_PCRE8)
9724
    /* We ignore non-ASCII first chars in 8 bit mode. */
9725
    if (utf)
9726
      {
9727
      if (re->req_char < 128)
9728
        {
9729
        if (cd->fcc[re->req_char] != re->req_char)
9730
          re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS;
9731
        }
9732
      else if (UCD_OTHERCASE(re->req_char) != re->req_char)
9733
        re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS;
9734
      }
9735
    else
9736
#endif
9737
54
    if (MAX_255(re->req_char) && cd->fcc[re->req_char] != re->req_char)
9738
18
      re->flags |= PCRE_RCH_CASELESS;
9739
54
    }
9740
9741
10.7k
  re->flags |= PCRE_REQCHSET;
9742
10.7k
  }
9743
9744
/* Print out the compiled data if debugging is enabled. This is never the
9745
case when building a production library. */
9746
9747
#ifdef PCRE_DEBUG
9748
printf("Length = %d top_bracket = %d top_backref = %d\n",
9749
  length, re->top_bracket, re->top_backref);
9750
9751
printf("Options=%08x\n", re->options);
9752
9753
if ((re->flags & PCRE_FIRSTSET) != 0)
9754
  {
9755
  pcre_uchar ch = re->first_char;
9756
  const char *caseless =
9757
    ((re->flags & PCRE_FCH_CASELESS) == 0)? "" : " (caseless)";
9758
  if (PRINTABLE(ch)) printf("First char = %c%s\n", ch, caseless);
9759
    else printf("First char = \\x%02x%s\n", ch, caseless);
9760
  }
9761
9762
if ((re->flags & PCRE_REQCHSET) != 0)
9763
  {
9764
  pcre_uchar ch = re->req_char;
9765
  const char *caseless =
9766
    ((re->flags & PCRE_RCH_CASELESS) == 0)? "" : " (caseless)";
9767
  if (PRINTABLE(ch)) printf("Req char = %c%s\n", ch, caseless);
9768
    else printf("Req char = \\x%02x%s\n", ch, caseless);
9769
  }
9770
9771
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9772
pcre_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE);
9773
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9774
pcre16_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE);
9775
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9776
pcre32_printint((pcre *)re, stdout, TRUE);
9777
#endif
9778
9779
/* This check is done here in the debugging case so that the code that
9780
was compiled can be seen. */
9781
9782
if (code - codestart > length)
9783
  {
9784
  (PUBL(free))(re);
9785
  *errorptr = find_error_text(ERR23);
9786
  *erroroffset = ptr - (pcre_uchar *)pattern;
9787
  if (errorcodeptr != NULL) *errorcodeptr = ERR23;
9788
  return NULL;
9789
  }
9790
#endif   /* PCRE_DEBUG */
9791
9792
/* Check for a pattern than can match an empty string, so that this information
9793
can be provided to applications. */
9794
9795
14.6k
do
9796
15.4k
  {
9797
15.4k
  if (could_be_empty_branch(codestart, code, utf, cd, NULL))
9798
2.74k
    {
9799
2.74k
    re->flags |= PCRE_MATCH_EMPTY;
9800
2.74k
    break;
9801
2.74k
    }
9802
12.7k
  codestart += GET(codestart, 1);
9803
12.7k
  }
9804
14.6k
while (*codestart == OP_ALT);
9805
9806
0
#if defined COMPILE_PCRE8
9807
0
return (pcre *)re;
9808
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE16
9809
return (pcre16 *)re;
9810
#elif defined COMPILE_PCRE32
9811
return (pcre32 *)re;
9812
#endif
9813
16.4k
}
9814
9815
/* End of pcre_compile.c */